Taint: fix dsearch result to be untainted
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.93"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552019
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440.endtable
441
442The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448.section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449.cindex "website"
450.cindex "FTP site"
451The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455.cindex "wiki"
456.cindex "FAQ"
457As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
458differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496.cindex "bug reports"
497.cindex "reporting bugs"
498Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506.cindex "FTP site"
507.cindex "HTTPS download site"
508.cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
509.cindex "distribution" "https site"
510The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511.display
512&url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
513.endd
514The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
520
521If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524here are top-level directories.
525
526There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533.display
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537.endd
538where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541most portable to old systems.
542
543.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544.cindex "distribution" "public key"
545.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
551PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552&_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565.endd
566For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
567separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574.display
575&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579.endd
580These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585.ilist
586.cindex "limitations of Exim"
587.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593.next
594.cindex "domainless addresses"
595.cindex "address" "without domain"
596Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600arrival.
601.next
602.cindex "transport" "external"
603.cindex "external transports"
604The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610.next
611Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614other means.
615.next
616Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620a number of common scanners are provided.
621.endlist
622
623
624.section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
625Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
640format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6413, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653.cindex "terminology definitions"
654.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657below) by a blank line.
658
659.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666rise to further bounce messages.
667
668The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671otherwise.
672
673The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676until a later time.
677
678The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682.cindex "envelope, definition of"
683.cindex "sender" "definition of"
684A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692.cindex "header section" "definition of"
693The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697line.
698
699.cindex "local part" "definition of"
700.cindex "domain" "definition of"
701The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
702part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712.cindex "return path" "definition of"
713&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714message's envelope.
715
716.cindex "queue" "definition of"
717The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
718because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744.cindex "incorporated code"
745.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746.cindex "PCRE"
747.cindex "OpenDMARC"
748A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750.ilist
751Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757.next
758.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763following statements:
764
765.blockquote
766Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771version.
772This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776restrictions applied to it).
777.endblockquote
778.next
779.cindex "SPA authentication"
780.cindex "Samba project"
781.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785under the Gnu GPL.
786.next
787.cindex "Cyrus"
788.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793conditions expressed therein.
794
795.blockquote
796Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800are met:
801
802.olist
803Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805.next
806Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809distribution.
810.next
811The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814details, please contact
815.display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822.endd
823.next
824Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825acknowledgment:
826
827&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837.endlist
838.endblockquote
839
840.next
841.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842.cindex "X-windows"
843.cindex "Athena"
844The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849.blockquote
850Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853All Rights Reserved
854
855Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869SOFTWARE.
870.endblockquote
871
872.next
873.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878source code.
879
880.next
881Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
883contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884.endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898.cindex "design philosophy"
899Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908.cindex "policy control" "overview"
909Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
911&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915.ilist
916.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925error code.
926.next
927An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929.next
930When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934.next
935When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940.next
941Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944.next
945After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947runs at the start of every delivery process.
948.endlist
949
950
951
952.section "User filters" "SECID12"
953.cindex "filter" "introduction"
954.cindex "Sieve filter"
955In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960of filtering are available:
961
962.ilist
963Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964by RFC 3028.
965.next
966Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968.endlist
969
970User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976.cindex "format" "of message id"
977.cindex "id of message"
978.cindex "base62"
979.cindex "base36"
980.cindex "Darwin"
981.cindex "Cygwin"
982Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
989not always case-sensitive.
990
991.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997somewhat eccentric:
998
999.ilist
1000The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003way of representing the date and time of day).
1004.next
1005After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006received the message.
1007.next
1008There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009.olist
1010.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015.next
1016If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018(1/100) of a second.
1019.endlist
1020.endlist
1021
1022After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030.cindex "receiving mail"
1031.cindex "message" "reception"
1032The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035there are several possibilities:
1036
1037.ilist
1038If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041.next
1042If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048.next
1049If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054.next
1055A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059.endlist
1060
1061
1062.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078(either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113affect file system performance.
1114
1115The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137.cindex "message" "life of"
1138.cindex "message" "frozen"
1139A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151to be sent.
1152
1153.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1158
1159.cindex "message" "log file for"
1160.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169systems.
1170
1171.cindex "journal file"
1172.cindex "file" "journal"
1173All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192.cindex "router" "definition of"
1193.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208the driver's features in general.
1209
1210A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214to be bounced.
1215
1216A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233configuration.
1234
1235The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243configured to fail the address.
1244
1245The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262.cindex "router" "for verification"
1263.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268&%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283.cindex "router" "running details"
1284.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285.cindex "router" "result of running"
1286As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290the following:
1291
1292.ilist
1293&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295original address ceases
1296.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301end of routing.
1302
1303Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308.next
1309&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314.next
1315&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320.next
1321&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324.next
1325&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329.next
1330&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332.endlist
1333
1334If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348.cindex "case of local parts"
1349.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366.ilist
1367.cindex affix "router precondition"
1368The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373of any other conditions.
1374.next
1375Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378address.
1379Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384.next
1385If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390.next
1391Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394.next
1395Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397.next
1398If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399of domains that it defines.
1400.next
1401.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1403.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1404.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1405.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1406.cindex affix "router precondition"
1407If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1408the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1409&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1410part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1411that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1412.new
1413that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1414&$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1415and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1416.wen
1417.next
1418.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1419.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1420.vindex "&$home$&"
1421If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1422an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1423local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1424user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1425remaining preconditions.
1426.next
1427If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1428because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1429later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1430subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1431could lead to confusion.
1432.next
1433If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1434set of addresses that it defines.
1435.next
1436If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1437specified files is tested.
1438.next
1439.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1440If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1441uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1442Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1443.endlist
1444
1445
1446Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1447it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1448part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1449&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1450&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1451going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1452example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1453
1454
1455
1456.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1457.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1458When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1459
1460.ilist
1461If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1462filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1463message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1464fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1465files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1466filtering'&.
1467.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1468(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1469
1470Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1471&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1472filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1473if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1474be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1475condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1476filter.
1477.next
1478Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1479its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1480address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1481can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1482processed entirely independently of each other.
1483.next
1484.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1485.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1486A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1487transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1488is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1489Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1490from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1491process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1492which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1493.next
1494When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1495handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1496doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1497local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1498collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1499addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1500address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1501addresses to the same domain.
1502.next
1503Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1504non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1505deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1506to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1507run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1508one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1509The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1510deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1511.next
1512.cindex "queue runner"
1513When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1514database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1515address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1516Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1517reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1518queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1519follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1520better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1521causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1522.next
1523.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1524Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1525deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1526retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1527reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1528not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1529.next
1530If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1531appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1532for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1533messages to other addresses.
1534.next
1535.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1536If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1537the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1538&'deferred'&.
1539.next
1540When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1541handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1542deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1543.endlist
1544
1545
1546
1547
1548.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1549.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1550.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1551.cindex "queue runner"
1552Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1553attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1554uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1555intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1556not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1557first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1558its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1559passed its retry time.
1560You can run several queue runners at once.
1561
1562Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1563address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1564should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1565bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1566error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1567as permanent.
1568
1569
1570
1571.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1572.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1573There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1574particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1575connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1576detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1577Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1578is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1579impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1580also apply.
1581
1582If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1583waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1584connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1585deferred,
1586.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1587Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1588SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1589for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1590connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1591one connection.
1592
1593
1594
1595.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1596.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1597.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1598When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1599bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1600errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1601delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1602many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1603attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1604message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1605See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1606
1607.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1608Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1609failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1610automatically.
1611
1612.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1613A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1614obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1615address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1616forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1617failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1618&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1619of the list.
1620
1621
1622
1623.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1624.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1625If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1626itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1627but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1628that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1629for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1630&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1631
1632
1633
1634
1635
1636. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1637. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1638
1639.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1640.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1641
1642.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1643Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1644creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1645&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1646
1647.table2 140pt
1648.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1649.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1650 documented"
1651.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1652.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1653.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1654.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1655 instructions"
1656.endtable
1657
1658Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1659following subdirectories are created:
1660
1661.table2 140pt
1662.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1663.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1664.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1665.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1666.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1667.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1668.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1669.endtable
1670
1671The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1672with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1673that may be useful to some sites.
1674
1675
1676.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1677.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1678The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1679a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1680source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1681Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1682system.
1683.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1684Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1685the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1686architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1687overridden if necessary.
1688.cindex compiler requirements
1689.cindex compiler version
1690A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1691
1692
1693.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1694.cindex "PCRE library"
1695Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1696modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1697install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1698system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1699process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1700headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1701and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1702or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1703If your operating system has no
1704PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1705from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1706More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1707
1708.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1709.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1710.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1711Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1712DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1713databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1714different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1715
1716.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1717.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1718.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1719.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1720If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1721Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1722may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1723you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1724
1725.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1726Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1727via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1728versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1729some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1730distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1731versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1732Berkeley DB library.
1733
1734Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1735use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1736possibilities:
1737
1738.olist
1739A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1740Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1741.next
1742.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1743The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1744compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1745&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1746filename is used unmodified.
1747.next
1748.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1749The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1750operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1751programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1752.next
1753If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1754file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1755the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1756.next
1757To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1758Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17592.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1760Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1761Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1762&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1763page with far newer versions listed.
1764It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1765Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1766suited to Exim's usage model.
1767.next
1768.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1769Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1770&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1771operates on a single file.
1772.endlist
1773
1774.cindex "USE_DB"
1775.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1776Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1777to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1778USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1779&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1780.code
1781USE_DB=yes
1782.endd
1783Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1784error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1785
1786At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1787thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1788configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1789Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1790configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1791&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1792
1793As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1794necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1795in one of these lines:
1796.code
1797DBMLIB = -ldb
1798DBMLIB = -ltdb
1799.endd
1800Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1801place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1802the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1803file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1804this example:
1805.code
1806INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1807DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1808.endd
1809There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1810file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1811
1812
1813
1814.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1815.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1816.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1817.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1818.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1819Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1820independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1821&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1822&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1823therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1824building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1825&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1826
1827There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1828without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1829(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1830(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1831maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1832a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1833
1834There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1835at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1836machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1837directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1838you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1839detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1840be logged.
1841
1842.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1843Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1844access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1845facilities, you need to set
1846.code
1847WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1848.endd
1849in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1850chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1851
1852
1853.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1854.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1855If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1856required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1857your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1858happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1859&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1860
1861This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1862operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1863to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1864configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1865defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1866do this.
1867
1868
1869
1870.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1871.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1872.cindex "RFC 2047"
1873The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1874described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1875in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1876character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1877mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1878(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1879supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1880
1881However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1882very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1883&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1884systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1885&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1886.code
1887HAVE_ICONV=yes
1888.endd
1889to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1890
1891
1892
1893.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1894.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1895.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1896.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1897.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1898Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1899command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1900start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1901&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1902line option).
1903
1904If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1905OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1906implementing SSL.
1907
1908If you do not want TLS support you should set
1909.code
1910DISABLE_TLS=yes
1911.endd
1912in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1913
1914If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1915.code
1916USE_OPENSL=yes
1917TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1918.endd
1919in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1920OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1921.code
1922USE_OPENSSL=yes
1923TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1924TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1925.endd
1926.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1927If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1928.code
1929USE_OPENSSL=yes
1930USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1931.endd
1932.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1933If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1934.code
1935USE_GNUTLS=yes
1936TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1937.endd
1938in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1939library and include files. For example:
1940.code
1941USE_GNUTLS=yes
1942TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1943TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1944.endd
1945.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1946If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1947.code
1948USE_GNUTLS=yes
1949USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1950.endd
1951
1952You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1953specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1954given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1955
1956
1957
1958
1959.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1960
1961.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1962.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1963.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1964.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1965Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1966SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1967alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1968already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1969should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1970&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1971&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1972EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1973you might have
1974.code
1975USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1976CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1977EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1978.endd
1979in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1980files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1981.code
1982exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1983.endd
1984in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1985the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1986All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1987can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1988&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1989configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1990further details.
1991
1992
1993.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1994.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1995Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1996&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1997it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1998where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1999library files.
2000
2001Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2002defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2003currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2004as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2005over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2006Exim used to
2007have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2008withdrawn.
2009
2010
2011
2012.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2013.cindex "lookup modules"
2014.cindex "dynamic modules"
2015.cindex ".so building"
2016On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2017the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2018on demand.
2019This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2020library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2021dependencies.
2022Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2023
2024Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2025installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2026measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2027for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2028Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2029see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2030
2031Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2032&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2033For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2034on demand:
2035.code
2036LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2037LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2038LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2039.endd
2040
2041
2042.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2043.cindex "build directory"
2044Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2045created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2046operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2047For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2048&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2049.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2050Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2051
2052If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2053a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2054&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2055&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2056then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2057number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2058makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2059directory, should this ever be necessary.
2060
2061If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2062&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2063FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2064
2065
2066
2067.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2068The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2069unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2070output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2071appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2072each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2073get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2074.code
2075FULLECHO='' make -e
2076.endd
2077The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2078command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2079given in addition to the short output.
2080
2081
2082
2083.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2084.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2085The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2086consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2087values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2088more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2089convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2090order:
2091.display
2092&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2093&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2094&_Local/Makefile_&
2095&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2096&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2097&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2098&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2099.endd
2100.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2101.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2102.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2103where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2104architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2105process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2106and are often not needed.
2107
2108The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2109called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2110the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2111values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2112Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2113fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2114of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2115that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2116to find out what values are being used on your system.
2117
2118
2119&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2120therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2121needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2122file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2123default values are.
2124
2125
2126.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2127If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2128or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2129need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2130putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2131.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2132when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2133formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2134compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2135called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2136Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2137default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2138containing the lines
2139.code
2140CC=cc
2141CFLAGS=-std1
2142.endd
2143If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2144these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2145
2146Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2147files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2148the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2149
2150
2151.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2152.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2153.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2154.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2155Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2156lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2157not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2158and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2159which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2160case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2161.code
2162LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2163LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2164LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2165.endd
2166and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2167&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2168libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2169.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2170However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2171the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2172files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2173binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2174errors.
2175
2176.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2177.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2178Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2179about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2180being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2181makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2182variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2183name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2184&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2185with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2186syntax. For instance:
2187.code
2188LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2189LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2190AUTH_GSASL=yes
2191AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2192AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2193AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2194.endd
2195
2196.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2197Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2198subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2199.code
2200EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2201.endd
2202must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2203chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2204
2205.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2206The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2207operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2208with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2209monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2210The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2211.code
2212X11=/usr/X11R6
2213XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2214XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2215.endd
2216These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2217example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2218.code
2219X11=/usr/openwin
2220XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2221XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2222.endd
2223If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2224definition of all three of these variables into your
2225&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2226
2227.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2228If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2229variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2230default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2231command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2232
2233.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2234There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2235use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2236EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2237binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2238libraries.
2239
2240.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2241The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2242files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2243necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2244&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2245
2246
2247.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2248.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2249.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2250The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2251&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2252normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2253recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2254are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2255
2256
2257
2258.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2259.cindex "building Eximon"
2260A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2261where the files that are involved are
2262.display
2263&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2264&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2265&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2266&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2267&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2268&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2269.endd
2270.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2271As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2272&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2273&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2274variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2275EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2276LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2277.ecindex IIDbuex
2278
2279
2280.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2281.cindex "installing Exim"
2282.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2283The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2284arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2285whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2286.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2287The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2288going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2289&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2290install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2291some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2292it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2293chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2294
2295.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2296Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2297in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2298exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2299by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2300is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2301alternative files, no default is installed.
2302
2303.cindex "system aliases file"
2304.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2305One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2306default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2307The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2308SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2309If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2310and outputs a comment to the user.
2311
2312The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2313aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2314kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2315&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2316Exim's configuration if necessary.
2317
2318The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2319and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2320running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2321directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2322other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2323over SMTP.
2324
2325It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2326distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2327command such as
2328.code
2329make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2330.endd
2331This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2332paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2333configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2334For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2335but this usage is deprecated.
2336
2337.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2338Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2339&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2340upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2341directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2342INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2343
2344For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2345to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2346installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2347for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2348called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2349of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2350from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2351
2352.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2353If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2354real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2355command:
2356.code
2357make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2358.endd
2359The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2360script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2361the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2362directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2363command:
2364.code
2365(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2366.endd
2367.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2368There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2369
2370.ilist
2371&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2372to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2373.next
2374&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2375installed binary.
2376.endlist
2377
2378INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2379.code
2380make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2381.endd
2382The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2383to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2384without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2385.code
2386make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2387.endd
2388
2389
2390
2391.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2392.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2393Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2394reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2395distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2396&<<SECTavail>>&).
2397
2398If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2399source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2400install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2401
2402
2403
2404.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2405.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2406When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2407exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2408directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2409necessary.
2410
2411
2412
2413
2414.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2415.cindex "testing" "installation"
2416Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2417syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2418Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2419.code
2420exim -bV
2421.endd
2422If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2423Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2424the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2425other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2426Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2427example,
2428.display
2429&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2430.endd
2431should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2432.display
2433&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2434.endd
2435a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2436This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2437user agent. For example:
2438.code
2439exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2440From: user@your.domain.example
2441To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2442Subject: Testing Exim
2443
2444This is a test message.
2445^D
2446.endd
2447The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2448In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2449arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2450
2451.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2452If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2453&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2454of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2455&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2456with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2457.display
2458&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2459.endd
2460You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2461produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2462For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2463relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2464&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2465
2466.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2467.cindex "lock files"
2468One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2469local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2470&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2471writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2472is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2473directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2474that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2475&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2476approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2477&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2478agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2479see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2480
2481One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2482the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2483&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2484port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2485&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2486incoming SMTP mail.
2487
2488Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2489be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2490within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2491that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2492production version.
2493
2494
2495.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2496.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2497Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2498general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2499is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2500operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2501binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2502normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2503or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2504.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2505a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2506privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2507and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2508
2509.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2510.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2511Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2512example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2513&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2514described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2515as follows:
2516.code
2517sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2518send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2519mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2520newaliases /usr/bin/true
2521.endd
2522Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2523your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2524favourite user agent.
2525
2526You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2527have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2528various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2529command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2530use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2531&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2532
2533
2534
2535.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2536.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2537If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2538version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2539call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2540.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2541.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2542to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2543new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2544version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2545configuration file.
2546
2547
2548
2549
2550.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2551.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2552The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2553.code
2554/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2555.endd
2556If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2557fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2558for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2559(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2560solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2561.code
2562pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2563.endd
2564to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2565
2566Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2567still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2568(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2569
2570
2571
2572
2573. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2574. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2575
2576.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2577.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2578.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2579Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2580each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2581options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2582some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2583combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2584The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2585
2586
2587.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2588.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2589If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2590were present before any other options.
2591The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2592standard output.
2593This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2594that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2595&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2596
2597.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2598If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2599were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2600&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2601format.
2602
2603.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2604If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2605&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2606Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2607
2608.cindex "&'runq'&"
2609.cindex "queue runner"
2610If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2611were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2612option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2613
2614.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2615.cindex "alias file" "building"
2616.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2617If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2618&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2619This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2620the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2621command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2622
2623
2624.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2625Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2626available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2627user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2628EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2629&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2630
2631.ilist
2632.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2633.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2634The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2635&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2636supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2637configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2638
2639.cindex '&"From"& line'
2640.cindex "envelope from"
2641.cindex "envelope sender"
2642Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2643&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2644Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2645See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2646users to set envelope senders.
2647
2648.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2649.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2650.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2651.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2652For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2653header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2654&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2655
2656Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2657protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2658locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2659have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2660users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2661that are available to trusted users.
2662.next
2663.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2664.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2665The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2666Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2667The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2668
2669Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2670operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2671necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2672the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2673
2674By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2675Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2676However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2677option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2678
2679Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2680is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2681false.
2682.endlist
2683
2684
2685&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2686edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2687getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2688&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2689
2690
2691
2692
2693.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2694Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2695of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2696a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2697format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2698on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2699with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2700outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2701
2702. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2703. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2704. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2705. creates a man page for the options.
2706. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2707
2708.literal xml
2709<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2710.literal off
2711
2712
2713.vlist
2714.vitem &%--%&
2715.oindex "--"
2716.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2717This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2718therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2719rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2720
2721.vitem &%--help%&
2722.oindex "&%--help%&"
2723This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2724The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2725no arguments.
2726
2727.vitem &%--version%&
2728.oindex "&%--version%&"
2729This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2730displayed.
2731
2732.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2733 &%-Am%&
2734.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2735.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2736These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2737ignored by Exim.
2738
2739.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2740.oindex "&%-B%&"
2741.cindex "8-bit characters"
2742.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2743This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2744clean; it ignores this option.
2745
2746.vitem &%-bd%&
2747.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2748.cindex "daemon"
2749.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2750.cindex "queue runner"
2751This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2752the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2753that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2754
2755The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2756(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2757disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2758stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2759
2760By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2761all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2762ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2763&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2764
2765When a listening daemon
2766.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2767.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2768is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2769configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2770in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2771PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2772running as root.
2773
2774When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2775process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2776used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2777
2778The SIGHUP signal
2779.cindex "SIGHUP"
2780.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2781.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2782.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2783.cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2784.cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2785.cindex reload configuration
2786can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2787whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2788means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2789of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2790referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2791because these are reread each time they are used.
2792
2793.vitem &%-bdf%&
2794.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2795This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2796from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2797
2798.vitem &%-be%&
2799.oindex "&%-be%&"
2800.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2801.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2802Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2803prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2804files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2805of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2806
2807If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2808to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2809used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2810function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2811test data. A line history is supported.
2812
2813Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2814continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2815continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2816string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2817configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2818message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2819is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2820
2821&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2822files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2823the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2824of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2825
2826Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2827defined and macros will be expanded.
2828Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2829available to admin users.
2830
2831.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2832.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2833.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2834.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2835This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2836of a file. For example:
2837.code
2838exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2839.endd
2840The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2841message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2842variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2843no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2844recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2845&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2846line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2847&%-be%&).
2848
2849.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2850.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2851.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2852.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2853This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2854tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2855system filters are recognized.
2856
2857.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2858.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2859.cindex "filter" "testing"
2860.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2861.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2862.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2863.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2864This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2865to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2866there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2867supplied.
2868
2869If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2870can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2871filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2872.code
2873exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2874.endd
2875This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2876variables that are used by the user filter.
2877
2878If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2879.code
2880# Exim filter
2881# Sieve filter
2882.endd
2883it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2884that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2885&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2886redirection lists.
2887
2888The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2889detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2890with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2891separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2892
2893When testing a filter file,
2894.cindex "&""From""& line"
2895.cindex "envelope from"
2896.cindex "envelope sender"
2897.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2898the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2899or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2900that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2901can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2902options).
2903
2904.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2905.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2906.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2907This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2908tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2909&$qualify_domain$&.
2910
2911.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2912.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2913This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2914tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2915process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2916suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2917actually being delivered.
2918
2919.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2920.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2921.cindex affix "filter testing"
2922This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2923file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2924prefix.
2925
2926.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2927.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2928.cindex affix "filter testing"
2929This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2930file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2931suffix.
2932
2933.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2934.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2935.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2936.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2937.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2938.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2939.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2940.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2941This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2942standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2943after a full stop. For example:
2944.code
2945exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2946exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2947.endd
2948When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2949of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2950conversion to the canonical form is
2951&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2952
2953Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2954include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2955This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2956messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2957test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2958
2959&*Warning 1*&:
2960.cindex "RFC 1413"
2961You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2962information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2963an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2964connection.
2965
2966&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2967are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2968occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2969
2970Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2971written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2972lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2973can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2974and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2975session were authenticated.
2976
2977The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2978output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2979acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2980
2981Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2982plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2983specialized SMTP test program such as
2984&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2985
2986.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2987.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2988This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2989verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2990updating the callout cache database.
2991
2992.vitem &%-bi%&
2993.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2994.cindex "alias file" "building"
2995.cindex "building alias file"
2996.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2997Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2998Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2999this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3000tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3001recognized.
3002
3003If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3004configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3005the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3006The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3007use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3008if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3009&%-bi%& is a no-op.
3010
3011. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3012.vitem &%-bI:help%&
3013.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3014.cindex "querying exim information"
3015We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3016information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3017consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3018synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3019options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3020
3021.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3022.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3023.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3024This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3025recognised DSCP names.
3026
3027.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3028.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3029.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3030This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3031Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3032useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3033&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3034compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3035way to guarantee a correct response.
3036
3037.vitem &%-bm%&
3038.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3039.cindex "local message reception"
3040This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3041locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3042command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3043argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3044default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3045if no other conflicting option is present.
3046
3047If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3048qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3049options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3050suppressing this for special cases.
3051
3052Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3053the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3054
3055.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3056The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3057action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3058
3059The format
3060.cindex "message" "format"
3061.cindex "format" "message"
3062.cindex "&""From""& line"
3063.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3064.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3065of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3066compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3067.code
3068From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3069From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3070.endd
3071(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3072is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3073authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3074matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3075option, which can be changed if necessary.
3076
3077.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3078The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3079&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3080preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3081trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3082
3083.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3084.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3085.cindex "testing", "malware"
3086.cindex "malware scan test"
3087This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3088(depending on the used scanner interface),
3089using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3090this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3091the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3092not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3093will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3094
3095Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3096using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3097user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3098This option requires admin privileges.
3099
3100The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3101there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3102administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3103
3104.vitem &%-bnq%&
3105.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3106.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3107By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3108without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3109is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3110envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3111&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3112defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3113
3114Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3115being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3116content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3117header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3118syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3119
3120The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3121messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3122addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3123unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3124
3125
3126.vitem &%-bP%&
3127.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3128.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3129.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3130If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3131main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3132of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3133arguments, for example:
3134.code
3135exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3136.endd
3137.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3138.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3139.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3140However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3141configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3142users, the output is as in this example:
3143.code
3144mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3145.endd
3146If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3147output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3148
3149If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3150configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3151backward compatibility.)
3152If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3153is the name of the file that was actually used.
3154
3155.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3156If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3157name will not be output.
3158
3159.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3160.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3161If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3162directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3163respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3164sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3165written directly into the spool directory.
3166
3167If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3168.code
3169exim -bP +local_domains
3170.endd
3171it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3172local part) and outputs what it finds.
3173
3174.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3175.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3176.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3177If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3178followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3179that driver are output. For example:
3180.code
3181exim -bP transport local_delivery
3182.endd
3183The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3184options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3185using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3186&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3187settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3188&%authenticators%&.
3189
3190.cindex "environment"
3191If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3192variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3193variables.
3194
3195.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3196If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3197are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3198for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3199The output format is one item per line.
3200For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3201the exit status will be nonzero.
3202
3203.vitem &%-bp%&
3204.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3205.cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3206.cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3207This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3208standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3209just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3210admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3211to allow any user to see the queue.
3212
3213Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3214.code
321525m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3216 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3217 <other addresses>
3218.endd
3219.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3220.cindex "size" "of message"
3221The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3222(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3223identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3224envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3225&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3226the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3227before the sender address.
3228
3229.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3230If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3231&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3232
3233The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3234displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3235been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3236expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3237displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3238complete.
3239
3240
3241.vitem &%-bpa%&
3242.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3243This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3244that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3245alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3246of just &"D"&.
3247
3248
3249.vitem &%-bpc%&
3250.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3251.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3252This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3253to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3254&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3255
3256
3257.vitem &%-bpr%&
3258.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3259This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3260chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3261lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3262going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3263
3264.vitem &%-bpra%&
3265.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3266This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3267
3268.vitem &%-bpru%&
3269.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3270This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3271
3272
3273.vitem &%-bpu%&
3274.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3275This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3276addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3277forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3278router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3279
3280
3281.vitem &%-brt%&
3282.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3283.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3284.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3285This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3286arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3287and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3288.code
3289exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3290Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3291.endd
3292See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3293argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3294&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3295contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3296retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3297with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3298rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3299sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3300used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3301.code
3302exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3303Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3304.endd
3305
3306.vitem &%-brw%&
3307.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3308.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3309.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3310This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3311a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3312complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3313would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3314&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3315
3316.vitem &%-bS%&
3317.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3318.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3319.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3320This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3321for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3322submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3323input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3324input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3325&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3326believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3327
3328The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3329dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3330provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3331
3332As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3333messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3334Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3335&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3336
3337Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3338as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3339QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3340
3341.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3342If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3343error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3344was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3345was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3346
3347More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3348&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3349
3350.vitem &%-bs%&
3351.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3352.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3353.cindex "local SMTP input"
3354This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3355on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3356policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3357Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3358messages to the MTA.
3359
3360In
3361.cindex "sender" "source of"
3362this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3363set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3364Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3365the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3366&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3367&%-bnq%& option is used.
3368
3369.cindex "inetd"
3370The
3371&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3372using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3373whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3374&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3375above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3376Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3377the listening daemon.
3378
3379.vitem &%-bt%&
3380.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3381.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3382.cindex "address" "testing"
3383This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3384as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3385written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3386user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3387sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3388
3389If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3390right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3391
3392Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3393&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3394security issues.
3395
3396Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3397(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3398written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3399&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3400genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3401program.
3402
3403.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3404The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3405failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3406code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3407
3408.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3409&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3410addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3411This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3412always shown.
3413
3414&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3415routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3416message,
3417.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3418you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3419&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3420default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3421whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3422those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3423doing such tests.
3424
3425.vitem &%-bV%&
3426.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3427.cindex "version number of Exim"
3428This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3429number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3430It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3431specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3432name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3433
3434As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3435configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3436values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3437detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3438alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3439realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3440dynamic testing facilities.
3441
3442.vitem &%-bv%&
3443.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3444.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3445.cindex "address" "verification"
3446This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3447taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3448not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3449happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3450(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3451including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3452
3453If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3454failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3455usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3456
3457If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3458right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3459
3460Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3461&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3462security issues.
3463
3464Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3465that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3466router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3467verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3468address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3469
3470If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3471address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3472latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3473causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3474addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3475and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3476to succeed.
3477
3478When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3479and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3480considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3481
3482The
3483.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3484return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3485failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3486code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3487
3488If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3489address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3490sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3491calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3492
3493.vitem &%-bvs%&
3494.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3495This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3496than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3497might happen.
3498
3499.vitem &%-bw%&
3500.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3501.cindex "daemon"
3502.cindex "inetd"
3503.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3504This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3505similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3506and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3507
3508In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3509listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3510inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3511each port only when the first connection is received.
3512
3513If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3514which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3515
3516.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3517.oindex "&%-C%&"
3518.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3519.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3520.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3521This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3522list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3523compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3524but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3525file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3526proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3527
3528When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3529from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3530runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3531However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3532file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3533which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3534listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3535CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3536not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3537
3538Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3539configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3540even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3541running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3542delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3543test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3544in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3545
3546If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3547prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3548must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3549However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3550CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3551usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3552unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3553
3554ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3555to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3556broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3557configuration file.
3558
3559The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3560syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3561caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3562require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3563specified by this option.
3564
3565
3566.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3567.oindex "&%-D%&"
3568.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3569This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3570(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3571unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3572If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3573completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3574
3575If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3576colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3577supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3578not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3579the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3580to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3581regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3582
3583The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3584command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3585string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3586synonymous:
3587.code
3588exim -DABC ...
3589exim -DABC= ...
3590.endd
3591To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3592quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3593example:
3594.code
3595exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3596.endd
3597&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3598Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3599
3600
3601.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3602.oindex "&%-d%&"
3603.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3604.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3605This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3606error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3607database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3608filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3609writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3610return code.
3611
3612When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3613standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3614some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3615made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3616of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3617debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3618no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3619are:
3620.display
3621&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3622&`auth `& authenticators
3623&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3624&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3625&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3626&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3627&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3628&`filter `& filter handling
3629&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3630&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3631&`ident `& ident lookup
3632&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3633&`lists `& matching things in lists
3634&`load `& system load checks
3635&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3636 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3637&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3638&`memory `& memory handling
3639&`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3640&`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3641&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3642&`queue_run `& queue runs
3643&`receive `& general message reception logic
3644&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3645&`retry `& retry handling
3646&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3647&`route `& address routing
3648&`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3649&`tls `& TLS logic
3650&`transport `& transports
3651&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3652&`verify `& address verification logic
3653&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3654.endd
3655The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3656for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3657tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3658is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3659generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3660turn everything off.
3661
3662.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3663.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3664The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3665with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3666unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3667rather than stderr.
3668
3669The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3670&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3671However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3672daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3673automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3674run in parallel.
3675
3676The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3677of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3678in processing.
3679
3680.cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3681.cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3682The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3683UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3684When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3685Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3686
3687If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3688any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3689
3690.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3691.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3692This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3693starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3694subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3695behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3696
3697.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3698.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3699This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3700handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3701described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3702
3703.vitem &%-E%&
3704.oindex "&%-E%&"
3705.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3706This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3707failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3708and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3709generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3710could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3711follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3712new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3713
3714.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3715.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3716There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3717called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3718example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3719form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3720
3721.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3722.oindex "&%-F%&"
3723.cindex "sender" "name"
3724.cindex "name" "of sender"
3725This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3726message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3727entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3728their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3729between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3730
3731.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3732.oindex "&%-f%&"
3733.cindex "sender" "address"
3734.cindex "address" "sender"
3735.cindex "trusted users"
3736.cindex "envelope from"
3737.cindex "envelope sender"
3738.cindex "user" "trusted"
3739This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3740message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3741by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3742users to use it.
3743
3744Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3745trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3746options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3747of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3748domain.
3749
3750There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3751can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3752never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3753string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3754examples of shell commands:
3755.code
3756exim -f '<>' user@domain
3757exim -f "" user@domain
3758.endd
3759In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3760with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3761&%-bv%& options.
3762
3763Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3764it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3765refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3766though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3767
3768White
3769.cindex "&""From""& line"
3770space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3771given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3772locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3773&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3774if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3775
3776.vitem &%-G%&
3777.oindex "&%-G%&"
3778.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3779This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3780.code
3781control = suppress_local_fixups
3782.endd
3783for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3784bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3785in future.
3786
3787As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3788this option.
3789
3790.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3791.oindex "&%-h%&"
3792.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3793This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3794Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3795headers.)
3796
3797.vitem &%-i%&
3798.oindex "&%-i%&"
3799.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3800.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3801This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3802line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3803no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3804command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3805
3806.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3807.oindex "&%-L%&"
3808.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3809This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3810file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3811Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3812read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3813effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3814
3815The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3816
3817.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3818.oindex "&%-M%&"
3819.cindex "forcing delivery"
3820.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3821.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3822This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3823any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3824delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3825and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3826
3827Retry
3828.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3829hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3830the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3831to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3832which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3833for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3834
3835The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3836not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3837produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3838use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3839
3840.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3841.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3842.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3843.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3844This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3845message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3846id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3847active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3848can be used only by an admin user.
3849
3850.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3851 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3852.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3853.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3854.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3855.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3856This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3857by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3858an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3859given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3860must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3861
3862.vitem &%-MCA%&
3863.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3864This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3865by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3866connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3867
3868.vitem &%-MCD%&
3869.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3870This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3871by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3872remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3873
3874.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3875.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3876This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3877by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3878alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3879
3880.vitem &%-MCK%&
3881.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3882This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3883by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3884remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3885
3886.vitem &%-MCP%&
3887.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3888This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3889by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3890which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3891
3892.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3893.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3894This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3895by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3896started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3897together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3898signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3899messages through the same SMTP connection.
3900
3901.vitem &%-MCS%&
3902.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3903This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3904by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3905SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3906connection.
3907
3908.vitem &%-MCT%&
3909.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3910This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3911by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3912host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3913
3914.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3915.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3916This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3917by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3918connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3919The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3920
3921.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3922.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3923.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3924.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3925This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3926but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3927that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3928provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3929order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3930However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3931respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3932overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3933If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3934&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3935and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3936
3937.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3938.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3939.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3940.cindex "sender" "changing"
3941This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3942given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3943&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3944be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3945is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3946This option can be used only by an admin user.
3947
3948.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3949.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3950.cindex "freezing messages"
3951.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3952This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3953prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3954either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3955However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3956attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3957user.
3958
3959.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3960.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3961.cindex "giving up on messages"
3962.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3963.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3964This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3965including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3966their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3967is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3968Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3969user.
3970
3971.vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3972.oindex "&%-MG%&"
3973.cindex queue named
3974.cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
3975.cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3976This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3977queue to the given named queue.
3978The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3979string to define the default queue.
3980If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3981a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3982
3983.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3984.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3985.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3986This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3987as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3988message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3989altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3990
3991.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3992.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3993.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3994.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3995.cindex "removing recipients"
3996This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3997(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3998the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3999addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4000(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4001can be used only by an admin user.
4002
4003.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4004.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
4005.cindex "removing messages"
4006.cindex "abandoning mail"
4007.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4008This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4009bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4010the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4011only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4012placed in the queue.
4013
4014. .new
4015. .vitem &%-MS%&
4016. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
4017. .cindex REQUIRETLS
4018. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4019. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4020. a bounce message.
4021. .wen
4022
4023.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4024.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4025.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4026.cindex "expansion" "testing"
4027This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4028string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4029the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4030&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4031available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4032make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4033user. See also &%-bem%&.
4034
4035.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4036.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4037.cindex "thawing messages"
4038.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4039.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4040.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4041This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4042&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4043messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4044by an admin user.
4045
4046.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4047.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4048.cindex "listing" "message body"
4049.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4050This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4051written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4052
4053.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4054.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4055.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4056.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4057This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4058be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4059only by an admin user.
4060
4061.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4062.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4063.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4064.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4065.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4066This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4067written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4068
4069.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4070.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4071.cindex "listing" "message log"
4072.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4073This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4074the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4075
4076.vitem &%-m%&
4077.oindex "&%-m%&"
4078This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4079treats it that way too.
4080
4081.vitem &%-N%&
4082.oindex "&%-N%&"
4083.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4084.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4085This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4086level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4087it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4088had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4089database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4090than &"=>"&.
4091
4092Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4093user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4094words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4095which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4096address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4097routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4098the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4099for that message.
4100
4101.vitem &%-n%&
4102.oindex "&%-n%&"
4103This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4104For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4105When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4106option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4107
4108.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4109.oindex "&%-O%&"
4110This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4111Exim.
4112
4113.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4114.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4115.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4116This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4117alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4118description above.
4119
4120.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4121.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4122.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4123.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4124.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4125This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4126be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4127transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4128
4129.vitem &%-odb%&
4130.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4131.cindex "background delivery"
4132.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4133This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4134including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4135messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4136delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4137processes to finish.
4138
4139When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4140leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4141and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4142This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4143
4144If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4145(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4146overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4147setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4148
4149.vitem &%-odf%&
4150.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4151.cindex "foreground delivery"
4152.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4153This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4154accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4155&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4156and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4157
4158The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4159process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4160during deliveries.
4161
4162However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4163false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4164
4165If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4166message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4167process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4168restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4169
4170
4171.vitem &%-odi%&
4172.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4173This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4174Sendmail.
4175
4176.vitem &%-odq%&
4177.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4178.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4179.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4180.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4181This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4182including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4183not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4184are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4185process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4186&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4187conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4188forces queueing.
4189
4190.vitem &%-odqs%&
4191.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4192.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4193.cindex "first pass routing"
4194This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4195However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4196&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4197configuration file is in effect.
4198
4199When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4200message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4201also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4202in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4203done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4204runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4205messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4206host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4207configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4208&%-qq%& option.
4209
4210.vitem &%-oee%&
4211.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4212.cindex "error" "reporting"
4213If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4214example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4215message.
4216
4217.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4218Provided
4219this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4220exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4221is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4222This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4223
4224.vitem &%-oem%&
4225.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4226.cindex "error" "reporting"
4227.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4228This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4229return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4230This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4231
4232.vitem &%-oep%&
4233.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4234.cindex "error" "reporting"
4235If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4236error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4237.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4238The return code is 1 for all errors.
4239
4240.vitem &%-oeq%&
4241.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4242.cindex "error" "reporting"
4243This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4244effect as &%-oep%&.
4245
4246.vitem &%-oew%&
4247.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4248.cindex "error" "reporting"
4249This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4250effect as &%-oem%&.
4251
4252.vitem &%-oi%&
4253.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4254.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4255This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4256line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4257single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4258lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4259&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4260
4261.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4262.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4263This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4264
4265.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4266.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4267.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4268A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4269with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4270over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4271&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4272other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4273
4274The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4275number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4276.code
4277exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4278.endd
4279An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4280followed by a colon and the port number:
4281.code
4282exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4283.endd
4284The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4285port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4286are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4287whichever one is last.
4288
4289.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4290.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4291.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4292See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4293option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4294name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4295This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4296authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4297
4298.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4299.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4300.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4301See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4302option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4303This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4304where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4305&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4306
4307.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4308.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4309.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4310See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4311option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4312overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4313messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4314default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4315specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4316&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4317
4318.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4319.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4320.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4321See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4322option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4323using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4324&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4325
4326.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4327.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4328.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4329See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4330option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4331delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4332messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4333abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4334running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4335
4336The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4337The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4338is sending the bounce.
4339
4340.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4341.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4342.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4343.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4344See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4345option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4346&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4347or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4348SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4349&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4350one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4351be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4352
4353.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4354.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4355.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4356See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4357option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4358present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4359uses the name it is given.
4360
4361.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4362.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4363.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4364See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4365option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4366local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4367used, when there is no default.
4368
4369.vitem &%-om%&
4370.oindex "&%-om%&"
4371.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4372In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4373message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4374expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4375
4376.vitem &%-oo%&
4377.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4378.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4379This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4380whatever that means.
4381
4382.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4383.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4384.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4385.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4386This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4387value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4388written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4389without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4390because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4391
4392.new
4393.vitem &%-oPX%&
4394.oindex "&%-oPX%&"
4395.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4396.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4397This option is not intended for general use.
4398The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4399combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4400It causes the pid file to be removed.
4401.wen
4402
4403.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4404.oindex "&%-or%&"
4405.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4406This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4407set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4408by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4409described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4410
4411.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4412.oindex "&%-os%&"
4413.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4414.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4415This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4416applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4417the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4418for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4419
4420.vitem &%-ov%&
4421.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4422This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4423
4424.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4425.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4426.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4427.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4428.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4429This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4430is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4431of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4432in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4433file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4434
4435.vitem &%-pd%&
4436.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4437.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4438This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4439chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4440option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4441needed.
4442
4443.vitem &%-ps%&
4444.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4445.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4446This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4447chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4448option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4449started.
4450
4451.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4452.oindex "&%-p%&"
4453For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4454.display
4455&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4456.endd
4457It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4458host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4459Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4460to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4461or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4462Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4463
4464.vitem &%-q%&
4465.oindex "&%-q%&"
4466.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4467This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4468configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4469relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4470and &%-S%& options).
4471
4472.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4473If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4474the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4475waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4476for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4477process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4478have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4479
4480If
4481.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4482.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4483.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4484the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4485passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4486proceeding.
4487
4488When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4489process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4490mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4491this to be repeated periodically.
4492
4493Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4494random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4495If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4496MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4497
4498It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4499order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4500&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4501
4502.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4503The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4504behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4505appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4506
4507.vitem &%-qq...%&
4508.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4509.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4510.cindex "queue" "routing"
4511.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4512.cindex "first pass routing"
4513An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4514stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4515every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4516transports are run.
4517
4518.new
4519Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4520.wen
4521
4522.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4523The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4524is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4525complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4526place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4527delivered down a single SMTP
4528.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4529.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4530.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4531connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4532This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4533intermittently.
4534
4535.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4536.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4537.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4538If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4539those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4540delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4541&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4542
4543.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4544.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4545.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4546.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4547If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4548message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4549their retry times are tried.
4550
4551.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4552.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4553.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4554If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4555frozen or not.
4556
4557.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4558.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4559.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4560The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4561be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4562for later delivery.
4563
4564.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4565.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4566.cindex queue named
4567.cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4568.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4569If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4570queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4571The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4572For a periodic queue run (see below)
4573append to the name a slash and a time value.
4574
4575If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4576will specify a queue to operate on.
4577For example:
4578.code
4579exim -bp -qGquarantine
4580mailq -qGquarantine
4581exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4582.endd
4583
4584.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4585When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4586lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4587starting message id. For example:
4588.code
4589exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4590.endd
4591Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4592second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4593are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4594.code
4595exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4596.endd
4597just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4598&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4599that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4600mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4601are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4602queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4603
4604.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4605.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4606.cindex "periodic queue running"
4607When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4608starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4609(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4610&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4611single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4612combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4613.code
4614/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4615.endd
4616Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4617process every 30 minutes.
4618
4619When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4620pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4621
4622.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4623.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4624This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4625compatibility.
4626
4627.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4628.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4629This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4630
4631.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4632.oindex "&%-R%&"
4633.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4634.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4635.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4636The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4637is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4638which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4639<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4640
4641This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4642perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4643queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4644address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4645way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4646regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4647
4648If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4649you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4650.code
4651exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4652.endd
4653This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4654every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4655applied to each queue run.
4656
4657Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4658are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4659information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4660means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4661existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4662address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4663will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4664information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4665address will be skipped.
4666
4667.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4668If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4669all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4670&'ff'& is present.
4671
4672The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4673to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4674command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4675effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4676an arbitrary command instead.
4677
4678.vitem &%-r%&
4679.oindex "&%-r%&"
4680This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4681
4682.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4683.oindex "&%-S%&"
4684.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4685.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4686This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4687message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4688conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4689has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4690
4691.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4692.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4693This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4694recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4695&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4696
4697.vitem &%-t%&
4698.oindex "&%-t%&"
4699.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4700.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4701.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4702.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4703When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4704input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4705from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4706from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4707takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4708
4709.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4710If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4711is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4712the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4713and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4714Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4715Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4716argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4717Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4718instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4719&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4720
4721.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4722If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4723recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4724lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4725with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4726&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4727
4728RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4729message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4730added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4731not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4732nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4733In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4734are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4735once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4736&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4737
4738.vitem &%-ti%&
4739.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4740This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4741compatibility with Sendmail.
4742
4743.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4744.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4745.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4746.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4747This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4748incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4749&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4750&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4751
4752
4753.vitem &%-U%&
4754.oindex "&%-U%&"
4755.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4756Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4757documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4758syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4759set. Exim ignores this option.
4760
4761.vitem &%-v%&
4762.oindex "&%-v%&"
4763This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4764describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4765receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4766dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4767the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4768selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4769unconditional.
4770
4771.vitem &%-x%&
4772.oindex "&%-x%&"
4773AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4774National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4775It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4776this option.
4777
4778.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4779.oindex "&%-X%&"
4780This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4781to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4782
4783.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4784.oindex "&%-z%&"
4785This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4786Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4787Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4788under most shells.
4789.endlist
4790
4791.ecindex IIDclo1
4792.ecindex IIDclo2
4793
4794
4795. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4796. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4797. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4798. creates a man page for the options.
4799. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4800
4801.literal xml
4802<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4803.literal off
4804
4805
4806
4807
4808
4809. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4810. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4811
4812
4813.chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4814 "The runtime configuration file"
4815
4816.cindex "runtime configuration"
4817.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4818.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4819.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4820.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4821.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4822Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4823binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4824because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4825control.
4826
4827If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4828writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4829The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4830errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4831not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4832actually alter the string.
4833
4834The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4835reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4836most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4837give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4838existing file in the list.
4839
4840.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4841.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4842.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4843.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4844.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4845.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4846The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4847specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4848configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4849group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4850CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4851
4852&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4853to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4854easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4855CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4856who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4857
4858Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4859be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4860since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4861compromise the Exim user account.
4862
4863A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4864is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4865defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4866configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4867CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4868&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4869configuration.
4870
4871
4872
4873.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4874.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4875A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4876option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4877&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4878unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4879CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4880is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4881is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4882installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4883specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4884
4885Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4886with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4887listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4888testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4889delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4890Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4891the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4892can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4893message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4894&%-M%&).
4895
4896If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4897prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4898start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4899There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4900filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4901
4902One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4903option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4904configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4905non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4906If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4907completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4908
4909The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4910to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4911necessarily be discarded.
4912WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4913considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4914values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4915is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4916transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4917values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4918
4919Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4920share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4921If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4922looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4923and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4924file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4925each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4926
4927In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4928different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4929help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4930
4931
4932
4933.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4934.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4935.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4936Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4937option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4938are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4939is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4940space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4941
4942.ilist
4943&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4944&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4945.next
4946.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4947&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4948are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4949.next
4950&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4951addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4952&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4953.next
4954&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4955define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4956&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4957.next
4958&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4959If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4960defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4961are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4962&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4963.next
4964&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4965when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4966chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4967.next
4968&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4969want to use this feature, you must set
4970.code
4971LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4972.endd
4973in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4974facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4975.endlist
4976
4977.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4978.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4979.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4980Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4981
4982Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4983leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4984# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4985and does not introduce a comment.
4986
4987Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4988the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4989backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4990lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4991appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4992
4993A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4994default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4995change settings as required.
4996
4997The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4998described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4999respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5000items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5001onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5002described.
5003
5004
5005
5006.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5007.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5008.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5009.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5010.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5011You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5012using this syntax:
5013.display
5014&`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5015&`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5016.endd
5017on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5018the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5019second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5020The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5021the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5022is required.
5023
5024Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5025configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5026If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5027because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5028
5029The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5030comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5031for example:
5032.code
5033hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5034 .include /some/file
5035.endd
5036Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5037process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5038inclusion appears.
5039
5040
5041
5042.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5043.cindex "macro" "description of"
5044.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5045If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5046&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5047definition, and must be of the form
5048.display
5049<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5050.endd
5051The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5052in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5053continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5054space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5055a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5056
5057Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5058definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5059ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5060
5061.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5062Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5063files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5064scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5065replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5066for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5067the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5068define
5069.display
5070&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5071&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5072.endd
5073but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5074error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5075before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5076consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5077line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5078comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5079
5080
5081.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5082Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5083(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5084&'='&. For example:
5085.code
5086MAC = initial value
5087...
5088MAC == updated value
5089.endd
5090Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5091subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5092the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5093Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5094.code
5095MAC = initial value
5096...
5097MAC == MAC and something added
5098.endd
5099This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5100from a number of other files.
5101
5102.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5103The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5104&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5105used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5106using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5107file to be ignored.
5108
5109
5110
5111.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5112As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5113up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5114strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5115.code
5116ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5117 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5118.endd
5119This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5120.code
5121data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5122.endd
5123In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5124address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5125section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5126
5127
5128.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5129Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5130differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5131All of these macros start with an underscore.
5132They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5133(see below).
5134
5135The following classes of macros are defined:
5136.display
5137&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5138&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5139&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5140&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5141&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5142&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5143&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5144&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5145&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5146&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5147&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5148&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5149.endd
5150
5151Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5152
5153
5154.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5155.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5156.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5157You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5158&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5159portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5160read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5161
5162The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5163be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5164that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5165line. Thus:
5166.code
5167.ifdef AAA
5168message_size_limit = 50M
5169.else
5170message_size_limit = 100M
5171.endif
5172.endd
5173sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5174(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5175otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5176is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5177obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5178
5179Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5180it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5181in this line"& will always be true.
5182
5183Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5184to clarify complicated nestings.
5185
5186
5187
5188.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5189.cindex "common option syntax"
5190.cindex "syntax of common options"
5191.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5192For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5193each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5194lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5195these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5196space) and then the value. For example:
5197.code
5198qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5199.endd
5200.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5201.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5202.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5203Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5204accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5205line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5206word &"hide"&. For example:
5207.code
5208hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5209.endd
5210For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5211.code
5212mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5213.endd
5214If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5215all instances of the same driver.
5216
5217The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5218that are found in option settings.
5219
5220
5221.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5222.cindex "format" "boolean"
5223.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5224.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5225.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5226Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5227different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5228the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5229if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5230boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5231&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5232the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5233.code
5234queue_only
5235queue_only = true
5236.endd
5237The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5238.code
5239no_queue_only
5240queue_only = false
5241.endd
5242You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5243
5244
5245
5246
5247.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5248.cindex "integer configuration values"
5249.cindex "format" "integer"
5250If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5251hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5252number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5253with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5254hexadecimal number.
5255
5256If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5257it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5258if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5259When the values
5260of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52611024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5262and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5263used.
5264
5265
5266.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5267.cindex "integer format"
5268.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5269If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5270interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5271Such options are always output in octal.
5272
5273
5274.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5275.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5276.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5277If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5278integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5279
5280
5281
5282.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5283.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5284.cindex "format" "time interval"
5285A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5286the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5287
5288.table2 30pt
5289.irow &%s%& seconds
5290.irow &%m%& minutes
5291.irow &%h%& hours
5292.irow &%d%& days
5293.irow &%w%& weeks
5294.endtable
5295
5296For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5297intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5298is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5299
5300
5301
5302.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5303.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5304.cindex "format" "string"
5305If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5306or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5307consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5308the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5309removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5310Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5311appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5312therefore equivalent:
5313.code
5314trusted_users = uucp:mail
5315trusted_users = uucp:\
5316 # This comment line is ignored
5317 mail
5318.endd
5319.cindex "string" "quoted"
5320.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5321If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5322double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5323continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5324
5325.table2 100pt
5326.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5327.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5328.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5329.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5330.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5331.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5332 character"
5333.endtable
5334
5335If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5336character, that character replaces the pair.
5337
5338Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5339insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5340trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5341current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5342in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5343and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5344
5345
5346.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5347.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5348Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5349by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5350circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5351is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5352strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5353However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5354backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5355within a quoted configuration string.
5356
5357
5358.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5359.cindex "user name" "format of"
5360.cindex "format" "user name"
5361.cindex "groups" "name format"
5362.cindex "format" "group name"
5363User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5364above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5365either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5366&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5367
5368
5369.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5370.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5371.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5372.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5373The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5374default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5375the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5376&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5377are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5378particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5379&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5380
5381In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5382input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5383&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5384in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5385on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5386start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5387example, the list
5388.code
5389local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5390.endd
5391contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5392
5393&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5394list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5395colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5396be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5397
5398.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5399.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5400.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5401Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5402introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5403with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5404character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5405above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5406.code
5407local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5408.endd
5409This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5410&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5411confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5412
5413.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5414.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5415It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5416code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5417must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5418are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5419sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5420interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5421generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5422.code
5423domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5424.endd
5425This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5426to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5427expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5428the value in quotes. For example:
5429.code
5430local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5431.endd
5432Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5433doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5434set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5435enclosing an empty list item.
5436
5437
5438
5439.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5440.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5441An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5442separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5443.code
5444senders = user@domain :
5445.endd
5446contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5447in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5448items, the second of which is empty:
5449.code
5450senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5451.endd
5452&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5453are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5454would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5455just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5456.code
5457senders = :
5458.endd
5459In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5460is at the end of the list.
5461
5462
5463
5464
5465.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5466.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5467There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5468and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5469instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5470a sequence of lines like this:
5471.display
5472<&'instance name'&>:
5473 <&'option'&>
5474 ...
5475 <&'option'&>
5476.endd
5477In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5478followed by three options settings:
5479.code
5480localuser:
5481 driver = accept
5482 check_local_user
5483 transport = local_delivery
5484.endd
5485For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5486setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5487settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5488deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5489a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5490described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5491
5492You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5493the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5494
5495The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5496passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5497transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5498authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5499them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5500server.
5501
5502.cindex "generic options"
5503.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5504Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5505and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5506same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5507&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5508.cindex "private options"
5509The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5510they all have default values.
5511
5512The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5513precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5514this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5515
5516Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5517elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5518with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5519a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5520instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5521confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5522configuration lines:
5523.code
5524remote_smtp:
5525 driver = smtp
5526.endd
5527create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5528&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5529different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5530instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5531thus:
5532.code
5533special_smtp:
5534 driver = smtp
5535 port = 1234
5536 command_timeout = 10s
5537.endd
5538The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5539these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5540lines.
5541
5542Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5543list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5544defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5545option.
5546
5547
5548
5549
5550
5551
5552. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5553. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5554
5555.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5556.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5557.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5558The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5559is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5560the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5561configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5562of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5563itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5564initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5565mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5566
5567
5568
5569.section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5570All macros should be defined before any options.
5571
5572One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5573.code
5574# ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5575.endd
5576If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5577hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5578later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5579deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5580
5581In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5582to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5583given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5584
5585
5586.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5587The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5588in the file, after the macros.
5589The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5590.code
5591# primary_hostname =
5592.endd
5593This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5594to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5595can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5596it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5597
5598The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5599.code
5600domainlist local_domains = @
5601domainlist relay_to_domains =
5602hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5603.endd
5604These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5605domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5606domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5607configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5608
5609The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5610later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5611on the local host.
5612
5613.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5614There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5615of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5616called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5617be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5618the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5619
5620The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5621list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5622controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5623domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5624domain is permitted.
5625
5626The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5627used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5628that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5629loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5630submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5631hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5632
5633Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5634we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5635and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5636
5637The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5638.code
5639acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5640acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5641.endd
5642These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5643during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5644command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5645respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5646&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5647section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5648accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5649to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5650contents of a message to be checked.
5651
5652Two commented-out option settings are next:
5653.code
5654# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5655# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5656.endd
5657These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5658content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5659scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5660details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5661
5662Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5663.code
5664# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5665# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5666# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5667.endd
5668These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5669support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5670first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5671connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5672other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5673key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5674More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5675
5676Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5677.code
5678# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5679# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5680.endd
5681.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5682.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5683.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5684.cindex "submissions protocol"
5685.cindex "smtps protocol"
5686.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5687.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5688.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5689.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5690These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5691server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5692TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5693more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5694Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5695to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5696much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5697consequences).
5698RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5699which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5700RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5701which should be used in preference to 587.
5702You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5703these ports.
5704Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5705
5706Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5707.code
5708# qualify_domain =
5709# qualify_recipient =
5710.endd
5711The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5712complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5713receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5714the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5715you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5716addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5717
5718.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5719The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5720addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5721(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5722.code
5723# allow_domain_literals
5724.endd
5725The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5726Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5727quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5728try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5729people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5730&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5731
5732The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5733.code
5734never_users = root
5735.endd
5736It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5737convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5738setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5739The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5740list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5741FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5742contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5743FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5744
5745When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5746Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5747line,
5748.code
5749host_lookup = *
5750.endd
5751specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5752in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5753information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5754or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5755Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5756because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5757unreachable.
5758
5759The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
57601413 (hence their names):
5761.code
5762rfc1413_hosts = *
5763rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5764.endd
5765These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5766Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5767terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5768of an incoming SMTP connection.
5769If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5770information, you can change this.
5771
5772This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5773and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5774.code
5775prdr_enable = true
5776.endd
5777
5778When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5779be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5780if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5781find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5782.code
5783# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5784# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5785.endd
5786show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5787and recipient addresses, respectively.
5788
5789The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5790over the default:
5791.code
5792log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5793 +tls_certificate_verified
5794.endd
5795
5796The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5797.code
5798# percent_hack_domains =
5799.endd
5800It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5801This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5802anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5803
5804The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5805concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5806message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5807occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5808address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5809bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5810are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5811always bounce messages.
5812.code
5813ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5814timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5815.endd
5816The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5817discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5818message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5819after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5820bounce message ever lasts a week.
5821
5822Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5823large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5824directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5825many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5826Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5827not often needed).
5828.code
5829# split_spool_directory = true
5830.endd
5831
5832In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5833messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5834characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5835violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5836In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5837problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5838check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5839.code
5840# check_rfc2047_length = false
5841.endd
5842
5843If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
58448BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5845that are not 8-bit clean.
5846.code
5847# accept_8bitmime = false
5848.endd
5849
5850Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5851imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5852&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5853&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5854Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5855option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5856.code
5857# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5858# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5859.endd
5860
5861
5862.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5863.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5864.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5865In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5866It starts with the line
5867.code
5868begin acl
5869.endd
5870and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5871&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5872and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5873
5874.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5875The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5876RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5877are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5878rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5879result of the ACL processing.
5880.code
5881acl_check_rcpt:
5882.endd
5883This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5884ACL, and names it.
5885.code
5886accept hosts = :
5887.endd
5888This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5889But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5890names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5891list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5892host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5893important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5894
5895What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5896messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5897input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5898manner.
5899.code
5900deny message = Restricted characters in address
5901 domains = +local_domains
5902 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5903
5904deny message = Restricted characters in address
5905 domains = !+local_domains
5906 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5907.endd
5908These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5909characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5910Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5911&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5912in Internet mail addresses.
5913
5914The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5915addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5916option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5917in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5918programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5919at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5920characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5921policy of being as safe as possible.
5922
5923The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5924to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5925first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5926&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5927reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5928&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5929
5930The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5931block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5932or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5933have to modify this rule.
5934
5935Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5936allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5937common convention of local parts constructed as
5938&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5939the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5940with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5941filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5942that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5943is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5944
5945The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5946allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5947and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5948with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5949local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5950and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5951(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5952.code
5953accept local_parts = postmaster
5954 domains = +local_domains
5955.endd
5956This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5957local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5958&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5959reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5960&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5961
5962The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5963by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5964in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5965.code
5966require verify = sender
5967.endd
5968This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5969ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5970address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5971see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5972addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5973used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5974discusses the details of address verification.
5975.code
5976accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5977 control = submission
5978.endd
5979This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5980hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5981verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5982that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5983second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5984is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5985messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5986&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5987probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5988.code
5989accept authenticated = *
5990 control = submission
5991.endd
5992This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5993Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5994likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5995authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5996examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5997fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5998.code
5999require message = relay not permitted
6000 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6001.endd
6002This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6003one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6004.code
6005require verify = recipient
6006.endd
6007This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6008fails, the address is rejected.
6009.code
6010# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6011# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6012# $dnslist_text
6013# dnslists = black.list.example
6014#
6015# warn dnslists = black.list.example
6016# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6017# a black list at $dnslist_domain
6018# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6019.endd
6020These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6021sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6022from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6023line.
6024.code
6025# require verify = csa
6026.endd
6027This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6028authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6029records.
6030.code
6031accept
6032.endd
6033The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6034address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6035.code
6036acl_check_data:
6037.endd
6038This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6039of this ACL are commented out:
6040.code
6041# deny malware = *
6042# message = This message contains a virus \
6043# ($malware_name).
6044.endd
6045These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6046viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6047suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6048virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6049.code
6050# warn spam = nobody
6051# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6052# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6053# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6054# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6055.endd
6056These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6057SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6058and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6059&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6060series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6061whatever the spam score.
6062.code
6063accept
6064.endd
6065This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6066
6067
6068.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6069.cindex "default" "routers"
6070.cindex "routers" "default"
6071The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6072by the line
6073.code
6074begin routers
6075.endd
6076Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6077messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6078accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6079matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6080manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6081.code
6082# domain_literal:
6083# driver = ipliteral
6084# domains = !+local_domains
6085# transport = remote_smtp
6086.endd
6087.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6088This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6089support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6090you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6091&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6092
6093Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6094macro has been defined, per
6095.code
6096.ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6097smarthost:
6098#...
6099.else
6100dnslookup:
6101#...
6102.endif
6103.endd
6104
6105If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6106command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6107perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6108skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6109
6110.code
6111smarthost:
6112 driver = manualroute
6113 domains = ! +local_domains
6114 transport = smarthost_smtp
6115 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6116 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6117 no_more
6118.endd
6119This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6120specified by the line
6121.code
6122domains = ! +local_domains
6123.endd
6124The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6125exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6126that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6127the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6128indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6129passed on to the following routers.
6130
6131The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6132specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6133While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6134be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6135
6136With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6137will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6138other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6139&<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6140are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6141and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6142&(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6143
6144.code
6145dnslookup:
6146 driver = dnslookup
6147 domains = ! +local_domains
6148 transport = remote_smtp
6149 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6150 no_more
6151.endd
6152The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6153
6154The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6155and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6156the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6157instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6158one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6159
6160The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6161DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6162router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6163specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6164in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6165the address fails and is bounced.
6166
6167The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6168be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6169encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6170whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6171Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6172email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6173continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6174out.
6175.code
6176system_aliases:
6177 driver = redirect
6178 allow_fail
6179 allow_defer
6180 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6181# user = exim
6182 file_transport = address_file
6183 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6184.endd
6185Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6186domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6187alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6188data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6189the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6190the next router.
6191
6192&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6193often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6194file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6195&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6196.code
6197userforward:
6198 driver = redirect
6199 check_local_user
6200# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6201# local_part_suffix_optional
6202 file = $home/.forward
6203# allow_filter
6204 no_verify
6205 no_expn
6206 check_ancestor
6207 file_transport = address_file
6208 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6209 reply_transport = address_reply
6210.endd
6211This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6212redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6213individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6214local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6215router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6216namely:
6217.code
6218# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6219# local_part_suffix_optional
6220.endd
6221.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6222show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6223is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6224by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6225variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6226presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6227the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6228
6229When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6230home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6231declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6232redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6233
6234.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6235Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6236files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6237is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6238of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6239filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6240separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6241
6242The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6243verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6244There are two reasons for doing this:
6245
6246.olist
6247Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6248checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6249unnecessary work.
6250.next
6251More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6252command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6253The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6254It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6255this time.
6256.endlist
6257
6258The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6259address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6260works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6261forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6262
6263The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6264forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6265auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6266.code
6267a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6268.endd
6269the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6270transport.
6271.code
6272localuser:
6273 driver = accept
6274 check_local_user
6275# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6276# local_part_suffix_optional
6277 transport = local_delivery
6278.endd
6279The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6280part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6281the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6282routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6283same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6284
6285
6286.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6287.cindex "default" "transports"
6288.cindex "transports" "default"
6289Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6290only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6291not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6292.code
6293begin transports
6294.endd
6295Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6296.code
6297remote_smtp:
6298 driver = smtp
6299 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6300.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6301 hosts_try_prdr = *
6302.endif
6303.endd
6304This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6305The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6306The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6307with over-long lines.
6308
6309The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6310negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6311but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6312use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6313
6314The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6315with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6316usual federated system.
6317
6318.code
6319smarthost_smtp:
6320 driver = smtp
6321 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6322 multi_domain
6323 #
6324.ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6325 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6326 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6327 hosts_require_tls = *
6328 tls_verify_hosts = *
6329 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6330 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6331 # or not:
6332 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6333 #
6334 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6335 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6336 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6337 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6338 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6339 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6340 #
6341.ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6342 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6343.endif
6344.ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6345 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6346.endif
6347.endif
6348.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6349 hosts_try_prdr = *
6350.endif
6351.endd
6352After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6353can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6354that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6355happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6356All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6357then no other options are defined.
6358If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6359and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6360used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6361Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6362from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6363mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6364the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6365to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6366ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6367You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6368should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6369
6370For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6371
6372All other options are defaulted.
6373.code
6374local_delivery:
6375 driver = appendfile
6376 file = /var/mail/$local_part_verified
6377 delivery_date_add
6378 envelope_to_add
6379 return_path_add
6380# group = mail
6381# mode = 0660
6382.endd
6383This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6384traditional BSD mailbox format.
6385
6386.new
6387We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6388as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6389Instead we use &$local_part_verified$&,
6390the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6391(done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6392.wen
6393
6394By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6395local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6396directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6397under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6398show how this can be done.
6399
6400Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6401&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6402similarly-named options above.
6403.code
6404address_pipe:
6405 driver = pipe
6406 return_output
6407.endd
6408This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6409redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6410option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6411be returned to the sender.
6412.code
6413address_file:
6414 driver = appendfile
6415 delivery_date_add
6416 envelope_to_add
6417 return_path_add
6418.endd
6419This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6420redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6421&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6422.code
6423address_reply:
6424 driver = autoreply
6425.endd
6426This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6427filter files.
6428
6429
6430
6431.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6432.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6433.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6434The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6435Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6436introduced by the line
6437.code
6438begin retry
6439.endd
6440In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6441errors:
6442.code
6443* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6444.endd
6445This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
64462 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
64471.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6448is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6449measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6450
6451If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6452if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6453temporary errors into permanent errors.
6454
6455
6456.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6457The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6458.code
6459begin rewrite
6460.endd
6461contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6462rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6463
6464
6465
6466.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6467.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6468The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6469.code
6470begin authenticators
6471.endd
6472defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6473configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6474which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6475standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6476mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6477to support most MUA software.
6478
6479The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6480.code
6481#PLAIN:
6482# driver = plaintext
6483# server_set_id = $auth2
6484# server_prompts = :
6485# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6486# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6487.endd
6488And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6489.code
6490#LOGIN:
6491# driver = plaintext
6492# server_set_id = $auth1
6493# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6494# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6495# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6496.endd
6497
6498The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6499in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6500&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6501that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6502i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6503when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6504when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6505need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6506
6507The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6508password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6509To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6510expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6511
6512Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6513usercode and password are in different positions.
6514Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6515
6516.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6517
6518
6519
6520. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6521. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6522
6523.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6524
6525.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6526.cindex "PCRE"
6527Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6528uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6529matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6530regular expressions is discussed in
6531online Perl manpages, in
6532many Perl reference books, and also in
6533Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6534O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6535. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6536. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6537. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6538
6539The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6540are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6541description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6542the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6543the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6544case-insensitive.
6545
6546In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6547it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6548or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6549second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6550.code
6551domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6552.endd
6553The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6554precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6555of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6556regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6557backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6558normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6559matched.
6560
6561There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6562recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6563string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6564these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6565it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6566match anywhere in the subject string.
6567
6568In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6569you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6570.code
6571domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6572.endd
6573matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6574You need to use:
6575.code
6576domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6577.endd
6578if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6579$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6580
6581
6582
6583. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6584. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6585
6586.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6587.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6588.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6589.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6590Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6591messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6592
6593.olist
6594A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6595cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6596lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6597can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6598&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6599The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6600.next
6601Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6602way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6603returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6604succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6605chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6606The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6607.endlist
6608
6609String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6610that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6611involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6612if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6613time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6614chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6615
6616.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6617It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6618lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6619processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6620Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6621.code
6622domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6623domains = lsearch;/some/file
6624.endd
6625The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6626No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6627defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6628The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6629file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6630.code
6631192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6632192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6633.endd
6634When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6635possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6636
6637In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6638Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6639in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6640.code
6641domain1:
6642domain2:
6643.endd
6644Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6645matches the list item.
6646
6647It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6648Consider a file containing lines like this:
6649.code
6650192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6651.endd
6652If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6653first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6654causes a second lookup to occur.
6655
6656The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6657available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6658lookup is permitted.
6659
6660
6661.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6662.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6663.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6664Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6665
6666.ilist
6667The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6668and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6669lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6670.next
6671.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6672The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6673key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6674Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6675.endlist
6676
6677The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6678the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6679default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6680.code
6681LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6682LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6683.endd
6684which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6685For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6686libraries and header files before building Exim.
6687
6688
6689
6690
6691.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6692.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6693.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6694The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6695
6696.ilist
6697.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6698.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6699.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6700&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6701string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6702indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6703re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6704aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6705tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6706.display
6707&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6708&url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6709&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6710&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6711.endd
6712A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6713because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6714However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6715you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6716.next
6717.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6718.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6719.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6720&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6721DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6722zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6723&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6724
6725.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6726For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6727when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6728using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6729the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6730that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6731other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6732.next
6733.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6734.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6735.cindex "sasldb2"
6736.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6737&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6738interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6739ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6740authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6741&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6742&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6743.next
6744.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6745.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6746.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6747.cindex "Courier"
6748.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6749.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6750&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6751is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6752if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6753other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6754use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6755calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6756utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6757by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6758.next
6759.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6760.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6761&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6762whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6763contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6764the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6765symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry.
6766.new
6767.cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6768It is regarded as untainted.
6769.wen
6770An example of how this
6771lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6772&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6773.next
6774.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6775.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6776&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6777terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6778file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6779IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6780being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6781.code
67821.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6783192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6784"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6785"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6786.endd
6787The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6788file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6789key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6790&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6791&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6792
6793&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6794&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6795lookup types support only literal keys.
6796
6797&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6798the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6799&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6800
6801&*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6802IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6803notation before executing the lookup.)
6804.next
6805.cindex lookup json
6806.cindex json "lookup type"
6807.cindex JSON expansions
6808&(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6809An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6810The key is a list of subelement selectors
6811(colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6812which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6813of the JSON structure.
6814If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6815nunbered array element is selected.
6816Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6817The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6818or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6819is returned.
6820For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6821.next
6822.cindex "linear search"
6823.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6824.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6825.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6826&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6827line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6828end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6829letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6830in the file is used.
6831
6832White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6833line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6834continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6835space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6836junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6837colon, for example:
6838.code
6839baduser: :fail:
6840.endd
6841Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6842middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6843that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6844wildcarding of any kind.
6845
6846.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6847.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6848In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6849characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6850If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6851matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6852contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6853quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6854quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6855
6856.next
6857.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6858.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6859.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6860&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6861the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6862&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6863reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6864aliases; the full map names must be used.
6865
6866.next
6867.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6868.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6869.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6870.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6871&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6872&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6873the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6874that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6875used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6876
6877.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6878Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6879file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6880&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6881
6882. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6883. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6884
6885.olist
6886The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6887.code
6888 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6889 *fish data for anythingfish
6890.endd
6891.next
6892The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6893example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6894.code
6895 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6896.endd
6897Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6898expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6899string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6900.code
6901 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6902.endd
6903The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6904expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6905For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6906.code
6907 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6908.endd
6909
6910If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6911either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6912ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6913colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6914escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6915
6916&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6917match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6918is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6919takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6920&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6921
6922.next
6923Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6924is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6925lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6926example:
6927.code
6928 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6929.endd
6930The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6931.endlist olist
6932
6933Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6934continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6935be followed by optional colons.
6936
6937&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6938&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6939lookup types support only literal keys.
6940
6941.next
6942.cindex "lookup" "spf"
6943If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6944(as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6945For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6946.endlist ilist
6947
6948
6949.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6950.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6951.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6952The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6953many of them are given in later sections.
6954
6955.ilist
6956.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6957.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6958&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6959are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6960records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6961.next
6962.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6963.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6964&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6965.next
6966.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6967.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6968&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6969returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6970that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6971called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6972any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6973.next
6974.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6975.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6976&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6977MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6978.next
6979.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6980.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6981&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6982the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6983.next
6984.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6985.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6986&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6987Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6988.next
6989.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6990.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6991.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6992&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6993lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6994success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6995lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6996password value. For example:
6997.code
6998*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6999.endd
7000.next
7001.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7002.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7003&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7004PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7005
7006.next
7007.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7008.cindex lookup Redis
7009&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7010passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7011
7012.next
7013.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7014.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7015&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
7016that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7017
7018.next
7019&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7020not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7021.next
7022.cindex "whoson lookup type"
7023.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7024. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
7025&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7026allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7027address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7028obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7029at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7030superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7031&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7032.code
7033require condition = \
7034 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7035.endd
7036The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7037the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7038this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7039one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7040.endlist
7041
7042
7043
7044.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7045.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7046Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7047completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7048reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7049options such as a list of local domains.
7050
7051When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7052of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7053temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7054or may give up altogether.
7055
7056
7057
7058.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7059.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7060.cindex "lookup" "default values"
7061.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7062.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7063.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7064In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7065that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7066
7067&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7068lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7069specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7070
7071If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7072and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7073provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7074
7075.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7076.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7077.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7078Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7079&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7080character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7081by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7082that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7083take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7084For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7085.code
7086data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7087.endd
7088Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7089looks up these keys, in this order:
7090.code
7091jane@eyre.example
7092*@eyre.example
7093*
7094.endd
7095The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7096&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7097complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7098Exim move on to try the next key.
7099
7100
7101
7102.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7103.cindex "partial matching"
7104.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7105.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7106.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7107.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7108The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7109match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7110being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7111information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7112domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7113a key in a DBM file is
7114.code
7115*.dates.fict.example
7116.endd
7117then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7118&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7119by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7120file.
7121
7122&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7123also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7124&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7125
7126Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7127keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7128be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7129partial matching keys
7130beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7131Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7132unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7133
7134Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7135the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7136is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7137is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7138fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7139start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7140remains.
7141
7142A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7143by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7144&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7145modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7146subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7147up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7148.code
71492250.dates.fict.example
7150*.2250.dates.fict.example
7151*.dates.fict.example
7152*.fict.example
7153.endd
7154As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7155finishes.
7156
7157.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7158.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7159The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7160changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7161formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7162parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7163.code
7164domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7165.endd
7166In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7167&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7168components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7169other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7170.code
7171domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7172.endd
7173For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7174&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7175
7176If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7177just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7178down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7179
7180.ilist
7181If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7182.next
7183If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7184example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7185.next
7186Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7187remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7188for &"*"& on its own.
7189.next
7190Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7191.endlist
7192
7193
7194If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7195&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7196this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7197specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7198prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7199lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7200&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7201
7202The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7203in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7204dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7205in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7206subject key is always followed by a dot.
7207
7208
7209
7210
7211.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7212.cindex "lookup" "caching"
7213.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7214Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7215lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7216of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7217single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7218
7219For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7220another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7221many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7222the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7223closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7224own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7225
7226The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7227strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7228complete.
7229
7230
7231
7232
7233.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7234.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7235.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7236When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7237is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7238the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7239.code
7240[name=$local_part]
7241.endd
7242will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7243For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7244.code
7245[name="$local_part"]
7246.endd
7247but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7248NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7249rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7250of the following form is provided:
7251.code
7252${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7253.endd
7254For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7255.code
7256[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7257.endd
7258See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7259operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7260lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7261
7262
7263
7264
7265.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7266.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7267.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7268.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7269The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7270of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7271an expansion string could contain:
7272.code
7273${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7274.endd
7275If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7276is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7277&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7278&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7279
7280The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7281and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7282If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7283
7284For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7285concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7286depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7287between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7288by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7289.code
7290${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7291.endd
7292It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7293white space is ignored.
7294For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7295an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7296separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7297
7298.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7299When the type is PTR,
7300the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7301&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7302.code
7303${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7304.endd
7305If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7306altered and nothing is added.
7307
7308.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7309.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7310For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7311each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7312port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7313The field separator can be modified as above.
7314
7315.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7316.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7317For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7318unless a field separator is specified.
7319To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7320For SPF records the
7321default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7322.code
7323${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7324${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7325${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7326.endd
7327It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7328white space is ignored.
7329
7330.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7331For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7332successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7333Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7334specified.
7335.code
7336${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7337.endd
7338
7339.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7340.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7341.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7342.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7343Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7344each followed by a comma,
7345that may appear before the record type.
7346
7347The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7348temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7349a defer-option modifier.
7350The possible keywords are
7351&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7352With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7353whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7354ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7355With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7356error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7357succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7358.code
7359${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7360${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7361.endd
7362Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7363yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7364
7365.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7366Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7367The possible keywords are
7368&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7369With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7370with the lookup.
7371With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7372is not labelled as authenticated data
7373is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7374The default is &"lax"&.
7375
7376See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7377
7378.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7379.cindex "DNS" timeout
7380Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7381The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7382(e.g. &"5s"&).
7383The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7384
7385Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7386The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7387The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7388
7389.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7390.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7391.cindex DNS TTL
7392Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7393The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7394value of the set of returned DNS records.
7395
7396
7397.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7398.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7399By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7400each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7401the pseudo-type MXH:
7402.code
7403${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7404.endd
7405In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7406returned.
7407
7408.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7409Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7410records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7411component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7412records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7413error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7414but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7415top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7416.code
7417${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7418${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7419.endd
7420Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7421the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7422the name servers for &%edu%&.
7423
7424You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7425top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7426sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7427given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7428for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7429such a list.
7430
7431.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7432A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7433records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7434&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7435not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7436result of a successful lookup such as:
7437.code
7438${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7439.endd
7440has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7441The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7442authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7443
7444.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7445The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7446and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7447(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7448.code
7449${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7450.endd
7451
7452
7453.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7454In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7455However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7456&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7457the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7458.code
7459${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7460${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7461${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7462.endd
7463In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7464the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7465to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7466case, it does not treat it as a list.
7467
7468The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7469in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7470different separator can be specified, as described above.
7471
7472
7473
7474
7475.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7476.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7477.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7478.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7479The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7480become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7481implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7482contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7483the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7484it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7485indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7486your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7487.code
7488LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7489LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7490LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7491LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7492LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7493.endd
7494If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7495same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7496
7497There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7498the way they handle the results of a query:
7499
7500.ilist
7501&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7502gives an error.
7503.next
7504&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7505Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7506.next
7507&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7508from all of them are returned.
7509.endlist
7510
7511
7512For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7513Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7514the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7515First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7516
7517
7518.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7519.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7520An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7521the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7522.code
7523data = ${lookup ldap \
7524 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7525 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7526.endd
7527.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7528The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7529secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7530encrypted TLS connection is used.
7531
7532With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7533LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7534See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7535
7536Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7537controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7538&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7539your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7540&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7541certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7542running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7543methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7544&_exim.conf_&.
7545
7546
7547.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7548.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7549Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7550and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7551within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7552reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7553
7554The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7555filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7556the string:
7557.code
7558* => \2A
7559( => \28
7560) => \29
7561\ => \5C
7562.endd
7563in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7564to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7565.code
7566! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7567.endd
7568are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7569.code
7570${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7571.endd
7572yields
7573.code
7574%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7575.endd
7576Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7577.code
7578a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7579.endd
7580The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7581base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7582by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7583.code
7584, + " \ < > ;
7585.endd
7586It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7587before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7588is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7589.code
7590${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7591.endd
7592yields
7593.code
7594%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7595.endd
7596Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7597.code
7598\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7599.endd
7600There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7601authentication below.
7602
7603
7604.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7605.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7606The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7607is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7608an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7609by starting it with
7610.code
7611ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7612.endd
7613If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7614used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7615taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7616colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7617handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7618returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7619are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7620Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7621failures, and timeouts.
7622
7623For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7624of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7625&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7626doubled. For example
7627.code
7628ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7629.endd
7630If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7631to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7632the local host) is used.
7633
7634If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7635a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7636&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7637to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7638not available.
7639
7640For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7641for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7642can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7643the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7644.code
7645ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7646.endd
7647When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7648&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7649.code
7650${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7651.endd
7652When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7653a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7654specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7655socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7656&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7657or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7658the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7659backup host.
7660
7661If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7662specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7663&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7664
7665.ilist
7666Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7667interface.
7668.next
7669Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7670.endlist
7671
7672
7673Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7674&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7675
7676
7677
7678.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7679.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7680The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7681information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7682be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7683spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7684when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7685them. The following names are recognized:
7686.display
7687&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7688&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7689&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7690&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7691&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7692&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7693&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7694&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7695.endd
7696The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7697&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7698must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7699library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7700
7701.cindex LDAP timeout
7702.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7703The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7704backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7705enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7706network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7707&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7708LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7709if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7710SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7711Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7712
7713The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7714set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7715
7716The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7717to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7718default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7719server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7720different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7721different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7722alternate list (colon-separated).
7723
7724Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7725values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7726.code
7727${lookup ldap
7728 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7729 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7730 {$value}fail}
7731.endd
7732The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7733any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7734which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7735non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7736
7737The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7738connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7739on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7740
7741When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7742removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7743some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7744quoting has two advantages:
7745
7746.ilist
7747It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7748DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7749.next
7750It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7751.endlist
7752
7753For example, a setting such as
7754.code
7755USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7756.endd
7757should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7758
7759Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7760expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7761field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7762does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7763.code
7764PASS=${quote:$3}
7765.endd
7766The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7767SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7768&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7769
7770
7771
7772.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7773.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7774The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7775as a sequence of values, for example
7776.code
7777cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7778.endd
7779The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7780search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7781the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7782values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7783you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7784directory.
7785
7786In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7787result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7788has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7789part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7790
7791If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7792strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7793quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7794backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7795Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7796(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7797Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7798output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7799same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7800
7801Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7802LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7803&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7804&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7805(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7806
7807.code
7808ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7809value1.1,value1,,2
7810
7811ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7812value two
7813
7814ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7815value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7816
7817ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7818attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7819
7820ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7821objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7822.endd
7823You can
7824make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7825results of LDAP lookups.
7826The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7827individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7828The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7829of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7830The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7831comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7832
7833
7834
7835
7836.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7837.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7838.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7839NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7840and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7841contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7842of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7843values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7844.code
7845[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7846.endd
7847might return the string
7848.code
7849name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7850home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7851.endd
7852(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7853.code
7854[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7855.endd
7856would just return
7857.code
7858Martin Guerre
7859.endd
7860with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7861for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7862operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7863
7864
7865
7866.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7867.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7868.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7869.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7870.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7871.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7872.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7873.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7874.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7875.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7876.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7877.cindex lookup Redis
7878Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7879and SQLite
7880databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7881might be
7882.code
7883${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7884 {$value}fail}
7885.endd
7886If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7887field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7888.code
7889${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7890 {$value}}
7891.endd
7892might be
7893.code
7894home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7895.endd
7896Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7897quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7898field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7899.code
7900Mister X
7901.endd
7902If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7903with a newline between the data for each row.
7904
7905
7906.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7907.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7908.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7909.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7910.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7911.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7912.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7913.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7914.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7915.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7916.cindex lookup Redis
7917If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7918&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7919or &%redis_servers%&
7920option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7921information.
7922(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7923queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7924&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7925For all but Redis
7926each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7927items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7928Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7929name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7930.code
7931hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7932.endd
7933Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7934&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7935option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7936.code
7937hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7938 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7939.endd
7940For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7941because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7942query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7943a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7944found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7945servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7946
7947For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7948own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7949If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7950information.
7951Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7952host, database number, and password.
7953.olist
7954The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7955port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7956higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7957.next
7958The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7959.next
7960The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7961.endlist
7962
7963The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7964convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7965respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7966itself are escaped with backslashes.
7967
7968The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7969escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7970
7971.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7972For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7973it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7974done by starting the query with
7975.display
7976&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7977.endd
7978Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7979.olist
7980If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7981global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7982of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7983taken from there.
7984.next
7985If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7986.endlist
7987The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7988Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7989successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7990
7991This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7992are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7993master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7994like this:
7995.code
7996mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7997 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7998 master/db/name/pw
7999.endd
8000In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8001.code
8002${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8003.endd
8004That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8005the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8006option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8007.code
8008${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
8009.endd
8010
8011
8012.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
8013For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8014causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8015socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8016An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8017the default value is &"exim"&.
8018The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8019.display
8020<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8021 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8022.endd
8023Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8024the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8025
8026No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8027the queries.
8028
8029If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8030or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8031
8032&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8033anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8034is zero because no rows are affected.
8035
8036
8037.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8038PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8039This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8040However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8041database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8042looks like this:
8043.code
8044hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8045.endd
8046In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8047given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8048visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8049
8050If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8051update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8052affected.
8053
8054.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8055.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8056.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8057SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8058addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8059daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8060of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8061separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8062contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8063.code
8064${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8065 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8066.endd
8067In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8068.code
8069domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8070 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8071.endd
8072The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8073quote, which it doubles.
8074
8075.cindex timeout SQLite
8076.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8077The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8078internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8079update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8080are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8081waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8082to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8083option.
8084
8085.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8086.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8087.cindex "redis lookup type"
8088Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8089Examples:
8090.code
8091${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8092${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8093.endd
8094
8095As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8096Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8097of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8098master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8099servers.
8100
8101When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8102immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8103to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8104reached.
8105
8106.ecindex IIDfidalo1
8107.ecindex IIDfidalo2
8108
8109
8110. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8111. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8112
8113.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8114 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8115 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8116.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8117A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8118email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8119contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8120are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8121arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8122
8123Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8124host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8125different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8126general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8127
8128Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8129support all the complexity available in
8130domain, host, address and local part lists.
8131
8132
8133
8134.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8135.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8136Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8137
8138&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8139splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8140
8141The result of
8142expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8143into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8144but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8145&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8146discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8147
8148
8149If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8150testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8151expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8152
8153If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8154other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8155misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8156the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8157expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8158.code
8159deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8160 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8161.endd
8162The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8163&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8164senders based on the receiving domain.
8165
8166
8167
8168
8169.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8170.cindex "list" "negation"
8171.cindex "negation" "in lists"
8172Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8173leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8174defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8175it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8176(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8177
8178The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8179subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8180subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8181subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8182was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8183.code
8184domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8185.endd
8186matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8187neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8188list is positive. However, if the setting were
8189.code
8190domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8191.endd
8192then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8193list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8194as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8195
8196Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8197the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8198item.
8199
8200
8201
8202.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8203.cindex "list" "filename in"
8204If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8205filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8206processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8207filenames are not allowed,
8208and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8209Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8210lines:
8211
8212.ilist
8213For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8214file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8215.next
8216Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8217address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8218white space or the start of the line. For example:
8219.code
8220not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8221.endd
8222.endlist
8223
8224Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8225file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8226is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8227so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8228
8229If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8230within the file is inverted. For example, if
8231.code
8232hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8233.endd
8234and the file contains the lines
8235.code
8236!a.b.c
8237*.b.c
8238.endd
8239then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8240any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8241
8242
8243
8244.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8245As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8246to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8247confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8248an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8249sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8250non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8251always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8252
8253If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8254list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8255in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8256&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8257
8258
8259
8260
8261.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8262.cindex "named lists"
8263.cindex "list" "named"
8264A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8265which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8266particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8267places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8268the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8269a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8270locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8271.code
8272domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8273.endd
8274Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8275for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8276configured with the line
8277.code
8278domains = +local_domains
8279.endd
8280The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8281except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8282.code
8283dnslookup:
8284 driver = dnslookup
8285 domains = ! +local_domains
8286 transport = remote_smtp
8287 no_more
8288.endd
8289The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8290the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8291respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8292equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8293.code
8294hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8295addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8296.endd
8297A named list may refer to other named lists:
8298.code
8299domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8300domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8301domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8302.endd
8303&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8304effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8305out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8306.code
8307domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8308domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8309.endd
8310The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8311list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8312means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8313.code
8314domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8315.endd
8316where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8317referenced lists if you can.
8318
8319.new
8320.cindex "hiding named list values"
8321.cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8322Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8323accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8324line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8325word &"hide"&. For example:
8326.code
8327hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8328.endd
8329.wen
8330
8331
8332Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8333address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8334lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8335.code
8336domains = +local_domains
8337.endd
8338on several of your routers
8339or in several ACL statements,
8340the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8341if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8342references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8343the same each time they are referenced.
8344
8345By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8346extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8347is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8348hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8349
8350
8351
8352.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8353.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8354.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8355At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8356configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8357write
8358.code
8359ALIST = host1 : host2
8360auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8361.endd
8362it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8363.code
8364auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8365.endd
8366Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8367list, and write
8368.code
8369hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8370auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8371.endd
8372the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8373.code
8374auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8375.endd
8376
8377
8378.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8379.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8380.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8381While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8382it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8383the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8384that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8385an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8386message. For example:
8387.code
8388domainlist special_domains = \
8389 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8390.endd
8391This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8392address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8393in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8394cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8395same list each time.
8396
8397By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8398cache the result anyway. For example:
8399.code
8400domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8401.endd
8402If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8403the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8404
8405
8406
8407.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8408.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8409.cindex "list" "domain list"
8410Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8411The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8412
8413.ilist
8414.cindex "primary host name"
8415.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8416.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8417.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8418.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8419If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8420as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8421possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8422differ only in their names.
8423.next
8424.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8425.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8426.cindex "domain literal"
8427If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8428in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8429only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8430&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8431control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8432In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8433.next
8434.cindex "@mx_any"
8435.cindex "@mx_primary"
8436.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8437.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8438If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8439has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8440.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8441&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8442are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8443local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8444but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8445preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8446
8447The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8448performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8449example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8450resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8451options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8452
8453Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8454patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8455list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8456ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8457on a router). For example:
8458.code
8459domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8460.endd
8461This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8462the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8463
8464The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8465host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8466contain negative items.
8467
8468Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8469be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8470list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8471.code
8472domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8473 an.other.domain : ...
8474.endd
8475so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8476involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8477.code
8478domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8479 an.other.domain ? ...
8480.endd
8481.next
8482.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8483.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8484.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8485If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8486are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8487domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8488list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8489matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8490list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8491&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8492
8493.next
8494.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8495.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8496If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8497expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8498function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8499Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8500default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8501with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8502are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8503
8504&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8505must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8506use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8507it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8508expression by expansion, of course).
8509.next
8510.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8511.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8512If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8513semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8514must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8515&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8516.code
8517domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8518.endd
8519The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8520key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8521only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8522is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8523or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8524&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8525other statements in the same ACL.
8526
8527.next
8528Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8529&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8530.code
8531domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8532.endd
8533This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8534works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8535
8536.next
8537.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8538Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8539a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8540original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8541select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8542value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8543expansion variable.
8544.next
8545If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8546semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8547pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8548chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8549.code
8550hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8551 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8552.endd
8553In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8554example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8555whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8556&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8557variable and can be referred to in other options.
8558.next
8559.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8560If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8561between the pattern and the domain.
8562.endlist
8563
8564Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8565.code
8566domainlist funny_domains = \
8567 @ : \
8568 lib.unseen.edu : \
8569 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8570 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8571 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8572 nis;domains.byname : \
8573 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8574.endd
8575There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8576an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8577explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8578but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8579patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8580patterns earlier.
8581
8582
8583
8584.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8585.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8586.cindex "list" "host list"
8587Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8588example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8589may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8590two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8591pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8592You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8593involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8594
8595
8596.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8597.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8598.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8599If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8600involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8601process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8602not used.
8603
8604.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8605The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8606the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8607
8608
8609
8610.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8611.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8612If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8613the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8614&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8615list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8616systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8617concerns.)
8618
8619The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8620inspecting its IP address:
8621
8622.ilist
8623If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8624with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8625to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8626&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8627This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8628with the IP address of the subject host.
8629
8630If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8631lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8632ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8633temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8634what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8635
8636.next
8637.cindex "@ in a host list"
8638If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8639domain name, as just described.
8640
8641.next
8642If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8643subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8644IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8645be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8646separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8647without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8648IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8649that can never match a client host.
8650
8651.next
8652.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8653If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8654the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8655interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8656.code
8657accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8658accept hosts = @[]
8659.endd
8660.next
8661.cindex "CIDR notation"
8662If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8663example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8664host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8665included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8666specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8667significant end of the address.
8668
8669&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8670of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8671address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8672addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8673.code
8674192.168.23.236/31
8675.endd
8676matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
867732 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8678matches.
8679
8680Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8681.code
8682recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8683 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8684.endd
8685The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8686appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8687For example:
8688.code
8689recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8690.endd
8691could make use of a file containing
8692.code
8693172.16.0.0/12
86943ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8695.endd
8696to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8697addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8698changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8699.code
8700recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8701 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8702.endd
8703The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8704list.
8705.endlist
8706
8707
8708
8709.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8710 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8711.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8712When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8713address, the pattern takes this form:
8714.display
8715&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8716.endd
8717For example:
8718.code
8719hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8720.endd
8721The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8722IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8723letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8724&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8725quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8726returned by the lookup is not used.
8727
8728.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8729.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8730Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8731patterns of this form:
8732.display
8733&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8734.endd
8735For example:
8736.code
8737net24-dbm;/networks.db
8738.endd
8739The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8740length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8741mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8742is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8743&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8744
8745When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8746of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8747terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8748to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8749recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8750(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8751For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8752converted using colons and not dots.
8753In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8754addresses are always used.
8755The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8756
8757Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8758colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8759However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8760configurations.
8761
8762&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8763IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8764the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8765case the IP address is used on its own.
8766
8767
8768
8769.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8770.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8771.cindex "unknown host name"
8772.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8773There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8774remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8775complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8776address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8777above.)
8778
8779If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8780patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8781Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8782DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8783Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8784effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8785Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8786
8787Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8788against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8789
8790By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8791if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8792&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8793are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8794security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8795for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8796Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8797discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8798found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8799
8800There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8801found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8802
8803.cindex "host" "alias for"
8804.cindex "alias for host"
8805As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8806of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8807
8808.ilist
8809.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8810If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8811the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8812&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8813requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8814expression.
8815.next
8816.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8817.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8818If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8819matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8820expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8821case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8822syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8823example,
8824.code
8825^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8826.endd
8827is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8828&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8829that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8830string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8831part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8832.code
8833sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8834.endd
8835&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8836&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8837example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8838required.
8839.endlist
8840
8841
8842
8843
8844.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8845.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8846While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8847name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8848from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8849behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8850
8851&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8852apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8853
8854.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8855.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8856Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8857lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8858Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8859does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8860To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8861&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8862not recognized in an indirected file).
8863
8864.ilist
8865If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8866cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8867.code
8868host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8869.endd
8870rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8871any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8872
8873.next
8874If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8875be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8876example:
8877.code
8878accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8879 192.168.4.5
8880.endd
8881accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8882whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8883name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8884.endlist
8885
8886Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8887list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8888list.
8889
8890.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8891 "SECTmixwilhos"
8892.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8893
8894This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8895as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8896wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8897
8898.ilist
8899If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8900IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8901addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8902.code
8903accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8904.endd
8905The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8906left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8907without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8908a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8909pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8910&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8911if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8912
8913.next
8914If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8915address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8916.code
8917accept hosts = *.friend.example
8918accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8919.endd
8920If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8921&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8922&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8923this section.
8924.endlist
8925
8926
8927.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8928 "SECTtemdnserr"
8929.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8930.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8931.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8932A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8933&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8934host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8935&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8936section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8937host lists such as whitelists.
8938
8939
8940
8941.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8942 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8943.cindex "unknown host name"
8944.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8945If a pattern is of the form
8946.display
8947<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8948.endd
8949for example
8950.code
8951dbm;/host/accept/list
8952.endd
8953a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8954lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8955is not used.
8956
8957&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8958keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8959addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8960&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8961two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8962lookup, both using the same file.
8963
8964
8965
8966.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8967If a pattern is of the form
8968.display
8969<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8970.endd
8971the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8972data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8973&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8974.code
8975hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8976 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8977.endd
8978The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8979can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8980use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8981operator.
8982
8983If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8984looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8985&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8986
8987Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8988host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8989&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8990still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8991effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8992See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8993
8994
8995
8996
8997
8998.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8999.cindex "list" "address list"
9000.cindex "address list" "empty item"
9001.cindex "address list" "patterns"
9002Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9003is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9004always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9005list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9006using this option setting:
9007.code
9008senders = :
9009.endd
9010The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9011data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9012detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9013and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9014
9015Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9016example:
9017.code
9018senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9019.endd
9020A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9021character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9022semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9023subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9024with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9025the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9026wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9027.code
9028deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9029 *@+hostile_domains:\
9030 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9031 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9032.endd
9033.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9034.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9035If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9036specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9037treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9038
9039If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9040contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9041address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9042domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9043is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9044.code
9045deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9046.endd
9047
9048The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9049address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9050senders:
9051
9052.ilist
9053.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9054.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9055If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9056done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9057You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9058as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9059to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9060.code
9061deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9062 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9063.endd
9064The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9065start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9066
9067.next
9068.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9069Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9070lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9071example:
9072.code
9073deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9074 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9075 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9076.endd
9077Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9078lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9079not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9080always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9081
9082Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9083cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9084panic log.
9085.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9086However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9087&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9088default. For example, with this lookup:
9089.code
9090accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9091.endd
9092the file could contains lines like this:
9093.code
9094user1@domain1.example
9095*@domain2.example
9096.endd
9097and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9098that are tried is:
9099.code
9100nimrod@jaeger.example
9101*@jaeger.example
9102*
9103.endd
9104&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9105would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9106
9107&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9108.code
9109deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9110deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9111.endd
9112The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9113because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9114domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9115.endlist
9116
9117
9118The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9119If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9120always fails.
9121
9122
9123.ilist
9124.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9125.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9126.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9127If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9128(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9129split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9130it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9131from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9132of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9133
9134.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9135The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9136keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9137patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9138even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9139with
9140.code
9141deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9142.endd
9143the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9144.code
9145baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9146.endd
9147to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9148
9149.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9150If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9151has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9152may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9153but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9154surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9155.code
9156aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9157 spammer3 : spammer4
9158.endd
9159As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9160doubling.
9161
9162If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9163of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9164list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9165might have entries like
9166.code
9167aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9168xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9169*: ^\d{8}$
9170.endd
9171in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9172local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9173each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9174chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9175
9176.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9177It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9178them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9179
9180.next
9181The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9182lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9183can only return a single list of local parts.
9184.endlist
9185
9186&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9187in these two examples:
9188.code
9189senders = +my_list
9190senders = *@+my_list
9191.endd
9192In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9193example it is a named domain list.
9194
9195
9196
9197
9198.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9199.cindex "case of local parts"
9200.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9201.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9202Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9203case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9204Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9205Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9206blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9207lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9208default.
9209
9210The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9211address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9212comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9213the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9214that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9215keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9216works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9217case-independent.
9218
9219.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9220To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9221an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9222part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9223longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9224lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9225performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9226become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9227
9228
9229
9230.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9231.cindex "list" "local part list"
9232.cindex "local part" "list"
9233Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9234lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9235setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9236set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9237case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9238matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9239&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9240option is case-sensitive from the start.
9241
9242If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9243comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9244only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9245Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9246that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9247&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9248Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9249types.
9250.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9251
9252
9253
9254
9255. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9256. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9257
9258.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9259.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9260Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9261them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9262
9263When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9264.cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9265when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9266start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9267below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9268escape character, as described in the following section.
9269
9270Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9271dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9272options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9273the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9274conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9275reasons,
9276.cindex "tainted data" expansion
9277.cindex expansion "tainted data"
9278and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9279is not permitted.
9280
9281
9282
9283.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9284.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9285An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9286backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9287character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9288If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9289required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9290the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9291
9292.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9293A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9294two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9295expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9296.code
9297deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9298.endd
9299On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9300without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9301string.
9302
9303
9304
9305.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9306.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9307A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9308expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9309carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9310octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9311backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9312encoding.
9313
9314These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9315in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9316and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9317
9318
9319.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9320.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9321.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9322.oindex "&%-be%&"
9323Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9324takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9325arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9326to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9327since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9328value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9329database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9330and &%nhash%&.
9331
9332Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9333instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9334using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9335
9336.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9337If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9338from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9339option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9340read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9341.code
9342exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9343.endd
9344The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9345Exim message identifier. For example:
9346.code
9347exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9348.endd
9349This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9350is therefore restricted to admin users.
9351
9352
9353.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9354.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9355A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9356alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9357(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9358used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9359instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9360the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9361that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9362its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9363from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9364taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9365being expanded.
9366
9367
9368
9369
9370.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9371The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9372between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9373outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9374white space is significant.
9375
9376.vlist
9377.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9378.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9379Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9380.code
9381$local_part
9382${domain}
9383.endd
9384The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9385characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9386&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9387section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9388given, the expansion fails.
9389
9390.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9391.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9392The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9393<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9394.code
9395${lc:$local_part}
9396.endd
9397The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9398leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9399below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9400one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9401string easier to understand.
9402
9403.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9404This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9405expansion item below.
9406
9407
9408.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9409.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9410.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9411The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9412arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9413Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9414arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9415and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9416are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9417a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9418the result of the expansion.
9419If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9420the expansion result is an empty string.
9421If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9422
9423
9424.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9425.cindex authentication "results header"
9426.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9427.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9428This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9429&'Authentication-Results:'&
9430header line.
9431The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9432will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9433Methods that might be present in the result include:
9434.code
9435none
9436iprev
9437auth
9438spf
9439dkim
9440.endd
9441
9442Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9443.code
9444 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9445.endd
9446This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9447
9448
9449.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9450 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9451.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9452.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9453.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9454The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9455The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9456the certificate. Supported fields are:
9457.display
9458&`version `&
9459&`serial_number `&
9460&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9461&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9462&`notbefore `& time
9463&`notafter `& time
9464&`sig_algorithm `&
9465&`signature `&
9466&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9467&`ocsp_uri `& list
9468&`crl_uri `& list
9469.endd
9470If the field is found,
9471<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9472otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9473variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9474is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9475
9476If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9477key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9478extracted is used.
9479
9480Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9481
9482The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9483output a Distinguished Name string which is
9484not quite
9485parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9486(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9487RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9488a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9489result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9490The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9491a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9492Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9493
9494The field selectors marked as "time" above
9495take an optional modifier of "int"
9496for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9497Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9498in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9499
9500The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9501newline-separated by default,
9502(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9503The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9504a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9505
9506The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9507prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9508Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9509which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9510if so the element tags are omitted.
9511
9512If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9513
9514.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9515 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9516.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9517This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9518This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9519.code
9520EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9521.endd
9522set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9523object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9524(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9525
9526There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9527
9528When compiling
9529a local function that is to be called in this way,
9530first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9531and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9532The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9533are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9534must have the following type:
9535.code
9536int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9537.endd
9538Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9539function should return one of the following values:
9540
9541&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9542into the expanded string that is being built.
9543
9544&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9545from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9546
9547&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9548taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9549
9550&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9551
9552When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9553you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9554configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9555
9556
9557.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9558.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9559.cindex "environment" "values from"
9560The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9561removed.
9562This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9563If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9564and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9565
9566Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9567appear, for example:
9568.code
9569${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9570.endd
9571This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9572{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9573
9574If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9575search failure.
9576If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9577search success.
9578
9579The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9580&%add_environment%& main section options.
9581
9582
9583.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9584 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9585.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9586.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9587The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9588white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9589must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9590The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9591.display
9592<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9593.endd
9594.vindex "&$value$&"
9595where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9596values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9597values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9598described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9599for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9600the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9601otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9602variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9603is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9604
9605If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9606key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9607extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9608yield &"2001"&:
9609.code
9610${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9611${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9612.endd
9613Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9614appear, for example:
9615.code
9616${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9617.endd
9618This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9619{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9620
9621.vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9622 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9623 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9624 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9625.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9626.cindex JSON expansions
9627The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9628white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9629must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9630The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9631.display
9632{ <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9633.endd
9634.vindex "&$value$&"
9635The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9636the spaces are optional.
9637Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9638For the &"json"& variant,
9639if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9640trailing quotes.
9641For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9642leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9643. XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9644
9645The results of matching are handled as above.
9646
9647
9648.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9649 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9650.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9651.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9652The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9653apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9654This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9655behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9656extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9657argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9658<&'string3'&> as before.
9659
9660The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9661separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9662The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9663counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9664number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9665number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9666expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9667provided. For example:
9668.code
9669${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9670.endd
9671yields &"42"&, and
9672.code
9673${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9674.endd
9675yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9676empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9677
9678
9679.vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9680 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9681 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9682 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9683.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9684.cindex JSON expansions
9685The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9686apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9687
9688Field selection and result handling is as above;
9689there is no choice of field separator.
9690For the &"json"& variant,
9691if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9692trailing quotes.
9693For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9694leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9695
9696
9697.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9698.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9699.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9700.vindex "&$item$&"
9701After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9702default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9703For each item
9704in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9705evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9706item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9707separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9708input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9709.code
9710${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9711.endd
9712yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9713to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9714
9715
9716.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9717.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9718.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9719This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9720early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9721(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9722
9723The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9724<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9725<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9726use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9727.code
9728${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9729.endd
9730The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9731or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9732Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9733function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9734first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9735.code
9736abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9737.endd
9738If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9739letters appear. For example:
9740.display
9741&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9742&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9743&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9744.endd
9745
9746.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9747 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9748 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9749 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9750 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9751 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9752 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9753 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9754.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9755.vindex "&$header_$&"
9756.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9757.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9758.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9759.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9760.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9761.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9762Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9763.code
9764$header_reply-to:
9765.endd
9766The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9767internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9768lines) may be present.
9769
9770The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9771the data in the header line is interpreted.
9772
9773.ilist
9774.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9775&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9776processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9777
9778.next
9779.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9780&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9781are multiple headers with a given name.
9782Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9783list-processing facilities can be used.
9784The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9785the content is &"raw"&.
9786
9787.next
9788.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9789&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9790or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9791character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9792&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9793.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9794produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9795what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9796
9797.next
9798&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9799standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9800be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9801returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9802&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9803a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9804.endlist ilist
9805
9806In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9807command of the following form:
9808.code
9809headers charset "UTF-8"
9810.endd
9811This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9812subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9813character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9814option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9815value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9816ISO-8859-1.
9817
9818Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9819any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9820&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9821if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9822
9823Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9824this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9825message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9826filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9827router or transport are not accessible.
9828
9829For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9830ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9831because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9832They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9833Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9834are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9835point they are added.
9836When any of the above ACLs ar
9837running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9838
9839Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9840following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9841this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9842white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9843expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9844expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9845section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9846header.)
9847
9848If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9849to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9850&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9851each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9852newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9853newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9854those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9855junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9856
9857.new
9858.cindex "tainted data"
9859When the headers are from an incoming message,
9860the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
9861.wen
9862
9863
9864.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9865.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9866.cindex &%hmac%&
9867This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9868shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9869RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9870&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9871cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9872or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9873present. For example:
9874.code
9875${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9876.endd
9877For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9878produces:
9879.code
9880dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9881.endd
9882As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9883an Exim configuration:
9884.code
9885SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9886.endd
9887In a router or a transport you could then have:
9888.code
9889headers_add = \
9890 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9891 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9892 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9893.endd
9894Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9895&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9896this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9897host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9898using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9899&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9900
9901
9902.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9903.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9904.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9905If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9906item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9907in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9908.code
9909${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9910.endd
9911The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9912true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9913be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9914case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9915&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9916
9917If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9918is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9919cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9920.code
9921condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9922.endd
9923you can use
9924.code
9925condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9926.endd
9927
9928
9929
9930.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9931.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9932.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9933This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9934folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9935For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9936
9937
9938
9939.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9940.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9941.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9942The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9943strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9944you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9945change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9946some of the braces:
9947.code
9948${length_<n>:<string>}
9949.endd
9950The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9951of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9952&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9953All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9954
9955
9956.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9957 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9958.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9959.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9960.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9961The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9962apart from an optional leading minus,
9963and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9964
9965After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9966default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9967
9968The first field of the list is numbered one.
9969If the number is negative, the fields are
9970counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9971The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9972then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9973
9974If the modulus of the
9975number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9976the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9977
9978For example:
9979.code
9980${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9981.endd
9982yields &"42"&, and
9983.code
9984${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9985.endd
9986yields &"result: 42"&.
9987
9988If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9989If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9990extracted is used.
9991You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9992
9993
9994.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9995 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9996This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9997described in the next item.
9998
9999.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10000 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10001.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10002.cindex "file" "lookups"
10003.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10004The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10005discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10006lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10007<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10008
10009If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10010a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10011other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10012in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10013out by the system administrator.
10014
10015.vindex "&$value$&"
10016If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10017During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10018lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10019level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10020the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10021string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10022lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10023original lookup fails.
10024
10025If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10026data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10027expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10028the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10029appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10030to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10031{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10032successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10033
10034For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10035search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10036type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10037&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10038
10039.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10040If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10041and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10042They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10043
10044This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10045.code
10046${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10047.endd
10048This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10049the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10050.code
10051${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10052 {$value}fail}
10053.endd
10054
10055
10056.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10057.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10058.vindex "&$item$&"
10059After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10060default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10061For each item
10062in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10063expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10064for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10065setting is not included in the output. For example:
10066.code
10067${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10068.endd
10069expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10070value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10071and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10072
10073.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10074.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10075.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10076The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10077<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10078if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10079can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10080.code
10081${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10082.endd
10083The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10084the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10085processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10086slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10087example,
10088.code
10089${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10090.endd
10091returns the string &"6/33"&.
10092
10093
10094
10095.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10096.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10097.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10098This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10099interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10100expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10101additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10102name of the subroutine, is nine.
10103
10104The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10105the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10106way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10107Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10108return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10109not its contents.
10110
10111If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10112with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10113Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10114
10115The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10116out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10117
10118
10119.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10120.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10121The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10122keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10123it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10124to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10125as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10126and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10127
10128.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10129 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10130.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10131This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10132checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10133yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10134empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10135prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10136version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10137variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10138
10139These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10140retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10141against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10142which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10143
10144The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10145string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10146result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10147whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10148is the expansion of the third argument.
10149
10150All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10151However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10152For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10153
10154.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10155.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10156.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10157.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10158The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10159then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10160the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10161newlines are left in the string.
10162String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10163you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10164the string expansion fails.
10165
10166The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10167locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10168
10169
10170
10171.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10172 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10173.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10174.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10175.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10176This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10177string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10178examples:
10179.code
10180${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10181${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10182.endd
10183For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10184For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10185a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10186number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10187optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10188example:
10189.code
10190${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10191.endd
10192Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10193one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10194both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10195unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10196and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10197is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10198extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10199.code
10200${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10201.endd
10202
10203The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10204and must be present if the argument is given.
10205Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10206Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10207The first defines whether (the default)
10208or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10209Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10210.code
10211${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10212.endd
10213The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10214.code
10215${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10216.endd
10217The default is to not use TLS.
10218If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10219
10220A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10221that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10222turns them into spaces:
10223.code
10224${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10225.endd
10226As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10227happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10228addition, the following errors can occur:
10229
10230.ilist
10231Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10232.next
10233Failure to connect the socket;
10234.next
10235Failure to write the request string;
10236.next
10237Timeout on reading from the socket.
10238.endlist
10239
10240By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10241you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10242errors occurs. For example:
10243.code
10244${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10245 {socket failure}}
10246.endd
10247You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10248expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10249and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10250if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10251non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10252
10253The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10254locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10255
10256
10257.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10258.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10259.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10260.vindex "&$value$&"
10261.vindex "&$item$&"
10262This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10263<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10264separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10265Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10266assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10267list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10268them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10269iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10270added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10271number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10272.code
10273${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10274.endd
10275The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10276can be found:
10277.code
10278${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10279.endd
10280At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10281restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10282expansion items.
10283
10284.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10285This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10286expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10287
10288.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10289 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10290.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10291.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10292The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10293split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10294in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10295executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10296a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10297
10298Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10299which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10300simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10301script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10302variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10303quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10304in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10305around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10306variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10307character.
10308
10309The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10310and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10311.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10312.vindex "&$value$&"
10313If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10314and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10315from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10316<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10317expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10318&$value$&.
10319
10320If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10321can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10322command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10323of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10324
10325.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10326The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10327In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10328troubleshoot:
10329.code
10330warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10331 log_message = Output of id: $value
10332.endd
10333If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10334shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10335.code
10336${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10337.endd
10338
10339.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10340The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10341remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10342.code
10343if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10344 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10345 ...
10346endif
10347.endd
10348If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10349the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10350commands.
10351
10352&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10353option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10354testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10355by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10356
10357The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10358out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10359
10360
10361.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10362.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10363.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10364This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10365option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10366modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10367into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10368a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10369.code
10370${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10371.endd
10372yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10373if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10374substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10375.code
10376${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10377.endd
10378yields &"defabc"&, and
10379.code
10380${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10381.endd
10382yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10383the regular expression from string expansion.
10384
10385The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10386rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10387
10388
10389.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10390.cindex sorting "a list"
10391.cindex list sorting
10392.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10393After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10394default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10395The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10396of a two-argument expansion condition.
10397The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10398The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10399if the first value should sort before the second value.
10400The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10401the element being placed in &$item$&,
10402to give values for comparison.
10403
10404The item result is a sorted list,
10405with the original list separator,
10406of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10407
10408Examples:
10409.code
10410${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10411.endd
10412sorts a list of numbers, and
10413.code
10414${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10415.endd
10416will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10417
10418
10419.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10420.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10421.cindex "substring extraction"
10422.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10423The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10424<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10425if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10426can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10427.code
10428${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10429.endd
10430The second number is optional (in both notations).
10431If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10432omitted.
10433
10434The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10435&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10436length required. For example
10437.code
10438${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10439.endd
10440If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10441null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10442length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10443given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10444
10445The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10446from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10447the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10448.code
10449${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10450.endd
10451yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10452length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10453the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10454.code
10455${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10456.endd
10457yields an empty string, but
10458.code
10459${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10460.endd
10461yields &"1"&.
10462
10463When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10464is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10465string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10466no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10467.code
10468${substr_-1:abcde}
10469${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10470.endd
10471yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10472
10473All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10474
10475
10476
10477.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10478 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10479.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10480.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10481This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10482argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10483matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10484replacement list. For example
10485.code
10486${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10487.endd
10488yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10489last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10490last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10491place.
10492
10493All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10494
10495.endlist
10496
10497
10498
10499.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10500.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10501For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10502the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10503The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10504following operations can be performed:
10505
10506.vlist
10507.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10508.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10509.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10510The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10511header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10512not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10513
10514The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10515
10516
10517.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10518.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10519.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10520The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
105212822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10522operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10523result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10524doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10525Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10526
10527It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10528separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10529character. For example:
10530.code
10531${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10532.endd
10533expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10534first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10535separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10536separator explicitly:
10537.code
10538${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10539.endd
10540
10541Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10542expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10543address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10544processing lists.
10545
10546To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10547a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10548unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10549email address separator. For the example header line:
10550.code
10551From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10552.endd
10553The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10554properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10555It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10556example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10557de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10558The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10559quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10560.code
10561# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10562=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10563user@example.com
10564# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10565Last:user@example.com
10566# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10567user@example.com
10568# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10569フィリップ@example.jp
10570.endd
10571
10572.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10573.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10574.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10575The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10576base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10577Only lowercase letters are used.
10578
10579.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10580.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10581.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10582The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10583The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10584
10585.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10586.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10587.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10588The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10589base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10590the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10591its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10592filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10593to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10594
10595.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10596.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10597.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10598The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10599environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10600identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10601string.
10602
10603.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10604.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10605.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10606.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10607.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10608This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10609
10610If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10611returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10612
10613
10614.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10615.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10616.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10617.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10618This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10619
10620
10621.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10622.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10623.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10624The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10625from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10626
10627
10628.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10629.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10630.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10631If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10632escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10633significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10634is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10635
10636.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10637.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10638.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10639If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10640they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10641Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10642
10643
10644.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10645.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10646.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10647.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10648These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10649expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10650arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10651logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10652integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10653C programming language):
10654.table2 70pt 300pt
10655.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10656.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10657.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10658.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10659.irow "" "and (&&)"
10660.irow "" "xor (^)"
10661.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10662.endtable
10663Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10664space is permitted before or after operators.
10665
10666For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10667hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10668decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10669permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10670times, which often do have leading zeros.
10671
10672A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10673or 1024*1024*1024,
10674respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10675a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10676
10677.display
10678&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10679&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10680&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10681&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10682&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10683&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10684&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10685&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10686&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10687&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10688&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10689.endd
10690
10691As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10692.code
10693deny message = Too many bad recipients
10694 condition = \
10695 ${if and { \
10696 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10697 { \
10698 < \
10699 {$recipients_count} \
10700 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10701 } \
10702 }{yes}{no}}
10703.endd
10704The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10705fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10706
10707
10708.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10709.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10710The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10711example,
10712.code
10713${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10714.endd
10715first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10716and then re-expands what it has found.
10717
10718
10719.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10720.cindex "Unicode"
10721.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10722.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10723.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10724The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10725email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10726to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10727UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10728converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10729the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10730
10731Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10732ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10733For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10734way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10735characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10736single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10737translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10738
10739
10740.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10741.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10742.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10743The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10744be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10745change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10746.code
10747${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10748.endd
10749See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10750abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10751
10752
10753
10754.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10755.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10756.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10757.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10758This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10759be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10760
10761
10762
10763.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10764.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10765.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10766This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10767escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10768as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10769byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10770
10771
10772.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10773.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10774.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10775This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10776of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10777A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10778Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10779
10780.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10781.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10782.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10783.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10784This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10785Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10786set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10787A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10788Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10789
10790
10791.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10792.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10793.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10794.cindex "lower casing"
10795.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10796.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10797This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10798.code
10799${lc:$local_part}
10800.endd
10801Case is defined per the system C locale.
10802
10803.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10804.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10805.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10806The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10807can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10808changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10809.code
10810${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10811.endd
10812See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10813&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10814when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10815All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10816
10817
10818.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10819.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10820.cindex "list" "item count"
10821.cindex "list" "count of items"
10822.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10823The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10824
10825
10826.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10827.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10828.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10829The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10830expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10831If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10832and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10833Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10834matching list is returned.
10835
10836
10837.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10838.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10839.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10840The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10841extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10842empty.
10843The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10844
10845
10846.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10847.cindex "masked IP address"
10848.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10849.cindex "CIDR notation"
10850.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10851.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10852If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10853slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10854expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10855masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10856the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10857.code
10858${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10859.endd
10860returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10861be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10862address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10863terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10864.code
10865${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10866.endd
10867returns the string
10868.code
108693ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10870.endd
10871Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10872
10873
10874.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10875.cindex "MD5 hash"
10876.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10877.cindex certificate fingerprint
10878.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10879The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10880as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10881
10882If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10883returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10884
10885
10886.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10887.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10888.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10889The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10890that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10891strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10892.code
10893${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10894.endd
10895See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10896
10897
10898.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10899.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10900.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10901.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10902The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10903is an empty string or
10904contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10905Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10906Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10907respectively For example,
10908.code
10909${quote:ab"*"cd}
10910.endd
10911becomes
10912.code
10913"ab\"*\"cd"
10914.endd
10915The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10916variable or a message header.
10917
10918.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10919.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10920This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10921required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10922example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10923If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10924(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10925
10926This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10927will likely use the quoting form.
10928Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10929
10930
10931.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10932.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10933This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10934query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10935the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10936.code
10937${quote_ldap:two * two}
10938.endd
10939returns
10940.code
10941two%20%5C2A%20two
10942.endd
10943For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10944yields an unchanged string.
10945
10946
10947.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10948.cindex "random number"
10949This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10950supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10951on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10952If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10953If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10954for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10955Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10956srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10957random().
10958
10959
10960.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10961.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10962This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10963dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10964dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10965for DNS. For example,
10966.code
10967${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10968${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10969.endd
10970returns
10971.code
109724.2.0.192
10973f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10974.endd
10975
10976
10977.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10978.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10979.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10980.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10981This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10982encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10983assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10984&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10985contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10986characters
10987.code
10988? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10989.endd
10990it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10991string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10992characters.
10993
10994
10995.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10996.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10997.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10998.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10999This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11000bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11001character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11002not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11003
11004&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11005access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11006to use this operator as well.
11007
11008
11009
11010.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11011.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11012.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11013.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11014The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11015characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11016variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11017
11018
11019.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11020.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11021.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11022.cindex certificate fingerprint
11023.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11024The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11025it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11026
11027If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11028returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11029
11030
11031.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11032 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11033 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11034.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11035.cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11036.cindex certificate fingerprint
11037.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11038.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11039.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11040The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11041and returns
11042it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11043
11044If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11045returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11046
11047The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11048(except for certificates, which are not supported).
11049Finally, if an underbar
11050and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11051member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11052Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11053
11054
11055.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11056 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11057.cindex "SHA3 hash"
11058.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11059.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11060The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11061and returns
11062it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11063
11064If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11065the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11066with 256 being the default.
11067
11068The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11069compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11070or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11071The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11072
11073
11074.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11075.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11076.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11077.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11078The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11079function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11080expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11081series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11082except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11083a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1108410-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11085&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11086can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11087
11088The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11089the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11090systems for files larger than 2GB.
11091
11092.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11093.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11094Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11095
11096
11097
11098.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11099.cindex "expansion" "string length"
11100.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11101.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11102The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11103decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11104All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11105
11106
11107.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11108.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11109.cindex "substring extraction"
11110.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11111The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11112can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11113that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11114.code
11115${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11116.endd
11117See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11118abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11119All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11120
11121.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11122.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11123.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11124This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11125seconds.
11126
11127.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11128.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11129.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11130The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11131represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11132number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11133&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11134
11135.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11136.cindex "case forcing in strings"
11137.cindex "string" "case forcing"
11138.cindex "upper casing"
11139.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11140.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11141This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11142Case is defined per the system C locale.
11143
11144.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11145.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11146.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11147.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11148.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11149.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11150This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11151In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11152final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11153If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11154the complexity will depend upon the task.
11155For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11156extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11157dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11158.code
11159condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11160.endd
11161(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11162literal question mark).
11163
11164.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11165 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11166 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11167 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11168.cindex expansion UTF-8
11169.cindex UTF-8 expansion
11170.cindex EAI
11171.cindex internationalisation
11172.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11173.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11174.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11175.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11176These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11177For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11178.endlist
11179
11180
11181
11182
11183
11184
11185.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11186.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11187The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11188while expanding strings:
11189
11190.vlist
11191.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11192.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11193.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11194Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11195condition.
11196
11197.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11198.cindex "numeric comparison"
11199.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11200There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11201are:
11202.display
11203&`= `& equal
11204&`== `& equal
11205&`> `& greater
11206&`>= `& greater or equal
11207&`< `& less
11208&`<= `& less or equal
11209.endd
11210For example:
11211.code
11212${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11213.endd
11214Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11215two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11216optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11217lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11218As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11219zero.
11220
11221In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11222<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1122310M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11224
11225
11226.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11227 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11228.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11229.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11230The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11231arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11232Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11233arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11234and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11235are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11236a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11237the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11238If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11239If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11240
11241.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11242.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11243.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11244This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11245a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11246(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11247false if zero.
11248An empty string is treated as false.
11249Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11250thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11251All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11252
11253When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11254make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11255For example:
11256.code
11257${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11258.endd
11259
11260
11261.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11262.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11263.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11264Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11265where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11266loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11267and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11268true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11269
11270Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11271
11272.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11273.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11274.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11275.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11276This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11277authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11278necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11279included in the binary.
11280
11281The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11282compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11283be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11284encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11285does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11286&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11287Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11288string in LDAP form is:
11289.code
11290{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11291.endd
11292If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11293be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11294.code
11295${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11296.endd
11297The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11298supported:
11299
11300.ilist
11301.cindex "MD5 hash"
11302.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11303&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11304printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11305length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11306(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11307hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11308comparison fails.
11309
11310.next
11311.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11312&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11313printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11314length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11315If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11316SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11317
11318.next
11319.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11320&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11321only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11322systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11323whatever its length.
11324
11325.next
11326.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11327&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11328use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11329modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11330.endlist
11331Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11332&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11333HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11334operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11335the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11336support &[crypt16()]&.
11337
11338Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11339it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11340turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11341&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11342algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11343
11344However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11345functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11346Exim is seen as very low priority.
11347
11348If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11349comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11350determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11351default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11352function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11353
11354.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11355.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11356.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11357The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11358variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11359variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11360.code
11361${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11362.endd
11363Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11364variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11365
11366.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11367 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11368.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11369This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11370exists in the message. For example,
11371.code
11372${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11373.endd
11374&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11375the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11376
11377.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11378 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11379.cindex "string" "comparison"
11380.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11381.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11382.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11383The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11384resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11385letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11386case is defined per the system C locale.
11387
11388.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11389.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11390.cindex "file" "existence test"
11391.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11392The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11393condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11394is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11395users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11396
11397.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11398.cindex "delivery" "first"
11399.cindex "first delivery"
11400.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11401.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11402This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11403attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11404
11405
11406.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11407 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11408.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11409.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11410.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11411.vindex "&$item$&"
11412These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11413the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11414the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11415The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11416be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11417condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11418.ilist
11419For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11420the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11421items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11422.next
11423For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11424and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11425all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11426.endlist
11427Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11428items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11429that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11430list separator is changed to a comma:
11431.code
11432${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11433.endd
11434The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11435being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11436
11437To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11438
11439.vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11440 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11441 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11442 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11443.cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11444.cindex JSON expansions
11445.cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11446.cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11447.cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11448.cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11449As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11450be a JSON array.
11451The array separator is not changeable.
11452For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11453and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11454
11455
11456
11457.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11458 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11459.cindex "string" "comparison"
11460.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11461.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11462.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11463The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11464string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11465comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11466case-independent.
11467Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11468
11469.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11470 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11471.cindex "string" "comparison"
11472.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11473.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11474.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11475The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11476string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11477includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11478case-independent.
11479Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11480
11481.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11482 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11483.cindex "string" "comparison"
11484.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11485Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11486strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11487is true.
11488For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11489
11490These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11491Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11492.code
11493${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11494 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11495${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11496 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11497.endd
11498
11499.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11500 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11501 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11502.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11503.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11504.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11505.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11506.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11507The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11508an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11509&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11510
11511For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11512which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11513colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11514hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11515component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11516
11517&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11518values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11519check.
11520This is no longer the case.
11521
11522The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11523host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11524.code
11525${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11526.endd
11527to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11528
11529.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11530.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11531.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11532.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11533This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11534&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11535queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11536query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11537password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11538server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11539with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11540will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11541of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11542this can be used.
11543
11544
11545.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11546 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11547.cindex "string" "comparison"
11548.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11549.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11550.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11551The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11552string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11553comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11554case-independent.
11555Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11556
11557.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11558 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11559.cindex "string" "comparison"
11560.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11561.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11562.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11563The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11564string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11565includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11566case-independent.
11567Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11568
11569
11570.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11571.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11572.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11573.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11574The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11575expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11576regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11577escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11578(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11579premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11580&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11581For example,
11582.code
11583${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11584.endd
11585If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11586backslashes is also required.
11587
11588The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11589The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11590metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11591and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11592the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11593metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11594All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11595but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11596
11597.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11598At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11599substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11600succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11601will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11602of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11603combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11604variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11605
11606.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11607.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11608See &*match_local_part*&.
11609
11610.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11611.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11612See &*match_local_part*&.
11613
11614.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11615.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11616This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11617be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11618address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11619list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11620.code
11621${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11622.endd
11623The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11624
11625.ilist
11626An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11627.next
11628A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11629.next
11630An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11631useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11632in a single test such as
11633. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11634. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11635. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11636. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11637.code
11638 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11639.endd
11640where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11641.next
11642The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11643.next
11644Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11645even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11646address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11647&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11648masks. For example:
11649.code
11650 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11651.endd
11652It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11653do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11654address mask, for example:
11655.code
11656 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11657.endd
11658However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11659just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11660.code
11661 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11662.endd
11663.endlist ilist
11664
11665Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11666Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11667
11668Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11669
11670.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11671.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11672.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11673.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11674.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11675This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11676possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11677condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11678example is:
11679.code
11680${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11681.endd
11682In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11683list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11684is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11685Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11686.code
11687${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11688.endd
11689.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11690For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11691item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11692have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11693caselessly.
11694
11695Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11696Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11697
11698&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11699hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11700how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11701matched using &%match_ip%&.
11702
11703.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11704.cindex "PAM authentication"
11705.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11706.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11707.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11708.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11709&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11710(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11711available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11712distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11713the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11714.code
11715SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11716.endd
11717in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11718in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11719
11720The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11721colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11722The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11723taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11724The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11725from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11726request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11727
11728There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11729characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11730separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11731item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11732of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11733.code
11734server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11735.endd
11736For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11737.code
11738server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11739.endd
11740In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11741running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11742messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11743. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11744
11745
11746.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11747.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11748.cindex "Cyrus"
11749.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11750.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11751This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11752This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11753that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11754deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11755
11756The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11757the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11758building Exim. For example:
11759.code
11760CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11761.endd
11762You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11763the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11764from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11765access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11766
11767The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11768password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11769configuration, you might have this:
11770.code
11771server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11772.endd
11773Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11774.code
11775server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11776.endd
11777.vitem &*queue_running*&
11778.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11779.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11780.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11781This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11782initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11783
11784
11785.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11786.cindex "Radius"
11787.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11788.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11789Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11790set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11791the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11792support.
11793
11794With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11795library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11796this library, you need to set
11797.code
11798RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11799.endd
11800in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11801&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11802.code
11803RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11804.endd
11805in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11806You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11807Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11808
11809The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11810Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11811the authentication is successful. For example:
11812.code
11813server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11814.endd
11815
11816
11817.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11818 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11819.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11820.cindex "Cyrus"
11821.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11822.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11823This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11824daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11825Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11826by a process that is not running as root.
11827
11828The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11829the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11830building Exim. For example:
11831.code
11832CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11833.endd
11834You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11835the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11836from the Cyrus SASL library.
11837
11838Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11839two are mandatory. For example:
11840.code
11841server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11842.endd
11843The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11844in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11845realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11846.endlist vlist
11847
11848
11849
11850.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11851.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11852Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11853and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11854conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11855sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11856the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11857
11858
11859.vlist
11860.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11861.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11862.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11863The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11864any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11865For example,
11866.code
11867${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11868.endd
11869When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11870evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11871numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11872
11873.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11874.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11875.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11876The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11877all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11878sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11879the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11880parsed but not evaluated.
11881.endlist
11882.ecindex IIDexpcond
11883
11884
11885
11886
11887.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11888.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11889This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11890of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11891support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11892
11893.vlist
11894.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11895.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11896When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11897captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11898processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11899In the expansion condition case
11900they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11901values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11902variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11903precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11904Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11905matching condition.
11906
11907.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11908Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11909any arguments are copied to these variables,
11910any unused variables being made empty.
11911
11912.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11913Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11914can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11915long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11916example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11917variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11918used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11919same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11920with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11921during subsequent delivery.
11922
11923.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11924These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11925are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11926received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11927message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11928also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11929message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11930and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11931delivery.
11932
11933.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11934Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11935this variable has the number of arguments.
11936
11937.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11938.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11939After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11940message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11941be preserved by coding like this:
11942.code
11943warn !verify = sender
11944 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11945.endd
11946You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11947&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11948failure.
11949
11950.vitem &$address_data$&
11951.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11952This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11953value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11954and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11955the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11956for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11957user filter files.
11958
11959If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11960a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11961conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11962to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11963of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11964from the child's routing.
11965
11966If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11967sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11968&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11969address.
11970
11971In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11972after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11973these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11974
11975.vitem &$address_file$&
11976.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11977When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11978to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11979is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11980default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11981.code
11982/home/r2d2/savemail
11983.endd
11984then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11985contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11986.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11987For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11988then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11989to the relevant file.
11990
11991.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11992.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11993When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11994this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11995
11996.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11997.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11998These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11999&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12000
12001.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12002.cindex "authentication" "id"
12003.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12004When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12005preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12006&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12007user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12008in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12009&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12010
12011When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12012the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12013process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12014command line option.
12015This second case also sets up information used by the
12016&$authresults$& expansion item.
12017
12018.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12019.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12020.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12021When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12022will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12023id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12024available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12025A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12026authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12027the ACL's as well.
12028
12029
12030.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
12031.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12032.cindex "authentication" "sender"
12033.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12034.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
12035When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12036SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12037described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12038&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12039available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12040sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12041
12042.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12043When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12044value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12045name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12046can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12047
12048
12049.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12050.cindex "authentication" "failure"
12051.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12052This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12053command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12054possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12055(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12056&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12057is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12058negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12059an undefined mechanism.
12060
12061.vitem &$av_failed$&
12062.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12063This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12064extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12065problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12066the ACL malware condition.
12067
12068.vitem &$body_linecount$&
12069.cindex "message body" "line count"
12070.cindex "body of message" "line count"
12071.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12072When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12073number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12074
12075.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12076.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12077.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12078.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12079.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12080When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12081number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12082
12083.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12084.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12085This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12086it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12087chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12088
12089.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12090.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12091This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12092up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12093file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12094
12095.vitem &$caller_gid$&
12096.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12097.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12098The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12099not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12100&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12101incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12102
12103.vitem &$caller_uid$&
12104.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12105.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12106The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12107not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12108&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12109incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12110
12111.vitem &$callout_address$&
12112.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12113After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12114address that was connected to.
12115
12116.vitem &$compile_number$&
12117.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12118The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12119of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12120compilations of the same version of Exim.
12121
12122.vitem &$config_dir$&
12123.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12124The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12125&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12126contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12127&$config_dir$& is ".".
12128
12129.vitem &$config_file$&
12130.vindex "&$config_file$&"
12131The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12132
12133.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12134 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12135 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12136 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12137Results of DMARC verification.
12138For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12139
12140.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12141Results of DKIM verification.
12142For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12143
12144.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12145 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12146 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12147 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12148 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12149 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12150 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12151 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12152 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12153 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12154 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12155 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12156 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12157 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12158 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12159 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12160 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12161 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12162 &$dkim_key_length$&
12163These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12164For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12165
12166.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12167.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12168When a message has been received this variable contains
12169a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12170For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12171
12172.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12173 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12174 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12175 &$dnslist_value$&
12176.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12177.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12178.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12179.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12180.cindex "black list (DNS)"
12181When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12182the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12183looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12184main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12185
12186.vitem &$domain$&
12187.vindex "&$domain$&"
12188When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12189contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12190case for &$domain$&.
12191
12192Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12193&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12194is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12195message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12196
12197When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12198RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12199have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12200at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12201the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12202which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12203
12204.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12205At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12206set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12207
12208The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12209
12210.ilist
12211When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12212the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12213&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12214normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12215is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12216&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12217the &(smtp)& transport.
12218
12219.next
12220When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12221&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12222it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12223rewrite domains by file lookup.
12224
12225.next
12226With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12227&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12228a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12229is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12230that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12231recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12232
12233.next
12234.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12235.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12236When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12237the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12238.endlist
12239
12240.new
12241.cindex "tainted data"
12242If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12243the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12244See also &$domain_verified$&.
12245.wen
12246
12247
12248.vitem &$domain_data$&
12249.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12250When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12251means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12252of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12253address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12254transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12255used.
12256
12257&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12258domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12259the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12260to nothing.
12261
12262.vitem &$exim_gid$&
12263.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12264This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12265
12266.vitem &$exim_path$&
12267.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12268This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12269
12270.vitem &$exim_uid$&
12271.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12272This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12273
12274.vitem &$exim_version$&
12275.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12276This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12277The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12278Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12279There may be other characters following the minor version.
12280This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12281
12282.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12283This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12284inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12285be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12286characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12287See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12288
12289.vitem &$headers_added$&
12290.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12291Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12292the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12293The headers are a newline-separated list.
12294
12295.vitem &$home$&
12296.vindex "&$home$&"
12297When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12298directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12299means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12300explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12301by a setting on the transport itself.
12302
12303When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12304of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12305&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12306
12307.vitem &$host$&
12308.vindex "&$host$&"
12309If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12310list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12311to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12312to local and remote transports.
12313
12314.cindex "transport" "filter"
12315.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12316For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12317&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12318particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12319using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12320&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12321is connected.
12322
12323When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12324&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12325client is connected.
12326
12327
12328.vitem &$host_address$&
12329.vindex "&$host_address$&"
12330This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12331for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12332when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12333
12334.vitem &$host_data$&
12335.vindex "&$host_data$&"
12336If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12337result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12338allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12339.code
12340deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12341message = $host_data
12342.endd
12343.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12344.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12345.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12346This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12347message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12348name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12349variables is set to &"1"&.
12350
12351.ilist
12352If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12353succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12354
12355.next
12356If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12357tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12358lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12359.endlist ilist
12360
12361Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12362single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12363names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12364is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12365&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12366IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12367sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12368lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12369the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12370&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12371
12372.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12373Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12374&%authresults%& expansion item.
12375
12376
12377.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12378.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12379See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12380
12381.vitem &$host_port$&
12382.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12383This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12384for an outbound connection.
12385
12386.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12387.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12388This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12389directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12390working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12391to &$spool_directory$& later.
12392
12393.vitem &$inode$&
12394.vindex "&$inode$&"
12395The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12396option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12397of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12398a unique name for the file.
12399
12400.vitem &$interface_address$&
12401.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12402This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12403
12404.vitem &$interface_port$&
12405.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12406This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12407
12408.vitem &$item$&
12409.vindex "&$item$&"
12410This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12411conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12412&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12413empty.
12414
12415.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12416.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12417This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12418contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12419lookup.
12420
12421.vitem &$load_average$&
12422.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12423This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12424is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12425variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12426
12427.vitem &$local_part$&
12428.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12429When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12430variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12431delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12432session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12433
12434Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12435&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12436&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12437because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12438once.
12439
12440.new
12441.cindex "tainted data"
12442If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12443the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12444
12445&*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12446attacker.
12447Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12448for file access.
12449This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12450For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12451&$local_part_verified$& variable rather than this one.
12452For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12453which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12454rather than this variable.
12455If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12456the retrieved data.
12457.wen
12458
12459.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12460.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
12461.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12462.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
12463.cindex affix variables
12464If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12465value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12466any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12467&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12468.new
12469If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12470the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12471&$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate.
12472.wen
12473
12474When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12475result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12476the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12477&$address_pipe$&).
12478
12479When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12480local part of the recipient address.
12481
12482When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12483&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12484it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12485
12486In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12487the addresses
12488.code
12489"abc:xyz"@test.example
12490abc\:xyz@test.example
12491.endd
12492the value of &$local_part$& is
12493.code
12494abc:xyz
12495.endd
12496If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12497inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12498have:
12499.code
12500data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12501.endd
12502&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12503to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12504&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12505
12506.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12507.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12508When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12509lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12510router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12511to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12512handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12513
12514&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12515matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12516available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12517variable expands to nothing.
12518
12519.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12520.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12521.cindex affix variables
12522When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12523specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12524variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12525
12526.new
12527.vitem &$local_part_prefix_v$&
12528.vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
12529When &$local_part_prefix$& is valid and the prefix match used a wildcard,
12530the portion matching the wildcard is available in this variable.
12531.wen
12532
12533.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12534.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12535When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12536specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12537variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12538
12539.new
12540.vitem &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12541.vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
12542When &$local_part_suffix$& is valid and the suffix match used a wildcard,
12543the portion matching the wildcard is available in this variable.
12544.wen
12545
12546.new
12547.vitem &$local_part_verified$&
12548.vindex "&$local_part_verified$&"
12549If the router generic option &%check_local_part%& has run successfully,
12550this variable has the user database version of &$local_part$&.
12551Such values are not tainted and hence usable for building file names.
12552.wen
12553
12554.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12555.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12556This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12557a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12558
12559.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12560.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12561See &$local_user_uid$&.
12562
12563.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12564.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12565This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12566&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12567are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12568and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12569router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12570are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12571
12572.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12573.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12574This contains the expanded value of the
12575&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12576been read.
12577
12578.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12579.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12580The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12581log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12582referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12583the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12584
12585.vitem &$log_space$&
12586.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12587The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12588partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12589whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12590ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12591the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12592
12593
12594.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12595.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12596This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12597a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12598.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12599It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12600&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12601and &"yes"& if it was.
12602Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12603the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12604as authenticated data.
12605
12606.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12607.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12608This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12609&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12610&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12611contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12612without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12613variable is empty.
12614
12615.vitem &$malware_name$&
12616.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12617This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12618content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12619when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12620
12621.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12622.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12623.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12624.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12625This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12626received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12627character(s).
12628It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12629
12630.vitem &$message_age$&
12631.cindex "message" "age of"
12632.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12633This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12634of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12635delivery attempt.
12636
12637.vitem &$message_body$&
12638.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12639.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12640.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12641.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12642.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12643This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12644being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12645number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12646&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12647
12648.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12649By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12650easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12651this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12652zeros are always converted into spaces.
12653
12654.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12655.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12656.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12657.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12658This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12659body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12660&$message_body$&.
12661
12662.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12663.cindex "body of message" "size"
12664.cindex "message body" "size"
12665.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12666When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12667in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12668separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12669also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12670
12671If the spool file is wireformat
12672(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12673the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12674
12675.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12676.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12677When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12678unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12679An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12680received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12681line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12682&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12683
12684.vitem &$message_headers$&
12685.vindex &$message_headers$&
12686This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12687is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12688lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12689same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12690
12691.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12692.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12693This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12694contents of header lines is done.
12695
12696.vitem &$message_id$&
12697This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12698
12699.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12700.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12701This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12702message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12703During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12704number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12705routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12706&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12707lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12708from the body is not counted.
12709
12710As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12711appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12712&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12713file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12714header and the body).
12715
12716Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12717.code
12718deny message = Too many lines in message header
12719 condition = \
12720 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12721.endd
12722In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12723message has not yet been received.
12724
12725This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12726
12727.vitem &$message_size$&
12728.cindex "size" "of message"
12729.cindex "message" "size"
12730.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12731When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12732most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12733message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12734deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12735expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12736doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12737precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12738&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12739
12740.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12741While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12742contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12743value may not, of course, be truthful.
12744
12745.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12746A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12747available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12748details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12749
12750.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12751These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12752of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12753
12754.vitem &$original_domain$&
12755.vindex "&$domain$&"
12756.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12757When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12758same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12759generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12760variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12761differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12762aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12763single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12764
12765If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12766filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12767part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12768
12769.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12770.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12771.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12772When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12773same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12774local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12775part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12776filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12777the original address.
12778
12779If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12780case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12781This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12782one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12783delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12784
12785If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12786filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12787part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12788
12789.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12790.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12791.cindex "sender" "gid"
12792.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12793.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12794This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12795message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12796gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12797normally the gid of the Exim user.
12798
12799.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12800.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12801.cindex "sender" "uid"
12802.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12803.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12804The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12805messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12806For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12807user.
12808
12809.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12810.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12811This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12812above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12813
12814.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12815.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12816This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12817(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12818
12819.vitem &$pid$&
12820.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12821.vindex "&$pid$&"
12822This variable contains the current process id.
12823
12824.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12825.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12826.cindex "transport" "filter"
12827.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12828This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12829&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12830&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12831(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12832It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12833variable"& error if encountered.
12834
12835.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12836.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12837This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12838configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12839a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12840&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12841qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12842
12843
12844.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12845 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12846 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12847 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12848 &$proxy_session$&
12849These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12850or SOCKS5 support.
12851For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12852
12853.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12854.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12855This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12856current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12857
12858.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12859This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12860which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12861&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12862
12863.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12864This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12865which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12866&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12867
12868.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12869This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12870which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12871&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12872
12873.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12874.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12875The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12876
12877.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12878.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12879The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12880or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12881
12882.vitem &$queue_name$&
12883.vindex &$queue_name$&
12884.cindex "named queues" variable
12885.cindex queues named
12886The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12887
12888.vitem &$queue_size$&
12889.vindex "&$queue_size$&"
12890.cindex "queue" "size of"
12891.cindex "spool" "number of messages"
12892This variable contains the number of messages queued.
12893It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
12894
12895.vitem &$r_...$&
12896.vindex &$r_...$&
12897.cindex router variables
12898Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12899They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12900The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12901and the eventual transport.
12902
12903.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12904.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12905When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12906RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12907RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12908
12909.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12910.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12911.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12912When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12913RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12914temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12915
12916.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12917.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12918When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12919RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12920permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12921
12922.vitem &$received_count$&
12923.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12924This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12925including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12926is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12927delivering.
12928
12929.vitem &$received_for$&
12930.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12931If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12932variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12933built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12934the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12935
12936.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12937.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12938As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12939variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12940is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12941&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12942the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12943option.
12944
12945As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12946could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12947on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12948values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12949messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12950time.
12951For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12952
12953.vitem &$received_port$&
12954.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12955See &$received_ip_address$&.
12956
12957.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12958.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12959When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12960protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12961by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12962&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12963(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12964is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12965connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12966
12967Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12968automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12969&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12970encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12971where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12972STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12973
12974The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12975messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12976identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12977
12978.vitem &$received_time$&
12979.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12980This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12981as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12982
12983.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12984.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12985This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12986condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12987until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12988.display
12989&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12990&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12991.endd
12992&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12993method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12994The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12995expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12996
12997.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12998.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12999In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13000information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13001
13002.ilist
13003&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13004was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13005
13006.next
13007&"route"&: Routing failed.
13008
13009.next
13010&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13011or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13012MAIL).
13013
13014.next
13015&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13016.next
13017
13018&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13019.endlist
13020
13021The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13022rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13023
13024.vitem &$recipients$&
13025.vindex "&$recipients$&"
13026This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
13027a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
13028is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13029unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
13030cases:
13031
13032.olist
13033In a system filter file.
13034.next
13035In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13036is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13037&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13038&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13039.next
13040From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13041.endlist
13042
13043
13044.vitem &$recipients_count$&
13045.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13046When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13047envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13048from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13049increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13050
13051
13052.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13053.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13054This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13055&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13056
13057.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13058.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13059When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13060these variables contain the
13061captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13062
13063
13064.vitem &$reply_address$&
13065.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
13066When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13067&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13068contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13069white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13070decoding or character code translation takes place.
13071
13072.vitem &$return_path$&
13073.vindex "&$return_path$&"
13074When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13075the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13076in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13077same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13078mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13079for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13080address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13081that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13082the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13083envelope sender.
13084
13085.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13086.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13087This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13088
13089.vitem &$router_name$&
13090.cindex "router" "name"
13091.cindex "name" "of router"
13092.vindex "&$router_name$&"
13093During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13094
13095.vitem &$runrc$&
13096.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13097.vindex "&$runrc$&"
13098This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13099&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13100assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13101preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13102reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13103another.
13104
13105.vitem &$self_hostname$&
13106.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13107.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13108When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13109local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13110One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13111happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13112original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13113
13114.vitem &$sender_address$&
13115.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13116When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13117that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13118is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13119value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13120
13121.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13122.vindex "&$address_data$&"
13123.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13124If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13125sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13126distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13127after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13128longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13129
13130.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13131.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13132The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13133
13134.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13135.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13136The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13137
13138.vitem &$sender_data$&
13139.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13140This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13141in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13142value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13143this:
13144.display
13145&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13146&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13147.endd
13148&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13149method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13150The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13151expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13152
13153.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13154.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13155When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13156name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13157brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13158enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13159issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13160looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13161&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13162start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13163verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13164the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13165the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13166
13167.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13168.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13169This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13170.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13171done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13172
13173.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13174.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13175When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13176command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13177set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13178the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13179
13180.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13181.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13182When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13183this variable contains that
13184host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13185
13186.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13187.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13188This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13189driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13190received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13191&$authenticated_id$&.
13192
13193.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13194.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13195If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13196(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13197otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13198resolver library states that both
13199the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13200other times, this variable is false.
13201
13202.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13203It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13204library, by setting:
13205.code
13206dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13207.endd
13208
13209Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13210validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13211
13212If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13213mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13214
13215This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13216DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13217all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13218is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13219
13220
13221.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13222.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13223When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13224host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13225other means, this variable is empty.
13226
13227.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13228If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13229&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13230A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13231via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13232any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13233&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13234
13235.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13236However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13237DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13238&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13239
13240Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13241host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13242in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13243is set to &"1"&.
13244
13245Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13246maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13247these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13248following are true:
13249
13250.ilist
13251A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13252.next
13253The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13254configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13255to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13256.next
13257Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13258that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13259&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13260.next
13261The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13262In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13263EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13264.next
13265The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13266domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13267. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13268. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13269.code
13270 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13271.endd
13272which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13273IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13274.endlist
13275
13276
13277.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13278.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13279When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13280number that was used on the remote host.
13281
13282.vitem &$sender_ident$&
13283.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13284When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13285identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13286been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13287called Exim.
13288
13289.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13290A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13291&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13292&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13293
13294.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13295.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13296.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13297.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13298This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13299either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13300there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13301there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13302the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13303followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13304first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13305the parentheses.
13306
13307There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13308was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13309address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13310all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13311into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13312
13313.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13314.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13315In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13316about the failure. The details are the same as for
13317&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13318
13319.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13320.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13321This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13322been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13323used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13324on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13325connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13326
13327.vitem &$sending_port$&
13328.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13329This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13330been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13331connections, see &$received_port$&.
13332
13333.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13334.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13335During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13336host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13337&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13338value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13339
13340.vitem &$smtp_command$&
13341.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13342During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13343entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13344the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13345.code
13346MAIL FROM:<>
13347MAIL FROM: <>
13348.endd
13349For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13350command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13351rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13352the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13353
13354.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13355.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13356.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13357While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13358argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13359space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13360somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13361
13362.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13363.cindex SMTP "command history"
13364.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13365A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13366received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13367are remembered.
13368
13369.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13370.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13371This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13372daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13373in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13374connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13375the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13376never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13377there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13378single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13379daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13380
13381.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13382These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13383that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13384filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13385example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13386message is junk mail.
13387
13388.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13389A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13390is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13391&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13392
13393.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13394 &$spf_received$& &&&
13395 &$spf_result$& &&&
13396 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13397 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13398These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13399For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13400
13401.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13402.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13403The name of Exim's spool directory.
13404
13405.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13406.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13407The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13408being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13409If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13410is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13411
13412.vitem &$spool_space$&
13413.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13414The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13415Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13416variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13417find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13418value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13419megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13420.code
13421condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13422.endd
13423See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13424
13425
13426.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13427.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13428This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13429command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13430command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13431interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13432
13433.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13434.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13435Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13436on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13437this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13438If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13439The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13440when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13441
13442The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13443except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13444the outbound.
13445
13446.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13447.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13448Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13449on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13450this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13451If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13452
13453.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13454.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13455.cindex certificate variables
13456This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13457inbound connection when the message was received.
13458It is only useful as the argument of a
13459&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13460or a &%def%& condition.
13461
13462&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13463when a list of more than one
13464file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13465The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13466
13467.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13468.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13469This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13470inbound connection when the message was received.
13471It is only useful as the argument of a
13472&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13473or a &%def%& condition.
13474If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13475which is not the leaf.
13476
13477.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13478.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13479This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13480outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13481&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13482or a &%def%& condition.
13483
13484.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13485.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13486This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13487outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13488&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13489or a &%def%& condition.
13490If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13491which is not the leaf.
13492
13493.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13494.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13495This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13496message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13497
13498The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13499except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13500the outbound.
13501
13502.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13503.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13504This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13505outbound SMTP connection was made,
13506and &"0"& otherwise.
13507
13508.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13509.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13510.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13511When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13512connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13513example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13514received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13515&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13516non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13517
13518The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13519but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13520becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13521
13522.vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13523.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13524As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13525
13526.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13527.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13528This variable is
13529cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13530and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13531&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13532details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13533
13534.vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13535.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13536As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13537
13538.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13539.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13540DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13541
13542.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13543.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13544When a message is received from a remote client connection
13545the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13546.code
135470 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
135481 No response to request
135492 Response not verified
135503 Verification failed
135514 Verification succeeded
13552.endd
13553
13554.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13555.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13556When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13557the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13558See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13559
13560.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13561.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13562.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13563.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13564When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13565connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13566the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13567&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13568If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13569which is not the leaf.
13570
13571The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13572except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13573the outbound.
13574
13575.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13576.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13577When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13578connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13579the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13580&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13581If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13582which is not the leaf.
13583
13584.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13585.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13586.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13587.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13588When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13589Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13590If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13591some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13592will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13593a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13594used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13595
13596The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13597except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13598the outbound.
13599
13600.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13601.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13602.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13603During outbound
13604SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13605the transport.
13606
13607.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13608.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13609Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13610
13611.vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13612.vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13613When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13614this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13615
13616.vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13617.vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13618When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13619this variable is set to the protocol version.
13620
13621
13622.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13623.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13624The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13625files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13626
13627.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13628.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13629The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13630
13631.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13632.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13633The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13634
13635.vitem &$tod_full$&
13636.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13637A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13638+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13639positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13640values for those that are behind (west).
13641
13642.vitem &$tod_log$&
13643.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13644The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
136451995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13646
13647.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13648.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13649This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13650is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13651flag.
13652
13653.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13654.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13655This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13656-0500.
13657
13658.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13659.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13660This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13661by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13662
13663.vitem &$transport_name$&
13664.cindex "transport" "name"
13665.cindex "name" "of transport"
13666.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13667During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13668
13669.vitem &$value$&
13670.vindex "&$value$&"
13671This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13672or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13673&*reduce*& expansion.
13674
13675.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13676.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13677While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13678contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13679Otherwise, empty.
13680
13681.vitem &$version_number$&
13682.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13683The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13684by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13685
13686.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13687.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13688This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13689delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13690
13691.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13692.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13693This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13694delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13695.endlist
13696.ecindex IIDstrexp
13697
13698
13699
13700. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13701. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13702
13703.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13704.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13705Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13706Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13707use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13708your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13709the line
13710.code
13711EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13712.endd
13713in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13714
13715
13716.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13717.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13718Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13719&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13720no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13721interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13722the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13723option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13724a newly created Perl interpreter.
13725
13726The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13727need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13728should usually be something like
13729.code
13730perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13731.endd
13732where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13733use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13734soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13735the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13736its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13737fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13738necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13739the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13740two ways:
13741
13742.ilist
13743.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13744Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13745a startup when Exim is entered.
13746.next
13747The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13748overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13749.endlist
13750
13751There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13752initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13753
13754.ilist
13755.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13756.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13757To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13758interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13759taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13760option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13761defaults to false.
13762
13763
13764.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13765When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13766of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13767by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13768forms:
13769.code
13770${perl{foo}}
13771${perl{foo}{argument}}
13772${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13773.endd
13774which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13775arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13776with an error message of the form
13777.code
13778Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13779.endd
13780The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13781it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13782return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13783an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13784by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13785that was passed to &%die%&.
13786
13787
13788.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13789Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13790is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13791the Perl code
13792.code
13793my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13794.endd
13795makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13796Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13797&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13798
13799If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13800&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13801expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13802an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13803
13804.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13805.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13806Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13807&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13808debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13809&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13810timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13811
13812
13813.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13814.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13815You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13816Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13817before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13818SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13819is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13820error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13821avoided, but the output is lost.
13822
13823.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13824The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13825Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13826you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13827output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13828change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13829For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13830.code
13831$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13832.endd
13833Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13834example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13835include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13836as the first subroutine argument.
13837.ecindex IIDperl
13838
13839
13840. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13841. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13842
13843.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13844 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13845 "Starting the daemon"
13846.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13847.cindex "interface" "listening"
13848.cindex "network interface"
13849.cindex "interface" "network"
13850.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13851.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13852.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13853.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13854A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13855hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13856or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13857works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13858In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13859IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13860knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13861
13862.olist
13863When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13864and ports to listen on.
13865.next
13866When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13867are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13868processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13869same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13870when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13871local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13872option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13873as an error situation.
13874.next
13875When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13876for the outgoing connection.
13877.endlist
13878
13879
13880Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13881of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13882addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13883standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13884rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13885
13886In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13887interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13888options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13889chapter describes how they operate.
13890
13891When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13892actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13893
13894
13895
13896.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13897When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13898option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13899following options:
13900
13901.ilist
13902&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13903or service names.
13904(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13905.next
13906&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13907listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13908.endlist
13909
13910The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13911described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13912it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13913colons. For example:
13914.code
13915local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13916 192.168.23.65 ; \
13917 ::1 ; \
13918 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13919.endd
13920There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13921in &%local_interfaces%&:
13922
13923.olist
13924The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13925on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13926.code
13927local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13928 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13929.endd
13930.next
13931The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13932with a colon separator, for example:
13933.code
13934local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13935 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13936.endd
13937.endlist
13938
13939When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13940default setting contains just one port:
13941.code
13942daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13943.endd
13944If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13945specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13946&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13947&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13948IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13949
13950
13951
13952.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13953The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13954as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13955case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13956instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13957default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13958.code
13959local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13960.endd
13961when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13962.code
13963local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13964.endd
13965Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13966
13967
13968
13969.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13970The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13971&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13972instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13973option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13974the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13975exim.
13976
13977The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13978changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13979If there are any items that do not
13980contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13981&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13982items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13983replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13984.code
13985-oX 1225
13986.endd
13987overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13988whereas
13989.code
13990-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13991.endd
13992overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13993(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13994value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13995
13996
13997
13998.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13999.cindex "submissions protocol"
14000.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14001.cindex "smtps protocol"
14002.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14003.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14004Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14005&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14006For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14007STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14008the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14009If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14010(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14011the 465 TCP ports.
14012
14013If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14014service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14015proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14016
14017The common use of this option is expected to be
14018.code
14019tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14020.endd
14021per RFC 8314.
14022There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14023to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14024
14025&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14026daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14027&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14028because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14029connections via the daemon.)
14030
14031
14032
14033
14034.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14035.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14036IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14037can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14038interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14039address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14040percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14041adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14042.code
14043fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14044.endd
14045To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14046allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14047to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14048percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14049address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14050&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14051.code
14052IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14053.endd
14054is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14055Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14056instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14057function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14058&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14059
14060.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14061.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14062Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14063run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14064using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14065connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14066.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14067&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14068activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14069that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14070etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14071to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14072
14073On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14074disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14075option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14076and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14077IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14078
14079
14080
14081.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14082The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14083.code
14084daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14085local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14086.endd
14087This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14088Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14089the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14090read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14091
14092To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14093.code
14094daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14095.endd
14096(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14097.code
14098local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14099 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14100.endd
14101To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14102IPv4 loopback address only:
14103.code
14104local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14105.endd
14106To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14107.code
14108local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14109.endd
14110&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14111
14112
14113
14114.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14115The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14116whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14117addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14118treated as local.
14119
14120For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14121the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14122available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14123(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14124
14125Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14126many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14127email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14128interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14129&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14130&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14131used for listening. Consider this example:
14132.code
14133local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14134 192.168.53.235 ; \
14135 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14136
14137extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14138.endd
14139The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14140address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14141Exim is routing.
14142
14143In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14144address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14145desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14146these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14147This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14148during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14149host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14150addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14151
14152
14153
14154.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14155Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14156allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14157there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14158&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14159description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14160details.
14161
14162
14163
14164
14165. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14166. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14167
14168.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14169.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14170.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14171The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14172
14173.ilist
14174Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14175&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14176.next
14177Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14178&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14179section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14180.next
14181Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14182(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14183&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14184only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14185settings.
14186.endlist
14187
14188This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14189types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14190in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14191are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14192an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14193listed in more than one group.
14194
14195.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14196.table2
14197.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14198.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14199.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14200.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14201.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14202.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14203.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14204.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14205.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14206.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14207.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14208.endtable
14209
14210
14211.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14212.table2
14213.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14214.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14215.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14216.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14217.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14218.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14219.endtable
14220
14221
14222
14223.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14224.table2
14225.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14226.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14227.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14228.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14229.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14230.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14231.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14232.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14233.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14234.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14235.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14236.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14237.endtable
14238
14239
14240
14241.section "Logging" "SECID99"
14242.table2
14243.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14244.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14245.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14246.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14247.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14248.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14249.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14250.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14251.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14252.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14253.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14254.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14255.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14256.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14257.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14258.endtable
14259
14260
14261
14262.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14263.table2
14264.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14265.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14266.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14267.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14268.endtable
14269
14270
14271
14272.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14273.table2
14274.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14275.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14276.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14277.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14278.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14279.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14280.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14281.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14282.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14283.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14284.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14285.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14286.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14287.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14288.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14289.endtable
14290
14291
14292
14293.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14294.table2
14295.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14296.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14297.endtable
14298
14299
14300
14301.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14302.table2
14303.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14304.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14305.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14306.endtable
14307
14308
14309
14310.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14311.table2
14312.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14313.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14314.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14315.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14316.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14317.row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14318.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14319.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14320.endtable
14321
14322
14323
14324.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14325.table2
14326.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14327.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14328.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14329.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14330.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14331.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14332.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14333.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14334.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14335.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14336.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14337.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14338.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14339.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14340.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14341.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14342 connection"
14343.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14344.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14345.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14346.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14347.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14348.endtable
14349
14350
14351
14352.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14353.table2
14354.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14355.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14356.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14357.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14358.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14359.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14360.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14361.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14362.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14363.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14364.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14365.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14366.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14367.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14368.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14369.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14370.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14371.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14372.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14373.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14374.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14375.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14376 words""&"
14377.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14378.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14379.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14380.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14381.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14382.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14383.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14384.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14385.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14386.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14387.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14388.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14389.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14390.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14391.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14392.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14393.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14394.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14395.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14396.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14397.endtable
14398
14399
14400
14401.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14402.table2
14403.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14404 item"
14405.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14406 item"
14407.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14408.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14409.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14410.endtable
14411
14412
14413
14414.section "TLS" "SECID108"
14415.table2
14416.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14417.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14418.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14419.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14420.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14421.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14422.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14423.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14424.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14425.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14426.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14427.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14428.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14429.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14430.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14431.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14432.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14433.endtable
14434
14435
14436
14437.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14438.table2
14439.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14440.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14441.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14442.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14443.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14444.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14445.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14446.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14447.endtable
14448
14449
14450
14451.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14452.table2
14453.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14454.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14455.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14456.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14457.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14458.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14459.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14460.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14461.endtable
14462
14463
14464
14465
14466.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14467.table2
14468.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14469.endtable
14470
14471
14472
14473
14474
14475.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14476See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14477
14478.table2
14479.row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14480.row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14481.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14482.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14483.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14484.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14485.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14486.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14487.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14488.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14489.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14490.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14491.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14492.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14493.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14494.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14495.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14496 connection"
14497.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14498.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14499.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14500.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14501.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14502.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14503.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14504.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14505.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14506.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14507.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14508.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14509.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14510.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14511.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14512.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14513.endtable
14514
14515
14516
14517.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14518.table2
14519.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14520.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14521.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14522.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14523.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14524.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14525.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14526.row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14527.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14528.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14529.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14530.endtable
14531
14532
14533
14534.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14535.table2
14536.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14537.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14538.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14539.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14540 words""&"
14541.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14542.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14543.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14544.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14545.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14546.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14547.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14548.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14549.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14550.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14551.endtable
14552
14553
14554
14555.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14556.table2
14557.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14558.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14559 directory"
14560.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14561.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14562.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14563.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14564.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14565.endtable
14566
14567
14568
14569.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14570.table2
14571.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14572.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14573.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14574.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14575.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14576.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14577.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14578.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14579.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14580.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14581.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14582.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14583.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14584.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14585.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14586.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14587.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14588.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14589.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14590.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14591.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14592.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14593.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14594.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14595.endtable
14596
14597
14598
14599.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14600.table2
14601.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14602.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14603.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14604.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14605.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14606.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14607.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14608.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14609.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14610.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14611.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14612.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14613.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14614.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14615.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14616.endtable
14617
14618
14619
14620.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14621Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14622&dagger;.
14623
14624.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14625.cindex "8BITMIME"
14626.cindex "8-bit characters"
14627.cindex "log" "selectors"
14628.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14629This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14630EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14631However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14632takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14633
14634Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14635feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14636It now defaults to true.
14637A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14638.display
14639&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14640.endd
14641
14642To log received 8BITMIME status use
14643.code
14644log_selector = +8bitmime
14645.endd
14646
14647.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14648.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14649.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14650This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14651read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14652further details.
14653
14654.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14655This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14656messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14657SMTP messages.
14658
14659.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14660.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14661.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14662This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14663non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14664
14665.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14666.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14667.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14668This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14669received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14670
14671.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14672.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14673This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14674See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14675
14676.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14677.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14678This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14679processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14680acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14681
14682.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14683.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14684.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14685.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14686.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14687This option defines the ACL that,
14688if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14689is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14690processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14691acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14692
14693.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14694.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14695This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14696(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14697of a received message.
14698See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14699
14700.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14701.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14702This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14703received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14704
14705.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14706.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14707This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14708received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14709
14710.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14711.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14712.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14713This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14714command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14715
14716
14717.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14718.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14719This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14720received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14721
14722.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14723.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14724This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14725a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14726&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14727
14728.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14729.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14730This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14731extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14732section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14733
14734.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14735.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14736This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14737ends without a QUIT command being received.
14738See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14739
14740.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14741This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14742received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14743further details.
14744
14745.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14746.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14747This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14748received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14749
14750.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14751.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14752This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14753received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14754
14755.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14756.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14757This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14758received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14759
14760.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14761.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14762This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14763received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14764
14765.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14766.cindex "environment" "set values"
14767This option adds individual environment variables that the
14768currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14769Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14770
14771See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14772
14773.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14774.cindex "admin user"
14775This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14776current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14777colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14778programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14779admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14780not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14781To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14782
14783.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14784.cindex "domain literal"
14785If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14786email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14787format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14788has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14789
14790Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14791format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14792addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14793&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14794domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14795configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14796the local host's IP addresses.
14797
14798
14799.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14800.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14801It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14802and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14803MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14804that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14805practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14806&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14807recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14808
14809.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14810.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14811.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14812Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14813camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14814that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14815This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14816
14817If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14818UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14819letters, digits, and hyphens.
14820
14821If Exim is built with internationalization support
14822and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14823this option can be left as default.
14824Without that,
14825if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14826adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14827suitable setting is:
14828.code
14829dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14830 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14831.endd
14832Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14833.code
14834dns_check_names_pattern =
14835.endd
14836That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14837
14838
14839.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14840.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14841.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14842If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14843response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14844Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14845Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14846advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14847authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14848&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14849authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14850
14851Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14852and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14853not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14854authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14855to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14856which Exim advertises AUTH.
14857
14858.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14859If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14860is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14861option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14862.code
14863auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14864.endd
14865.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14866If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14867the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14868expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14869
14870
14871.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14872.cindex "thawing messages"
14873.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14874If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14875new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14876this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14877being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14878saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14879
14880&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14881&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14882thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14883
14884
14885.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14886This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14887It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14888.code
14889sophie:/var/run/sophie
14890.endd
14891If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14892before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14893
14894
14895.option bi_command main string unset
14896.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14897This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14898the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14899just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14900required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14901
14902
14903.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14904.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14905.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14906This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14907for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14908chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14909
14910
14911.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14912When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14913message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14914delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14915
14916.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14917.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14918This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14919bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14920causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14921value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14922message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14923error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14924point at which the error was detected are returned.
14925.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14926
14927.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14928.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14929.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14930.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14931This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14932that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14933when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14934The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14935If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14936treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14937
14938The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14939during reception of a message.
14940In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14941
14942The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14943
14944
14945.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14946If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14947bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14948&%bounce_return_body%&.
14949
14950
14951.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14952.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14953.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14954.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14955This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14956senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14957limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14958any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14959that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14960
14961When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14962greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14963added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14964to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14965size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14966messages.
14967
14968.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14969.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14970.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14971.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14972This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14973bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14974connection. A typical setting might be:
14975.code
14976bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14977.endd
14978which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14979.code
14980MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14981.endd
14982The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14983address.
14984
14985.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14986.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14987.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14988This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14989domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14990section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14991
14992
14993.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14994This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14995domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14996section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14997
14998
14999.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15000This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15001address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15002section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15003
15004
15005.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15006This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15007address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15008section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15009
15010
15011.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15012This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15013callout verification. The default value is
15014.code
15015$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15016.endd
15017See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15018
15019
15020.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
15021See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15022
15023
15024.option check_log_space main integer 10M
15025See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15026
15027.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15028.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15029.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15030RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15031system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15032word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15033multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15034exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15035of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15036set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15037
15038
15039.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
15040See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15041
15042
15043.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
15044.cindex "checking disk space"
15045.cindex "disk space, checking"
15046.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15047The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15048message is accepted.
15049
15050.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15051.vindex "&$log_space$&"
15052.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15053.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15054When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15055want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15056testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15057&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15058
15059
15060&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15061either value is greater than zero, for example:
15062.code
15063check_spool_space = 100M
15064check_spool_inodes = 100
15065.endd
15066The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15067SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15068transit.
15069
15070&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15071files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15072&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15073
15074If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15075incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15076error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15077SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15078&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15079&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15080
15081The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15082number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15083If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15084
15085For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15086failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15087it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15088
15089There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15090Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15091high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15092may wish to deliberately disable them.
15093
15094.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15095.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15096.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15097The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15098these hosts.
15099Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15100
15101.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15102.cindex "restricting access to features"
15103This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15104administrative user.
15105This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15106
15107.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15108.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15109.cindex memory debugging
15110This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15111management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15112it should normally be left as default.
15113
15114.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15115.cindex "port" "for daemon"
15116.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15117This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15118listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15119backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15120
15121.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15122.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15123This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15124the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15125(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15126defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15127&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15128
15129.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15130See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15131
15132.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15133.cindex "warning of delay"
15134.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15135.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15136When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15137intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15138after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15139string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15140message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15141between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15142with
15143.code
15144delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15145.endd
15146the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15147the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15148because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15149just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15150.code
15151delay_warning = 6h
15152.endd
15153messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15154a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15155.code
15156delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15157.endd
15158Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15159which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15160Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15161
15162.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15163.vindex "&$domain$&"
15164The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15165deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15166expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15167forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15168&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15169not sent. The default is:
15170.code
15171delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15172 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15173 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15174 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15175 } {no}{yes}}
15176.endd
15177This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15178&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15179&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15180&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15181
15182.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15183.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15184.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15185If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15186delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15187the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15188of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15189chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15190
15191.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15192.cindex "load average"
15193.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15194When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15195becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15196ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15197See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15198
15199
15200.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15201.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15202Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15203message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15204handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15205should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15206removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15207occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15208
15209.option disable_fsync main boolean false
15210.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15211This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15212ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15213a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15214build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15215really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15216distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15217
15218When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15219updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15220such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15221Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15222
15223
15224.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15225.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15226If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15227activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15228that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15229etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15230to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15231
15232
15233.new
15234.option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15235.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15236This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15237.wen
15238and an order of processing.
15239Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15240
15241Acceptable values include:
15242.code
15243sha1
15244sha256
15245sha512
15246.endd
15247
15248Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15249
15250.option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15251This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15252and an order of processing.
15253Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15254
15255.option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15256If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15257first success.
15258
15259.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15260.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15261This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15262It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15263the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15264See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15265
15266
15267.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15268.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15269DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15270&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15271keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15272incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15273may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15274anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15275This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15276by a setting such as this:
15277.code
15278dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15279.endd
15280This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15281&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15282since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15283&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15284when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15285options are applied after this global option.
15286
15287.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15288.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15289When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15290names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15291the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15292contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15293a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15294done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15295value of this option. The default pattern is
15296.code
15297dns_check_names_pattern = \
15298 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15299.endd
15300which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15301they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15302permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15303accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15304&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15305empty string.
15306
15307.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15308This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15309DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15310
15311.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15312This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15313reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15314section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15315
15316.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15317.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15318This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15319not do it internally.
15320As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15321If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15322
15323The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15324thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15325given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15326
15327
15328.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15329.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15330.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15331If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15332DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15333default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15334
15335If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15336
15337
15338.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15339.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15340.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15341.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15342When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15343looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15344(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15345domain matches this list.
15346
15347This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15348not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15349servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15350Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15351this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15352only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15353
15354
15355.option dns_retrans main time 0s
15356.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15357.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15358.cindex "DNS" timeout
15359The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15360retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15361defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15362time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15363totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15364take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15365parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15366but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15367to set in them.
15368See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15369
15370
15371.option dns_retry main integer 0
15372See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15373
15374
15375.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15376.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15377.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15378If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15379(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15380DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15381match with this expanded domain list.
15382
15383Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15384authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15385bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15386mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15387Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15388a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15389
15390Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15391to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15392zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15393
15394If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15395in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15396authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15397authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15398record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15399
15400.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15401.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15402.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15403.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15404.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15405If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15406DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15407the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15408on.
15409
15410If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15411
15412OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15413means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15414is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15415
15416
15417.option drop_cr main boolean false
15418This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15419handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15420described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15421
15422.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15423.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15424.cindex "DSN" "success"
15425.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15426DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15427and accepted from, these hosts.
15428Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15429and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15430A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15431A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15432are sent.
15433
15434.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15435.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15436.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15437This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15438bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15439Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15440.code
15441dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15442.endd
15443The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15444panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15445
15446.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15447.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15448Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15449message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15450handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15451message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15452be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15453the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15454delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15455
15456
15457.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15458.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15459.cindex "copy of bounce message"
15460Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15461generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15462coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15463items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15464a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15465must be enclosed in double quotes.
15466
15467Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15468(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15469the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15470items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15471are examined. For example:
15472.code
15473errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15474 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15475 postmaster@mydomain.example
15476.endd
15477.vindex "&$domain$&"
15478.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15479The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15480and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15481there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15482.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15483variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15484
15485
15486.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15487.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15488By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15489.display
15490&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15491.endd
15492.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15493where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15494A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15495&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15496overrides the default.
15497
15498Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15499&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15500and warning messages. For example:
15501.code
15502errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15503.endd
15504The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15505address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15506&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15507own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15508not used.
15509
15510
15511.option event_action main string&!! unset
15512.cindex events
15513This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15514For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15515
15516
15517.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15518.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15519.cindex "Exim group"
15520This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15521privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15522option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15523of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15524configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15525security issues.
15526
15527
15528.option exim_path main string "see below"
15529.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15530This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15531needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15532the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15533is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15534other place.
15535&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15536you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15537where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15538settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15539
15540
15541.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15542.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15543.cindex "Exim user"
15544This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15545privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15546time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15547options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15548
15549Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15550&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15551not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15552used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15553
15554
15555.option exim_version main string "current version"
15556.cindex "Exim version"
15557.cindex customizing "version number"
15558.cindex "version number of Exim" override
15559This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15560various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15561
15562
15563.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15564This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15565routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15566&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15567
15568
15569. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15570. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15571
15572.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15573 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15574.oindex "&%-t%&"
15575.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15576.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15577According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15578are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15579envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15580line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15581behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15582command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15583&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15584argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15585addresses.
15586
15587
15588.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15589.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15590On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15591distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15592related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15593Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15594errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15595many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15596retries.
15597
15598.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15599You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15600a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15601search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15602
15603
15604
15605.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15606.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15607On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15608ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15609delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15610&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15611feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15612warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15613freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15614is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15615supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15616message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15617freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15618log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15619logging that you require.
15620
15621
15622.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15623.cindex "HP-UX"
15624.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15625Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15626password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15627looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15628headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15629of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15630it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15631upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15632
15633When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15634expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15635login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15636user's name.
15637
15638.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15639Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15640pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15641name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15642.code
15643gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15644gecos_name = $1
15645.endd
15646
15647.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15648See &%gecos_name%& above.
15649
15650
15651.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15652This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15653server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15654implementations of TLS.
15655
15656
15657.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15658This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15659the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15660
15661See
15662&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15663for documentation.
15664
15665
15666
15667.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15668This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15669&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15670default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15671ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15672insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15673
15674
15675
15676.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15677.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15678.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15679This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15680section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15681&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15682sections are rejected.
15683
15684
15685.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15686.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15687.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15688This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15689all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15690header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15691zero means &"no limit"&.
15692
15693
15694
15695
15696.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15697.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15698.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15699Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15700mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15701some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15702this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15703if you want to do semantic checking.
15704See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15705set.
15706
15707
15708.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15709.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15710.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15711.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15712This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15713all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15714hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15715.code
15716helo_allow_chars = _
15717.endd
15718Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15719
15720
15721.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15722.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15723.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15724If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15725list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15726default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15727its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15728do.
15729
15730
15731.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15732.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15733.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15734By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15735&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15736to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15737condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15738Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15739to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15740necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15741encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15742Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15743
15744When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15745&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15746EHLO command either:
15747
15748.ilist
15749is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15750.next
15751.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15752.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15753matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15754calling host address, or
15755.next
15756when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15757.endlist
15758
15759However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15760fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15761be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15762
15763If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15764.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15765&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15766
15767.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15768.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15769.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15770Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15771backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15772name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15773&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15774rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15775If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15776error.
15777
15778.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15779.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15780.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15781This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15782manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15783&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15784verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15785item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15786it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15787
15788This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15789delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15790configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15791domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15792&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15793
15794A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15795messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15796time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15797retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15798
15799
15800.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15801.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15802Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15803is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15804&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15805option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15806default configuration file contains
15807.code
15808host_lookup = *
15809.endd
15810which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15811is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15812
15813After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15814has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15815this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15816
15817.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15818.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15819After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15820unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15821&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15822&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15823
15824
15825.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15826This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15827to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15828first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15829if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15830if you want.
15831
15832&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15833multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15834&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15835case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15836
15837
15838
15839.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15840.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15841If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15842as soon as the connection is made.
15843This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15844nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15845connections immediately.
15846
15847The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15848ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15849sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15850incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15851chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15852
15853
15854.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15855.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15856This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15857happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15858you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15859127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15860the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15861list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15862local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15863.code
15864hosts_connection_nolog = :
15865.endd
15866If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15867
15868
15869
15870.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15871.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15872This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15873connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15874
15875
15876.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15877.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15878.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15879If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15880if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15881records
15882or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15883host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15884
15885This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15886&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15887section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15888&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15889that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15890chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15891interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15892
15893
15894.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15895.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15896This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15897to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15898The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15899
15900
15901
15902.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15903.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15904.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15905This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15906that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15907suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15908
15909After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15910because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15911message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15912the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15913again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15914bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15915for frozen messages. For example,
15916.code
15917ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15918.endd
15919retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15920failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15921failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15922value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15923dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15924&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15925
15926
15927.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15928.cindex "&""From""& line"
15929.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15930Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15931the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15932message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15933such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15934match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15935process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15936&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15937
15938
15939.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15940See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15941
15942.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15943.cindex "environment" "values from"
15944This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15945You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15946these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15947during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15948installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15949environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15950external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15951
15952Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15953(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15954
15955WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15956FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15957unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15958that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15959
15960Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15961&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15962current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15963anymore.
15964
15965See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15966environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15967transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15968details.
15969
15970
15971.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15972This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15973have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15974next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15975logged.
15976
15977
15978.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15979.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15980.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15981This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15982a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15983While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15984Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15985and constrained to be a directory.
15986
15987
15988.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15989.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15990.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15991This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15992a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15993While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15994Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15995and constrained to be a file.
15996
15997
15998.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15999.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16000.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16001This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16002Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16003Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16004
16005
16006.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16007.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16008.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16009This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16010to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16011Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16012identity to be proven.
16013
16014
16015.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16016.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16017This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16018the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16019cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16020
16021
16022.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16023.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16024This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16025LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16026details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16027with LDAP support.
16028
16029
16030.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16031.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16032This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16033A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16034See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16035Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16036to hard/demand.
16037
16038
16039.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16040.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16041If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16042connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16043"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16044of SSL-on-connect.
16045In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16046by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16047This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16048
16049
16050.option ldap_version main integer unset
16051.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16052This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16053LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16054-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16055the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16056has been built with LDAP support.
16057
16058
16059
16060.option local_from_check main boolean true
16061.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16062.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16063When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16064an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16065checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16066the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16067
16068&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16069locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16070&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16071
16072You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16073on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16074&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16075and the default qualify domain.
16076
16077If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16078and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16079&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16080&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16081
16082.cindex "envelope from"
16083.cindex "envelope sender"
16084These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16085is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16086&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16087
16088For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16089request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16090has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16091
16092
16093
16094
16095.option local_from_prefix main string unset
16096When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16097matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16098ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16099done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16100appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16101&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16102example, if
16103.code
16104local_from_prefix = *-
16105.endd
16106is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16107.code
16108From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16109.endd
16110will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16111matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16112qualify domain.
16113
16114
16115.option local_from_suffix main string unset
16116See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16117
16118
16119.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16120This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16121listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16122&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16123options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16124&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16125&%local_interfaces%& is
16126.code
16127local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16128.endd
16129when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16130.code
16131local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16132.endd
16133
16134.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16135.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16136.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16137This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16138&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16139the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16140message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16141non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16142
16143
16144
16145.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16146.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16147When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16148an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16149do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16150also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16151See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16152&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16153
16154
16155
16156
16157.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16158.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16159.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16160.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16161Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16162uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16163value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16164after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16165host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16166range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16167systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16168&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16169characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16170time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16171section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16172
16173
16174
16175.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16176.cindex "log" "file path for"
16177This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16178files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16179when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16180name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16181or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16182they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16183A path must start with a slash.
16184To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16185Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16186section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16187used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16188variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16189configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16190&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16191early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16192
16193
16194.option log_selector main string unset
16195.cindex "log" "selectors"
16196This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16197writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16198minus characters. For example:
16199.code
16200log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16201.endd
16202A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16203logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16204
16205
16206.option log_timezone main boolean false
16207.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16208.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16209.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16210By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16211timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16212in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16213avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16214&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16215timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16216of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16217&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16218another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16219
16220
16221.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16222.cindex "too many open files"
16223.cindex "open files, too many"
16224.cindex "file" "too many open"
16225.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16226.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16227This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16228lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16229Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16230file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16231recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16232actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16233as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16234open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16235&%lookup_open_max%&.
16236
16237
16238.option max_username_length main integer 0
16239.cindex "length of login name"
16240.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16241.cindex "limit" "user name length"
16242Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16243&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16244this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16245an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16246
16247
16248.option message_body_newlines main bool false
16249.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16250.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16251.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16252.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16253By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16254the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16255option is set true, this no longer happens.
16256
16257
16258.option message_body_visible main integer 500
16259.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16260.cindex "message body" "visible size"
16261.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16262.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16263This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16264&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16265
16266
16267.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16268.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16269If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16270(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16271locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16272means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16273Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16274Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16275replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16276empty string, the option is ignored.
16277
16278
16279.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16280If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16281the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16282message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16283take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16284the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16285it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16286yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16287before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16288that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16289means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16290colons will become hyphens.
16291
16292
16293.option message_logs main boolean true
16294.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16295.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16296If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16297&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16298Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16299minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16300per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16301which is not affected by this option.
16302
16303
16304.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16305.cindex "message" "size limit"
16306.cindex "limit" "message size"
16307.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16308This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16309value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16310to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16311TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16312optionally followed by K or M.
16313
16314&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16315other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16316the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16317error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16318&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16319
16320Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16321exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16322failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16323an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16324the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16325message that an individual transport can process.
16326
16327If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16328maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16329failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16330virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16331probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16332default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16333some problems may result.
16334
16335A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16336SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16337SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16338
16339
16340.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16341.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16342This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16343.code
16344SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16345.endd
16346in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16347moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16348and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16349standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16350lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16351
16352
16353.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16354Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16355it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16356contains a full description of this facility.
16357
16358
16359
16360.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16361.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16362This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16363be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16364option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16365
16366
16367.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16368This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16369message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16370recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16371It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16372safety precaution.
16373
16374When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16375list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16376the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16377contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16378can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16379
16380If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16381&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16382example is
16383.code
16384never_users = root:daemon:bin
16385.endd
16386Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16387harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16388transport driver.
16389
16390
16391.new
16392.option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16393This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16394listens for work and information-requests.
16395Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16396should need to modify the default.
16397
16398The option is expanded before use.
16399If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16400is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16401Otherwise, it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16402to Exim.
16403
16404If the Exim command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&
16405then a notifier socket is not created.
16406.wen
16407
16408
16409.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16410.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16411This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16412by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16413each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16414
16415This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16416available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16417The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16418the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16419list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16420&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16421names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16422
16423Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16424SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16425yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16426adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16427invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16428
16429The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16430
16431Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16432"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16433with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16434some now infamous attacks.
16435
16436Examples:
16437.code
16438# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16439openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16440 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16441
16442# Disable older protocol versions:
16443openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16444.endd
16445
16446Possible options may include:
16447.ilist
16448&`all`&
16449.next
16450&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16451.next
16452&`cipher_server_preference`&
16453.next
16454&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16455.next
16456&`ephemeral_rsa`&
16457.next
16458&`legacy_server_connect`&
16459.next
16460&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16461.next
16462&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16463.next
16464&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16465.next
16466&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16467.next
16468&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16469.next
16470&`no_compression`&
16471.next
16472&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16473.next
16474&`no_sslv2`&
16475.next
16476&`no_sslv3`&
16477.next
16478&`no_ticket`&
16479.next
16480&`no_tlsv1`&
16481.next
16482&`no_tlsv1_1`&
16483.next
16484&`no_tlsv1_2`&
16485.next
16486&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16487.next
16488&`single_dh_use`&
16489.next
16490&`single_ecdh_use`&
16491.next
16492&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16493.next
16494&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16495.next
16496&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16497.next
16498&`tls_d5_bug`&
16499.next
16500&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16501.endlist
16502
16503As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16504all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16505to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16506to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16507release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16508where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16509
16510
16511.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16512.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16513This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16514to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16515The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16516
16517
16518.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16519.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16520.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16521.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16522The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16523percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16524replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16525also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16526option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16527but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16528an ACL.
16529
16530&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16531trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16532if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16533implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16534routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16535a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16536local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16537
16538
16539.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16540.cindex "Perl"
16541This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16542interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16543
16544
16545.option perl_startup main string unset
16546.cindex "Perl"
16547This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16548interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16549
16550.option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16551.cindex "Perl"
16552This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16553
16554
16555.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16556.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16557This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16558data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16559&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16560PostgreSQL support.
16561
16562
16563.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16564.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16565.cindex "pid file, path for"
16566This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16567process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16568to the host name:
16569.code
16570pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16571.endd
16572If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16573spool directory.
16574The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16575option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16576of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16577
16578
16579.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16580.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16581This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16582PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16583control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16584&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16585for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16586that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16587not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16588
16589.option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16590.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16591.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16592If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16593this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16594and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16595commands are acceptable.
16596When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16597
16598See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16599
16600Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16601
16602
16603.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16604.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16605This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16606to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16607If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16608If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16609an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16610is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16611
16612.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16613.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16614If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16615completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16616called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16617purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16618volume of mail. Use with care!
16619
16620
16621.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16622.cindex "name" "of local host"
16623.cindex "host" "name of local"
16624.cindex "local host" "name of"
16625.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16626This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16627HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16628option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16629The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16630server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16631
16632If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16633name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16634contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16635&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16636version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16637explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16638
16639
16640.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16641.cindex "printing characters"
16642.cindex "8-bit characters"
16643By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1664432&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16645when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16646sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16647is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16648characters.
16649
16650This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16651&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16652the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16653described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16654Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16655standards.
16656
16657
16658.option process_log_path main string unset
16659.cindex "process log path"
16660.cindex "log" "process log"
16661.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16662This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16663&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16664utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16665in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16666can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16667different spool directories.
16668
16669
16670.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16671.cindex "restricting access to features"
16672.oindex "&%-M%&"
16673.oindex "&%-R%&"
16674.oindex "&%-q%&"
16675The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16676admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16677&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16678
16679
16680.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16681.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16682.cindex "address" "qualification"
16683This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16684addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16685recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16686are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16687also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16688locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16689
16690Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16691unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16692&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16693addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16694necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16695addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16696&%primary_hostname%& value.
16697
16698
16699.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16700This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16701addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16702
16703
16704
16705.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16706.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16707.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16708.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16709This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16710A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16711domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16712next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16713
16714
16715.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16716.cindex "restricting access to features"
16717.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16718The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16719queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16720&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16721See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16722
16723
16724.option queue_only main boolean false
16725.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16726.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16727If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16728whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16729next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16730delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16731
16732The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16733and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16734&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16735&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16736
16737
16738.option queue_only_file main string unset
16739.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16740.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16741This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16742one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16743it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16744each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16745For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16746&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16747.code
16748queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16749.endd
16750causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16751&_/some/file_& exists.
16752
16753
16754.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16755.cindex "load average"
16756.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16757.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16758If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16759all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16760happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16761the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16762the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16763false.
16764
16765Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16766option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16767determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16768&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16769
16770
16771.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16772.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16773When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16774because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16775all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16776This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16777threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16778connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16779circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16780where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16781should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16782re-evaluated for each message.
16783
16784
16785.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16786.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16787When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16788setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16789&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16790to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16791
16792
16793.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16794.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16795If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16796in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16797must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16798single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16799and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16800single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16801the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16802avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16803&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16804when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16805large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16806
16807
16808
16809.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16810.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16811This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16812can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16813but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16814start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16815very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16816however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16817started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16818
16819Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16820the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16821run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16822the daemon's command line.
16823
16824.cindex queues named
16825.cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
16826To set limits for different named queues use
16827an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16828
16829.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16830.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16831.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16832.cindex "first pass routing"
16833When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16834received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16835However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16836&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16837message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16838has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16839when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16840over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16841SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16842&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16843&%queue_domains%&.
16844
16845
16846.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16847.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16848This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16849maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16850the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16851&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16852controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16853
16854.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16855.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16856.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16857This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16858added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16859on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16860used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16861added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16862&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16863header lines.
16864The default setting is:
16865
16866.code
16867received_header_text = Received: \
16868 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16869 {${if def:sender_ident \
16870 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16871 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16872 by $primary_hostname \
16873 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16874 ${if def:tls_ver { ($tls_ver)}}\
16875 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16876 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16877 ${if def:sender_address \
16878 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16879 id $message_exim_id\
16880 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16881.endd
16882
16883The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16884support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16885locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16886header lines such as the following:
16887.code
16888Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16889by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16890(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16891id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16892for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16893Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16894id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16895.endd
16896Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16897the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16898checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16899message was accepted.
16900
16901
16902.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16903.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16904.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16905.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16906When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16907counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16908have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16909This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16910
16911
16912.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16913.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16914.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16915This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16916recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16917qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16918affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16919addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16920host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16921or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16922option was not set.
16923
16924
16925.option recipients_max main integer 0
16926.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16927.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16928If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16929original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16930by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16931all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16932Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16933done.
16934
16935.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16936&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16937RCPT commands in a single message.
16938
16939
16940.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16941If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16942recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16943error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16944error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16945initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16946for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16947
16948
16949.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16950.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16951This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16952hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16953does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16954message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16955have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16956deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16957deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16958each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16959same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16960&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16961with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16962tagged with its process id.
16963
16964This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16965message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16966manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16967deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16968is received.
16969
16970.cindex "number of deliveries"
16971.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16972If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16973need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16974are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16975daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16976fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16977runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16978delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16979then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16980&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16981
16982If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16983&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16984doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16985host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16986
16987
16988.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16989.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16990.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16991When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16992domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16993.code
16994remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16995.endd
16996would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16997then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16998
16999
17000.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17001.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17002This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17003database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17004host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17005past failures.
17006
17007
17008.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17009.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17010.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17011Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17012intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17013straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17014retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17015the default value.
17016
17017
17018.option return_path_remove main boolean true
17019.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17020RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17021&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17022The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17023MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17024in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17025&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17026received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17027the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17028
17029
17030.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17031This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17032
17033
17034.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17035.cindex "RFC 1413"
17036.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17037RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17038an item in the list.
17039The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17040for the system.
17041
17042.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17043.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17044.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17045This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17046no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17047
17048
17049.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17050.cindex "unqualified addresses"
17051.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17052This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17053sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17054&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17055not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17056it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17057&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17058using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17059
17060
17061.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17062.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17063.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17064This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17065If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17066and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17067Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17068
17069
17070
17071.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17072.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17073This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17074TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17075connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17076other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17077still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17078this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17079connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17080tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17081hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17082
17083
17084
17085.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17086.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17087.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17088.cindex "inetd"
17089This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17090that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17091control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17092value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17093non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17094set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17095
17096A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17097has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17098that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17099and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17100
17101
17102.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17103.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17104.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17105Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17106the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17107check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17108client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17109client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17110
17111When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17112allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17113but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17114or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17115starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17116counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17117following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17118MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17119
17120
17121.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17122You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17123check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17124changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17125live with.
17126
17127
17128. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17129. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17130. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17131. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17132. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17133. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17134. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17135. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17136. the option name to split.
17137
17138.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17139 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17140.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17141.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17142The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17143prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17144results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17145response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17146precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17147seen).
17148
17149
17150.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17151.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17152.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17153This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17154host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17155expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17156reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17157connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17158is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17159of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17160required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17161
17162&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17163constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17164happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17165without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17166could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17167doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17168
17169
17170
17171.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17172.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17173.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17174.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17175If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17176listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17177in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17178fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17179subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17180to all messages received in the same connection.
17181
17182A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17183if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17184also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17185various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17186
17187
17188. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17189
17190.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17191 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17192.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17193.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17194This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17195automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17196the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17197and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17198number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17199are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17200restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17201systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17202dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17203
17204
17205.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17206.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17207.cindex "host" "reserved"
17208When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17209number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17210that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17211&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17212restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17213of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17214of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17215the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17216individual host.
17217
17218For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17219set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17220connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17221provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17222
17223
17224.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17225.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17226.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17227.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17228This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17229several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17230is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17231responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17232incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17233
17234.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17235The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17236is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17237in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17238
17239If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17240expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17241used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17242panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17243value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17244For example:
17245.code
17246smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17247 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17248.endd
17249
17250Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17251messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17252verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17253&%helo_data%& value.
17254
17255.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17256.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17257.cindex "banner for SMTP"
17258.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17259.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17260This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17261positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17262.code
17263smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17264 $version_number $tod_full
17265.endd
17266Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17267multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17268appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17269in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17270multiline response).
17271
17272
17273.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17274.cindex "checking disk space"
17275.cindex "disk space, checking"
17276.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17277When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17278option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17279spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17280leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17281is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17282
17283
17284.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17285.cindex "connection backlog"
17286.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17287.cindex "backlog of connections"
17288This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17289this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17290of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17291attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17292say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17293out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17294value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17295attacks by SYN flooding.
17296
17297
17298.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17299.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17300.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17301The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17302the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17303synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17304fewer, but they still exist.
17305
17306Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17307for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17308client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17309SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17310for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17311input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17312does detect many instances.
17313
17314The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17315If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17316hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17317(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17318
17319
17320
17321.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17322.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17323.vindex "&$domain$&"
17324If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17325command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17326chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17327are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17328argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17329example:
17330.code
17331smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17332 $sender_host_address
17333.endd
17334.new
17335If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17336be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17337In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17338if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17339.wen
17340
17341A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17342complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17343run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17344a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17345receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17346the command.
17347
17348
17349.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17350.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17351When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17352one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17353section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17354
17355
17356.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17357.cindex "load average"
17358If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17359accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17360If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17361the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17362systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17363&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17364
17365
17366
17367.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17368.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17369.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17370Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17371particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17372.code
17373RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17374.endd
17375causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17376(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17377example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17378too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17379dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17380
17381.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17382When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17383&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17384Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17385&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17386not count towards the limit.
17387
17388
17389
17390.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17391.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17392.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17393If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17394Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17395that subvert web
17396clients
17397into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17398non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17399
17400
17401
17402.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17403.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17404.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17405.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17406Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17407can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17408recipients.
17409
17410Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17411facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17412&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17413&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17414
17415When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17416&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17417rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17418respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17419values:
17420
17421.ilist
17422A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17423.next
17424An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17425fractional parts are allowed here.
17426.next
17427A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17428.next
17429A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17430because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17431.endlist
17432
17433For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17434first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17435.code
17436smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17437smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17438.endd
17439The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17440two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17441seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17442delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17443
17444
17445.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17446See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17447
17448
17449.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17450See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17451
17452
17453.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17454.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17455.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17456This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17457input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17458data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17459the message is abandoned.
17460A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17461.code
17462SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17463SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17464.endd
17465The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17466means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17467
17468If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17469expanded before use and may depend on
17470&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17471
17472
17473.oindex "&%-os%&"
17474The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17475&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17476this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17477of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17478timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17479
17480
17481.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17482This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17483&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17484
17485
17486.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17487.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17488.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17489In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17490&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17491reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17492to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17493policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17494&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17495example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17496.code
17497550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17498550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17499.endd
17500
17501
17502.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17503.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17504When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17505the availability thereof is advertised in
17506response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17507chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17508
17509
17510.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17511This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17512extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17513See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17514
17515
17516
17517.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17518This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17519See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17520
17521
17522
17523.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17524.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17525.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17526.cindex "directories, multiple"
17527If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17528subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17529sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17530subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17531arrival of the message.
17532
17533Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17534where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17535directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17536directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17537are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17538
17539It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17540changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17541&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17542after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17543automatically deleted.
17544
17545When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17546changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17547trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17548sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17549sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17550spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17551particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17552if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17553entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17554
17555
17556.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17557.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17558This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17559it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17560configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17561string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17562&$primary_hostname$&.
17563
17564If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17565that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17566log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17567Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17568as failures in the configuration file.
17569
17570By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17571tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17572
17573.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17574.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17575If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17576for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17577Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17578Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17579option.
17580
17581The following variables will not have useful values:
17582.code
17583$max_received_linelength
17584$body_linecount
17585$body_zerocount
17586.endd
17587
17588Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17589and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17590(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17591will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17592
17593Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17594(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17595The transmission benefit is maintained.
17596
17597.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17598.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17599This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17600access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17601
17602.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17603.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17604This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17605variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17606is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17607&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17608
17609.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17610.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17611If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17612items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17613treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17614passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17615option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17616
17617
17618.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17619.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17620.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17621If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17622ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17623MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17624domain causes a syntax error.
17625However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17626syntax checking.
17627
17628
17629.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17630.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17631When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17632separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17633be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17634separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17635nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17636particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17637both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17638containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17639Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17640the LOG_ALERT priority.
17641
17642
17643.option syslog_facility main string unset
17644.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17645This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17646syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17647&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17648If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17649details of Exim's logging.
17650
17651
17652.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17653.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17654If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17655omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17656the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17657to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17658into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17659
17660
17661
17662.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17663.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17664This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17665syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17666&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17667
17668
17669
17670.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17671.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17672If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17673omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17674details of Exim's logging.
17675
17676
17677.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17678.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17679.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17680.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17681This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17682the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17683must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17684generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17685appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17686which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17687&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17688A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17689
17690
17691.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17692.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17693This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17694&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17695implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17696During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17697
17698
17699.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17700.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17701This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17702command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17703the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17704
17705.option system_filter_group main string unset
17706.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17707This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17708gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17709with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17710
17711.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17712.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17713.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17714This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17715is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17716contains the pipe command.
17717
17718
17719.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17720.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17721This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17722is used in a system filter.
17723
17724
17725.option system_filter_user main string unset
17726.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17727If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17728delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17729process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17730Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17731is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17732configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17733specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17734&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17735
17736If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17737under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17738transport option overrides.
17739
17740
17741.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17742.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17743.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17744.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17745If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17746TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17747turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17748performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17749should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17750However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17751this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17752daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17753TCP_NODELAY.
17754
17755
17756.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17757.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17758.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17759If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17760message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17761is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17762bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17763sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17764If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17765frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17766
17767&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17768frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17769messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17770
17771
17772.option timezone main string unset
17773.cindex "timezone, setting"
17774.cindex "environment" "values from"
17775The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17776running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17777created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17778to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17779.code
17780timezone = UTC
17781.endd
17782The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17783or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17784is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17785time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17786runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17787unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17788
17789
17790.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17791.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17792.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17793.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17794When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17795of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17796response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17797chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17798Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17799using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17800is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17801
17802
17803.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17804.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17805.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17806The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17807files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17808Commonly only one file is needed.
17809The server's private key is also
17810assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17811&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17812
17813&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17814receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17815use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17816option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17817
17818&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17819separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17820
17821&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17822when a list of more than one
17823file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17824The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17825
17826If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17827if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17828Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17829&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17830
17831If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17832generated for every connection.
17833
17834.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17835.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17836.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17837This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17838be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17839
17840Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17841
17842&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17843for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17844For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17845
17846See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17847
17848
17849.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17850.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17851The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17852the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17853interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17854suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17855
17856The value must be at least 1024.
17857
17858The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17859hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17860by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17861
17862If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17863number.
17864
17865Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17866little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17867larger prime than requested.
17868
17869
17870.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17871.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17872The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17873to be used by Exim.
17874
17875This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
17876The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
17877
17878&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
17879for other TLS library versions,
17880using a filename with site-generated
17881local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17882other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17883"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17884
17885If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17886then it names a file from which DH
17887parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17888PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17889OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17890fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17891loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17892and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17893
17894If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17895loaded by Exim.
17896
17897If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17898Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17899does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17900See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17901
17902If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17903a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17904
17905In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
179062.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17907in IKE is assigned number 23.
17908
17909Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17910of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17911sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17912the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17913&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17914
17915The available standard primes are:
17916&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17917&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17918&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17919&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17920
17921The available additional primes are:
17922&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17923
17924Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17925Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17926The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17927of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17928(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17929
17930At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17931they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17932candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17933
17934The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17935to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17936whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17937tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17938need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17939userbase.
17940
17941Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17942is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17943applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17944used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17945mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17946prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17947acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17948
17949
17950.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17951.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17952This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17953It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17954
17955After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17956&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17957for valid selections.
17958
17959For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17960&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17961&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17962
17963If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17964
17965
17966.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17967.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17968.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17969This option
17970must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17971status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17972Certificate Authority.
17973
17974Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17975The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
17976
17977For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
17978for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17979of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17980The ordering of the two lists must match.
17981The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
17982
17983The file(s) should be in DER format,
17984except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
17985or for OpenSSL,
17986when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
17987The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
17988a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
17989files in the list; the initial format is DER.
17990If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
17991(this only works under TLS1.3)
17992they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
17993
17994Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
17995PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
17996TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
17997although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
17998
17999.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18000.cindex SSMTP
18001.cindex SMTPS
18002This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18003operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18004set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18005further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18006
18007
18008
18009.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
18010.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18011The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18012files which contains the server's private keys.
18013If this option is unset, or if
18014the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18015key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18016&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18017
18018See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18019
18020
18021.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18022.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18023.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18024If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18025&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18026support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18027TLS session.
18028
18029
18030.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18031.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18032.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18033This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18034The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18035connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18036different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18037permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18038in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18039preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18040&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18041
18042
18043.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18044.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18045.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18046See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18047
18048
18049.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18050.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18051.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18052The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18053word "system"
18054or the absolute path to
18055a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18056match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18057
18058The "system" value for the option will use a
18059system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18060This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18061and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18062must be specified.
18063
18064The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18065preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18066
18067With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18068explicitly
18069either by file or directory
18070are added to those given by the system default location.
18071
18072These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18073than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18074the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18075connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18076Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18077use the explicit directory version.
18078
18079See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18080
18081A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18082being unset.
18083
18084
18085.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18086.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18087.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18088This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18089certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18090&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18091either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18092&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18093
18094Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18095&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18096present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18097aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18098the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18099connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18100ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18101
18102A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18103matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18104certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18105abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18106state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18107such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18108but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18109certificate"&.
18110
18111Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18112certificates.
18113
18114
18115.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18116.cindex "trusted groups"
18117.cindex "groups" "trusted"
18118This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18119option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18120which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18121specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18122details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18123&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18124are trusted.
18125
18126.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18127.cindex "trusted users"
18128.cindex "user" "trusted"
18129This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18130option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18131trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18132&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18133If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18134Exim user are trusted.
18135
18136.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18137.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18138.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18139This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18140the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18141gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18142used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18143can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18144is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18145&%-F%& option.
18146
18147.option unknown_username main string unset
18148See &%unknown_login%&.
18149
18150.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18151.cindex "trusted users"
18152.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18153.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18154.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18155.cindex "envelope from"
18156.cindex "envelope sender"
18157When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18158normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18159default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18160senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18161is used) is ignored.
18162
18163However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18164to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18165.code
18166exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18167.endd
18168.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18169The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18170other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18171users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18172patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18173identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18174users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18175followed by a hyphen
18176by a setting like this:
18177.code
18178untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18179.endd
18180If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18181restriction, you can use
18182.code
18183untrusted_set_sender = *
18184.endd
18185The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18186only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18187to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18188parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18189&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18190necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18191overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18192described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18193
18194The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18195&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18196&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18197envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18198sender address.
18199
18200
18201.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18202.cindex "&""From""& line"
18203.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18204Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18205an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18206particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18207of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18208matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18209&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18210default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18211.code
18212From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18213From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18214.endd
18215The pattern can be seen by running
18216.code
18217exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18218.endd
18219It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18220year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18221regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18222&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18223(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18224&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18225
18226
18227.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18228See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18229
18230
18231.option warn_message_file main string unset
18232.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18233.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18234This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18235for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18236been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18237&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18238&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18239
18240
18241.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18242.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18243If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18244See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18245.ecindex IIDconfima
18246.ecindex IIDmaiconf
18247
18248
18249
18250
18251. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18252. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18253
18254.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18255.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18256.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18257This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18258Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18259
18260For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18261&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18262which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18263provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18264&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18265
18266
18267
18268.option address_data routers string&!! unset
18269.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18270The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18271precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18272router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18273&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18274delivery of the address to be deferred.
18275
18276.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18277When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18278accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18279routers, and the eventual transport.
18280
18281&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18282that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18283in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18284either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18285put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18286
18287Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18288with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18289on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18290&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18291&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18292
18293The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18294for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18295you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18296.code
18297uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18298.endd
18299In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18300.code
18301file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18302.endd
18303This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18304lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18305
18306See also the &%set%& option below.
18307
18308.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18309.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18310The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18311from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18312&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18313ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18314verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18315
18316
18317
18318.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18319.oindex "&%-bt%&"
18320.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18321If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18322by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18323your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18324having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18325routing.
18326
18327
18328
18329.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18330.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18331.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18332This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18333routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18334&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18335&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18336value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18337includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18338well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18339you could put:
18340.code
18341cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18342.endd
18343on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18344and
18345.code
18346cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18347.endd
18348on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18349this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18350explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18351logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18352
18353
18354.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18355.cindex "case of local parts"
18356.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18357By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18358manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18359If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18360this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18361part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18362turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18363more details.
18364
18365.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18366.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18367.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18368The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18369router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18370an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18371is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18372addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18373and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18374
18375This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18376recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18377modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18378(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18379
18380
18381
18382.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18383.cindex "local user, checking in router"
18384.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18385.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18386.vindex "&$home$&"
18387When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18388address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18389local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18390than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18391holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18392user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18393preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18394given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18395overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18396the router is skipped.
18397
18398If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18399or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18400setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18401two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18402setting to achieve this. For example:
18403.code
18404local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18405.endd
18406Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18407up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18408&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18409
18410
18411
18412.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18413.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18414This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18415router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18416evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18417result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18418&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18419router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18420
18421If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18422precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18423
18424This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18425All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18426
18427The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18428running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18429the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18430.code
18431condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18432.endd
18433Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18434.code
18435condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18436.endd
18437
18438A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18439.code
18440condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18441condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18442condition = foobar
18443.endd
18444
18445If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18446of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18447be specified using &%condition%&.
18448
18449Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18450are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18451they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18452parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18453ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18454Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18455Router rules processing behavior.
18456
18457This is best illustrated in an example:
18458.code
18459# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18460# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18461
18462$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18463true {yes} {no}}
18464
18465$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18466 {yes} {no}}
18467.endd
18468In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18469&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18470default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18471(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18472string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18473with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18474resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18475&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18476
18477In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18478&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18479mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18480conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18481string characters.
18482
18483Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18484true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18485match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18486contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18487expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18488
18489
18490.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18491.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18492If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18493option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18494the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18495If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18496output, and Exim carries on processing.
18497This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18498so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18499option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18500variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18501&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18502are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18503The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18504
18505
18506
18507.option disable_logging routers boolean false
18508If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18509or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18510unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18511transport option of the same name.
18512
18513.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18514.cindex "MX record" "security"
18515.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18516.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18517.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18518DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18519the dnssec request bit set.
18520This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18521
18522.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18523.cindex "MX record" "security"
18524.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18525.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18526.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18527DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18528the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18529(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18530This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18531
18532
18533.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18534.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18535.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18536If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18537the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18538lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18539expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18540a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18541
18542
18543
18544.option driver routers string unset
18545This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18546to be used.
18547
18548
18549.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18550.cindex "DSN" "success"
18551.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18552If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18553Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18554instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18555Not effective on redirect routers.
18556
18557
18558
18559.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18560.cindex "envelope from"
18561.cindex "envelope sender"
18562.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18563If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18564transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18565there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18566message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18567provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18568expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18569
18570The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18571subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18572settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18573setting.
18574
18575If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18576the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18577address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18578expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18579
18580If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18581SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18582any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18583sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18584settings:
18585.code
18586errors_to =
18587errors_to = ""
18588.endd
18589An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18590this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18591no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18592address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18593overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18594
18595.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18596If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18597MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18598path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18599setting &%return_path%&.
18600
18601The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18602manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18603implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18604
18605
18606
18607.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18608.cindex "address" "testing"
18609.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18610.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18611.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18612If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18613as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18614want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18615on for the system alias file.
18616See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18617are evaluated.
18618
18619The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18620&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18621an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18622
18623
18624
18625.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18626.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18627Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18628&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18629
18630
18631
18632.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18633If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18634verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18635
18636
18637
18638.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18639If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18640verifying a sender, verification fails.
18641
18642
18643
18644.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18645.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18646.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18647String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18648colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18649changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18650each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18651defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18652&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18653
18654If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18655associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18656list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18657randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18658transport for further details.
18659
18660
18661.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18662.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18663.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18664.cindex "transport" "local"
18665.cindex "router" "setting group"
18666When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18667specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18668process.
18669The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18670error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18671The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18672is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18673and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18674
18675
18676
18677.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18678.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18679.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18680This option specifies a list of text headers,
18681newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18682that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18683Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18684option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18685the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18686&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18687message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18688header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18689&"see"& the added header lines.
18690
18691The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18692&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18693an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18694failures are treated as configuration errors.
18695
18696Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18697for a router; all listed headers are added.
18698
18699&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18700router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18701
18702.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18703.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18704&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18705additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18706For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18707address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18708modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18709circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18710which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18711avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18712
18713
18714
18715.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18716.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18717.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18718This option specifies a list of text headers,
18719colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18720that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18721However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
18722Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
18723.new
18724If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
18725.wen
18726The way in which
18727the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18728section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18729the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18730to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18731&"see"& the original header lines.
18732
18733The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
18734&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18735the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18736errors.
18737
18738Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18739for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18740
18741&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18742router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18743
18744&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18745removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18746routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18747warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18748
18749&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18750items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18751To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18752
18753
18754
18755.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18756.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18757.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18758Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18759entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18760IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18761address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18762like
18763.code
18764remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18765.endd
18766by setting
18767.code
18768ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18769.endd
18770on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18771discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18772attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18773domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18774Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18775router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18776
18777You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18778means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18779.code
18780ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18781ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18782.endd
18783The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18784in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18785
18786This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18787addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18788is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18789domain that is being routed.
18790
18791.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18792During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18793checked.
18794
18795.option initgroups routers boolean false
18796.cindex "additional groups"
18797.cindex "groups" "additional"
18798.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18799.cindex "transport" "local"
18800If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18801the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18802&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18803any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18804and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18805
18806
18807
18808.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18809.cindex affix "router precondition"
18810.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18811.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18812If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18813one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18814section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18815evaluated.
18816
18817The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18818used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18819asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18820the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18821some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18822.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18823.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18824Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18825section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18826
18827.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18828.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18829During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18830running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18831expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18832the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18833a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18834command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18835This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18836the relevant transport.
18837
18838.new
18839.vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
18840If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
18841wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
18842.wen
18843
18844When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18845behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18846means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18847callout.
18848
18849The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18850&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18851&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18852to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18853immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18854.code
18855real_localuser:
18856 driver = accept
18857 local_part_prefix = real-
18858 check_local_user
18859 transport = local_delivery
18860.endd
18861For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18862router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18863.code
18864 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18865 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18866.endd
18867
18868If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18869both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18870are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18871separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18872
18873
18874.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18875See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18876
18877
18878
18879.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18880.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18881.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18882This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18883local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18884&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18885mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18886character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18887parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18888&%username-foo%&.
18889
18890
18891.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18892See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18893
18894
18895
18896.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18897.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18898.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18899The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18900See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18901are evaluated, and
18902section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18903string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18904example:
18905.code
18906local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18907.endd
18908.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18909If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18910for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18911expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18912example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18913send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18914each virtual domain:
18915.code
18916postmaster:
18917 driver = redirect
18918 local_parts = postmaster
18919 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18920.endd
18921
18922
18923.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18924.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18925.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18926Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18927deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18928recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18929this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18930router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18931router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18932redirect addresses.
18933
18934
18935
18936.option more routers boolean&!! true
18937The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18938that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18939result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18940fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18941delivery to be deferred.
18942
18943If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18944further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18945.oindex "&%self%&"
18946However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18947means of the setting
18948.code
18949self = pass
18950.endd
18951or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18952does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18953case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18954
18955Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18956expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18957controls what happens next.
18958
18959
18960.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18961.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18962.cindex "router" "timeout"
18963If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18964address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18965router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18966intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18967host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18968
18969There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18970lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18971applies to all of them.
18972
18973
18974
18975.option pass_router routers string unset
18976.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18977Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18978&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18979routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18980these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18981router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18982of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18983be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18984to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18985&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18986
18987
18988
18989.option redirect_router routers string unset
18990.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18991Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18992generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18993example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18994point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18995
18996The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18997It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18998instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18999which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19000
19001
19002
19003.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19004.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19005.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19006This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19007router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19008Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19009through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19010
19011Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19012be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19013(&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19014If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19015failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19016
19017If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19018below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19019&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19020existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19021preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19022
19023.cindex "NFS"
19024If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19025the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19026unavailable.
19027
19028This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19029options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19030look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19031full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19032these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19033to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19034that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19035transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19036
19037During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19038facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19039This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19040operates as follows:
19041
19042If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19043characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19044comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19045but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19046used. For example:
19047.code
19048require_files = mail:/some/file
19049require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
19050.endd
19051If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19052&%require_files%& condition fails.
19053
19054Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19055checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19056directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19057access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19058
19059&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19060incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19061may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19062may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19063user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19064
19065&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19066&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19067without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19068is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19069check again in that process.
19070
19071The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19072be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19073existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19074circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19075not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19076for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19077as if the file did not exist. For example:
19078.code
19079require_files = +/some/file
19080.endd
19081If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19082handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19083option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19084
19085
19086
19087.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19088.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19089.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19090When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19091in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19092domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19093other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19094Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19095latter kind.
19096
19097This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19098hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19099router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19100&%check_local_user%&,
19101&%local_parts%&,
19102&%condition%&,
19103&%local_part_prefix%&,
19104&%local_part_suffix%&,
19105&%senders%& or
19106&%require_files%&
19107set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19108for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19109same name.
19110
19111Failing to set this option when it is needed
19112(because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19113can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19114
19115The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19116appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19117independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19118
19119
19120
19121.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19122.cindex "router" "home directory for"
19123.cindex "home directory" "for router"
19124.vindex "&$home$&"
19125This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19126&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19127transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19128sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19129forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19130cause the router to defer.
19131
19132Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19133&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19134place.
19135(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19136are evaluated.)
19137While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19138&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19139
19140When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19141the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19142delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19143of these values that is set:
19144
19145.ilist
19146The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19147.next
19148The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19149.next
19150The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19151.next
19152The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19153.endlist
19154
19155In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19156router, but not for the transport.
19157
19158
19159
19160.option self routers string freeze
19161.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19162.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19163This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19164list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19165and &(manualroute)& routers.
19166Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19167of remote hosts.
19168Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19169&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19170host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19171The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19172&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19173
19174Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19175example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19176error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19177reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19178freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19179cases:
19180
19181.vlist
19182.vitem &%defer%&
19183Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19184
19185.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19186The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19187be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19188behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19189
19190.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19191The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19192reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19193rewritten.
19194
19195.vitem &%pass%&
19196.oindex "&%more%&"
19197.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19198The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19199&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19200subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19201name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19202distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19203combination
19204.code
19205self = pass
19206no_more
19207.endd
19208ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19209Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19210be passed to the next router.
19211
19212.vitem &%fail%&
19213Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19214
19215.vitem &%send%&
19216.cindex "local host" "sending to"
19217The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19218setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19219makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19220is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19221different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19222.endlist
19223
19224
19225
19226.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19227.cindex "router" "checking senders"
19228If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19229address matches something on the list.
19230See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19231are evaluated.
19232
19233There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19234dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19235setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19236to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19237set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19238verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19239SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19240matters.
19241
19242
19243.option set routers "string list" unset
19244.cindex router variables
19245This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19246because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19247The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19248usual way.
19249
19250Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19251and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19252Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19253When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19254to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19255the address.
19256The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19257The variables can be used by the router options
19258(not including any preconditions)
19259and by the transport.
19260Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19261Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19262
19263This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19264many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19265
19266
19267.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19268.cindex "IP address" "translating"
19269.cindex "packet radio"
19270.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19271There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19272it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19273mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19274routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19275is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19276code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19277SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19278
19279.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19280The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19281by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19282expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19283For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19284If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19285address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19286up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19287produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19288addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19289.code
19290translate_ip_address = \
19291 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19292 {$value}fail}}
19293.endd
19294The file would contain lines like
19295.code
1929610.2.3.128/26 some.host
1929710.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19298.endd
19299You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19300are doing.
19301
19302
19303
19304.option transport routers string&!! unset
19305This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19306and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19307only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19308after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19309and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19310delivery is deferred.
19311
19312The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19313have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19314(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19315
19316
19317
19318.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19319.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19320This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19321to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19322explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19323file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19324option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19325overridden by a setting on the transport.
19326If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19327logged, and delivery is deferred.
19328See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19329environment.
19330
19331
19332
19333
19334.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19335.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19336This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19337local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19338configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19339pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19340string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19341setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19342If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19343logged, and delivery is deferred.
19344
19345If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19346&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19347the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19348the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19349is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19350
19351See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19352environment.
19353
19354
19355
19356
19357.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19358.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19359The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19360that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19361result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19362fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19363delivery to be deferred.
19364
19365When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19366address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19367overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19368&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19369the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19370sometimes true and sometimes false).
19371
19372.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19373Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19374qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19375delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19376In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19377&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19378to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19379&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19380
19381&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19382this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19383only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19384no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19385a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19386duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19387duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19388&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19389so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19390&%redirect%& router may be of help.
19391
19392Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19393&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19394subsequent routers.
19395
19396
19397.option user routers string&!! "see below"
19398.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19399.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19400.cindex "transport" "local"
19401.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19402.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19403When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19404specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19405The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19406error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19407This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19408The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19409the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19410a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19411See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19412&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19413
19414
19415
19416.option verify routers&!? boolean true
19417Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19418&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19419
19420
19421.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19422.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19423.oindex "&%-bv%&"
19424.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19425If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19426delivering in cutthrough mode or
19427testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19428with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19429restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19430&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19431
19432&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19433SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19434accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19435user or group.
19436
19437
19438.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19439If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19440addresses,
19441delivering in cutthrough mode
19442or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19443See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19444are evaluated.
19445See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19446
19447
19448.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19449If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19450or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19451See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19452are evaluated.
19453See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19454.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19455.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19456
19457
19458
19459
19460
19461
19462. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19463. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19464
19465.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19466.cindex "&(accept)& router"
19467.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19468The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19469used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19470be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19471specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19472it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19473up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19474.code
19475localusers:
19476 driver = accept
19477 domains = mydomain.example
19478 check_local_user
19479 transport = local_delivery
19480.endd
19481The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19482&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19483When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19484address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19485
19486
19487
19488
19489
19490
19491. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19492. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19493
19494.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19495.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19496.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19497The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19498recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19499unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19500
19501If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19502SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19503MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19504However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19505records.
19506
19507MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19508looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19509When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19510except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19511IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19512generic option, the router declines.
19513
19514Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19515to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19516are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19517
19518.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19519.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19520.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19521If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19522address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19523happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19524
19525
19526.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19527There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19528Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19529SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19530MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19531problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19532
19533For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19534&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19535&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19536an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19537domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19538such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19539proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19540look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19541case routing fails.
19542
19543
19544.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19545.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19546There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19547an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19548domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19549
19550The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19551is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19552
19553Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19554.ilist
19555The domain does not exist in DNS
19556.next
19557The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19558convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19559for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19560.next
19561Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19562.next
19563MX record points to a non-existent host.
19564.next
19565MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19566&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19567.next
19568MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19569addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19570.next
19571The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19572&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19573.next
19574&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19575not be found in the MX records (see below)
19576.endlist
19577
19578
19579
19580
19581.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19582.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19583The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19584
19585.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19586.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19587If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19588(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19589process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19590differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19591the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19592
19593
19594.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19595.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19596The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19597addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19598enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19599required. For example,
19600.code
19601check_srv = smtp
19602.endd
19603looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19604expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19605to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19606submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19607option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19608normal way.
19609
19610When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19611the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19612host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19613this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19614SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19615according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19616
19617When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19618the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19619records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19620this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19621defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19622and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19623have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19624trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19625
19626See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19627when there is a DNS lookup error.
19628
19629
19630
19631
19632.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19633.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19634DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19635which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19636rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19637This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19638domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19639However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19640also being queued.
19641
19642
19643.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19644.cindex IPv6 disabling
19645.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19646The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19647or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19648(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19649only A records are used.
19650
19651.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19652.cindex IPv4 preference
19653.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19654The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19655or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19656(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19657A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19658
19659.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19660.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19661.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19662A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19663record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19664For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19665records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19666setting:
19667.code
19668mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19669.endd
19670This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19671has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19672the address record.
19673
19674
19675.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19676If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19677DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19678&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19679
19680
19681
19682
19683.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19684.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19685.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19686When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19687lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19688single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19689called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19690&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19691resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19692&'resolv.conf'&.
19693
19694
19695
19696.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19697.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19698.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19699If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19700qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19701an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19702expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19703occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19704&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19705any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19706header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19707
19708This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19709ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19710sense.
19711
19712When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19713servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19714making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19715some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19716name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19717header rewriting.
19718
19719
19720.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19721.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19722Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19723to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19724options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19725default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19726servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19727any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19728
19729If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19730domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19731local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19732lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19733routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19734message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19735without processing them independently,
19736provided the following conditions are met:
19737
19738.ilist
19739No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19740&%headers_remove%&.
19741.next
19742The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19743the domain.
19744.endlist
19745
19746
19747
19748
19749.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19750.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19751When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19752lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19753applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19754the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19755domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19756up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19757&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19758actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19759
19760Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19761record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19762local wildcard.
19763
19764
19765
19766.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19767If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19768DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19769&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19770
19771
19772
19773
19774.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19775.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19776If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19777added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19778if
19779.code
19780widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19781.endd
19782is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19783&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19784&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19785and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19786the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19787when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19788
19789
19790.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19791When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19792of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19793corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19794is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19795
19796These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19797for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19798such as that implied by
19799.code
19800domains = @mx_any
19801.endd
19802that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19803entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19804.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19805.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19806
19807
19808
19809
19810
19811
19812
19813
19814
19815. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19816. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19817
19818.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19819.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19820.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19821.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19822This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19823verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19824generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19825takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19826router handles the address
19827.code
19828root@[192.168.1.1]
19829.endd
19830by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19831consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19832are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19833.code
19834postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19835.endd
19836Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19837grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19838
19839.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19840If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19841declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19842&%self%& option determines what happens.
19843
19844The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19845controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19846also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19847Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19848
19849
19850
19851. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19852. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19853
19854.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19855.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19856.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19857The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19858Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19859not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19860must set
19861.code
19862ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19863.endd
19864in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19865
19866The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19867connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19868a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19869message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19870this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19871can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19872must not be specified for it.
19873
19874.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19875.option hosts iplookup string unset
19876This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19877names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19878(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19879and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19880happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19881
19882
19883.option optional iplookup boolean false
19884If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19885is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19886delivery to the address is deferred.
19887
19888
19889.option port iplookup integer 0
19890.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19891This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19892call.
19893
19894
19895.option protocol iplookup string udp
19896This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19897protocols is to be used.
19898
19899
19900.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19901This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19902default value is:
19903.code
19904$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19905.endd
19906The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19907query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19908
19909
19910.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19911If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19912returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19913string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19914in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19915&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19916whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19917up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19918
19919
19920.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19921This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19922returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19923router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19924response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19925check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19926address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19927the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19928following could be used:
19929.code
19930response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19931reroute = $local_part@$1
19932.endd
19933
19934.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19935This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19936machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19937call. It does not apply to UDP.
19938
19939
19940
19941
19942. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19943. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19944
19945.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19946.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19947.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19948.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19949The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19950routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19951route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19952normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19953route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19954messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19955
19956The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19957it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19958has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19959include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19960&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19961generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19962being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19963
19964.vindex "&$host$&"
19965In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19966router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19967an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19968transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19969with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19970passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19971host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19972text string.
19973
19974The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19975&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19976or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19977any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19978below, following the list of private options.
19979
19980
19981.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19982
19983.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19984The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19985
19986.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19987See &%host_find_failed%&.
19988
19989.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19990This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19991address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19992of the following values:
19993.code
19994decline
19995defer
19996fail
19997freeze
19998ignore
19999pass
20000.endd
20001The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20002error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20003forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20004&%pass_router%&),
20005.oindex "&%more%&"
20006overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20007router only if &%more%& is true.
20008
20009The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20010cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20011controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20012as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20013
20014The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20015state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20016generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20017
20018
20019.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20020.cindex "randomized host list"
20021.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20022If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20023is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20024overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20025crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20026same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20027(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20028deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20029
20030When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20031into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20032set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20033item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20034.code
20035route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20036.endd
20037The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20038randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20039If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20040randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20041&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20042
20043
20044.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20045If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20046Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20047example:
20048.code
20049route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20050.endd
20051If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20052router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20053deferred.
20054
20055
20056.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20057This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20058unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20059that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20060
20061
20062.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20063.cindex "address" "copying routing"
20064Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20065router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20066router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20067default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20068servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20069any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20070
20071If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20072domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20073local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20074lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20075&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20076addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20077same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20078if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20079
20080
20081
20082
20083.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20084The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20085rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20086entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20087described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20088Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20089.display
20090<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20091.endd
20092The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20093no options:
20094.code
20095route_list = \
20096 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20097 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20098.endd
20099The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20100list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20101usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20102single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20103pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20104&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20105except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20106That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20107lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20108in a &%route_list%&).
20109
20110The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20111matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20112then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20113&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20114
20115
20116
20117.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20118The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20119routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20120hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20121The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20122Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20123expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20124like this:
20125.code
20126dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20127thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20128.endd
20129This data can be accessed by setting
20130.code
20131route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20132.endd
20133Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20134decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20135requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20136possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20137be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20138
20139
20140
20141
20142.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20143A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20144always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20145declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20146and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20147If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20148The format of each item
20149in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20150as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20151
20152If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20153variables are set during its expansion:
20154
20155.ilist
20156.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20157If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20158&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20159.code
20160route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20161.endd
20162.next
20163&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20164.next
20165&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20166
20167.next
20168.vindex "&$value$&"
20169If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20170looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20171.code
20172route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20173.endd
20174.endlist
20175
20176Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20177semicolon is the default route list separator.
20178
20179
20180
20181.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20182Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20183optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20184(see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20185When no port is given, an IP address
20186is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20187specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20188by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20189
20190.ilist
20191Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20192the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20193be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20194.code
20195route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20196route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20197.endd
20198.next
20199When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20200colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20201enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20202number follows. For example:
20203.code
20204route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20205.endd
20206.endlist
20207
20208.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20209When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20210the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20211delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20212option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20213transport.
20214
20215Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20216hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20217interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20218records in the DNS. For example:
20219.code
20220route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20221.endd
20222If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20223example:
20224.code
20225route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20226.endd
20227If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20228randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20229that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20230be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20231Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20232happens is controlled by the
20233.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20234&%self%& option of the router.
20235
20236A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20237hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20238lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20239below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20240preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20241randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20242defined by MX preferences.
20243
20244If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20245not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20246preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20247
20248If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20249depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20250is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20251Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20252
20253If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20254most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20255router.
20256
20257DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20258failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20259&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20260
20261The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20262whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20263
20264
20265
20266.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20267The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20268One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20269&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20270other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20271per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20272routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20273
20274.ilist
20275&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20276setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20277.next
20278&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20279overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20280.next
20281&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20282find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20283also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20284.next
20285&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20286no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20287timeout), delivery is deferred.
20288.next
20289&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20290.next
20291&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20292.endlist
20293
20294For example:
20295.code
20296route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20297 domain2 host4:host5
20298.endd
20299If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20300DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20301result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20302or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20303call.
20304
20305&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20306called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20307instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20308lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20309function called.
20310
20311&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20312inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20313option specified.
20314
20315
20316
20317If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20318&%host_find_failed%& option.
20319
20320.vindex "&$host$&"
20321When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20322The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20323
20324
20325
20326.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20327In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20328transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20329
20330.ilist
20331.cindex "smart host" "example router"
20332The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20333&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20334named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20335.code
20336domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20337.endd
20338You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20339your first router something like this:
20340.code
20341smart_route:
20342 driver = manualroute
20343 domains = !+local_domains
20344 transport = remote_smtp
20345 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20346.endd
20347This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20348&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20349they are tried in order
20350(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20351Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20352.code
20353smart_route:
20354 driver = manualroute
20355 transport = remote_smtp
20356 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20357.endd
20358There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20359However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20360example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20361precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20362always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20363would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20364always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20365&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20366
20367.next
20368.cindex "mail hub example"
20369A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20370records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20371the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20372machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20373&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20374to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20375using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20376lookup is easier to manage.
20377
20378If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20379to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20380example:
20381.code
20382hub_route:
20383 driver = manualroute
20384 transport = remote_smtp
20385 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20386.endd
20387This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20388whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20389if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20390that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20391domain can be used to find the host:
20392.code
20393through_firewall:
20394 driver = manualroute
20395 transport = remote_smtp
20396 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20397.endd
20398The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20399hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20400data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20401next router.
20402
20403.next
20404.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20405.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20406You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20407SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20408storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20409can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20410.code
20411save_in_file:
20412 driver = manualroute
20413 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20414 route_list = saved.domain.example
20415.endd
20416though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20417several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20418different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20419.code
20420save_in_file:
20421 driver = manualroute
20422 route_list = \
20423 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20424 *.saved.domain2.example \
20425 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20426 batch_pipe
20427.endd
20428.vindex "&$domain$&"
20429.vindex "&$host$&"
20430The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20431doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20432file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20433the address if the lookup fails.
20434
20435.next
20436.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20437Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20438&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20439one way it can be done:
20440.code
20441# Transport
20442uucp:
20443 driver = pipe
20444 user = nobody
20445 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20446 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20447 return_fail_output = true
20448
20449# Router
20450uucphost:
20451 transport = uucp
20452 driver = manualroute
20453 route_data = \
20454 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20455.endd
20456The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20457.code
20458darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20459.endd
20460It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20461makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20462&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20463.endlist
20464.ecindex IIDmanrou1
20465.ecindex IIDmanrou2
20466
20467
20468
20469
20470
20471
20472
20473
20474. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20475. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20476
20477.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20478.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20479.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20480.cindex "routing" "by external program"
20481The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20482and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20483mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20484However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20485&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20486be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20487options:
20488.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20489
20490.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20491This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20492command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20493expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20494&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20495
20496
20497.option command_group queryprogram string unset
20498.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20499This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20500address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20501uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20502gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20503
20504
20505.option command_user queryprogram string unset
20506.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20507This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20508command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20509it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20510using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20511not set, a value for the gid also.
20512
20513&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20514root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20515However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20516usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20517is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20518the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20519gid.
20520
20521
20522.option current_directory queryprogram string /
20523This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20524before running the command.
20525
20526
20527.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20528If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20529is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20530timeout.
20531
20532
20533The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20534the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20535containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20536the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20537field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20538
20539.ilist
20540&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20541below).
20542.next
20543&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20544&%no_more%& is set.
20545.next
20546&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20547subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20548of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20549included in the SMTP response.
20550.next
20551&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20552subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20553included in any SMTP response.
20554.next
20555&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20556.next
20557&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20558&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20559.next
20560&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20561new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20562or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20563.endlist
20564
20565When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20566number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20567the page):
20568.code
20569ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20570LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20571.endd
20572The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20573is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20574used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20575an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20576
20577The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20578As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20579in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20580&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20581(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20582
20583If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20584find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20585anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20586goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20587result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20588
20589.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20590If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20591variable. For example, this return line
20592.code
20593accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20594.endd
20595routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20596the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20597.ecindex IIDquerou1
20598.ecindex IIDquerou2
20599
20600
20601
20602
20603. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20604. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20605
20606.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20607.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20608.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20609.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20610.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20611The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20612common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20613(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20614files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20615redirected in several different ways:
20616
20617.ilist
20618It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20619independently.
20620.next
20621It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20622.next
20623It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20624.next
20625It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20626.next
20627It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20628.next
20629It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20630.next
20631It can be discarded.
20632.endlist
20633
20634The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20635However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20636files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20637&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20638
20639If success DSNs have been requested
20640.cindex "DSN" "success"
20641.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20642redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20643
20644
20645
20646.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20647The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20648expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20649contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20650options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20651aliases, in a configuration like this:
20652.code
20653system_aliases:
20654 driver = redirect
20655 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20656.endd
20657If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20658expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20659expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20660cause delivery to be deferred.
20661
20662A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20663&_.forward_& files, like this:
20664.code
20665userforward:
20666 driver = redirect
20667 check_local_user
20668 file = $home/.forward
20669 no_verify
20670.endd
20671If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20672empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20673is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20674yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20675comments.
20676
20677.new
20678.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
20679.cindex redirect "tainted data"
20680Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
20681
20682&*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
20683directly for redirection,
20684as they are provided by a potential attacker.
20685In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
20686on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
20687the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
20688.wen
20689
20690
20691
20692.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20693.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20694It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20695&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20696
20697.ilist
20698When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20699running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20700the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20701practice the router may not be able to operate.
20702.next
20703However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20704is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20705local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20706saves some resources.
20707.endlist
20708
20709
20710
20711
20712
20713
20714.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20715.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20716.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20717The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20718can be interpreted in two different ways:
20719
20720.ilist
20721If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20722&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20723&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20724respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20725in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20726document is intended for use by end users.
20727.next
20728Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20729described in the next section.
20730.endlist
20731
20732When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20733in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20734generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20735configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20736for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20737
20738
20739
20740.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20741.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20742When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20743comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20744addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20745&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20746disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20747depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20748commas or newlines.
20749If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20750quotes.
20751
20752Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20753also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20754next newline character is ignored.
20755
20756If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20757double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20758(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20759&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20760removed.
20761
20762.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20763&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20764and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20765of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20766special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20767&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20768setting:
20769.code
20770data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20771.endd
20772
20773
20774.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20775.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20776.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20777.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20778A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20779consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20780automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20781is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20782Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20783as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20784complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20785
20786.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20787Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20788filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20789mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20790&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20791.code
20792cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20793.endd
20794.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20795.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20796For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20797preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20798it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20799synonymously.
20800
20801If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
208022822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20803domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20804addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20805force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20806
20807Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20808Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20809contains:
20810.code
20811Sam.Reman: spqr
20812.endd
20813Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20814messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20815this forward file:
20816.code
20817Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20818.endd
20819With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20820&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20821second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20822and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20823should really contain
20824.code
20825spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20826.endd
20827but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20828below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20829&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20830
20831
20832
20833.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20834In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20835lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20836
20837.ilist
20838.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20839.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20840An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20841as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20842command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20843Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20844which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20845
20846Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20847the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20848the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20849in double quotes, for example:
20850.code
20851"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20852.endd
20853since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20854quote just the command. An item such as
20855.code
20856|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20857.endd
20858is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20859
20860Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20861of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20862redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20863quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20864string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20865are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20866data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20867transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20868an &%accept%& router.
20869
20870.next
20871.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20872.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20873An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20874parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20875.code
20876/home/world/minbari
20877.endd
20878is treated as a filename, but
20879.code
20880/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20881.endd
20882is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20883the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20884forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20885filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20886
20887Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20888which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20889
20890.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20891However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20892bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20893instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20894
20895.next
20896.cindex "included address list"
20897.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20898If an item is of the form
20899.code
20900:include:<path name>
20901.endd
20902a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20903point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20904out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20905by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20906item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20907the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20908.code
20909list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20910.endd
20911It must be given as
20912.code
20913list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20914.endd
20915.new
20916.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
20917.cindex redirect "tainted data"
20918Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
20919.wen
20920.next
20921.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20922.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20923.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20924.cindex "black hole"
20925.cindex "abandoning mail"
20926Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20927&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20928the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20929.code
20930:blackhole:
20931.endd
20932can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20933done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20934&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20935
20936&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20937delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20938are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20939database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20940&_/dev/null_&.
20941
20942.next
20943.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20944.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20945.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20946.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20947.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20948An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20949redirection items of the form
20950.code
20951:defer:
20952:fail:
20953.endd
20954respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20955to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20956text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20957associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20958.code
20959X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20960.endd
20961In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20962of a
20963.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20964VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20965default.
20966.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20967The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20968the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20969
20970.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20971By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20972&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20973space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20974followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20975code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20976incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20977suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20978&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20979ignored.
20980
20981.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20982In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20983default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20984therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20985
20986Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20987not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20988normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20989as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20990lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20991
20992During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20993containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20994whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20995subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20996deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20997rules still apply.
20998
20999.next
21000.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21001Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21002chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21003for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21004&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21005router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21006results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21007.endlist
21008
21009
21010.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21011.cindex "duplicate addresses"
21012.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21013.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21014Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21015to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21016routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21017aliasing scheme of the type
21018.code
21019pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21020localpart1: pipe
21021localpart2: pipe
21022.endd
21023does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21024when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21025discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21026such as
21027.code
21028localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21029localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21030.endd
21031does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21032the pipes are distinct.
21033
21034
21035
21036.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21037.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21038.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21039When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21040leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21041afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21042delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21043members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21044can be used to avoid this.
21045
21046
21047.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21048.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21049If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21050error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21051for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21052detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21053deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21054
21055
21056
21057.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21058
21059.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21060The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21061
21062
21063.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21064Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21065data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21066
21067
21068.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21069.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21070If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21071and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21072
21073
21074.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21075.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21076.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21077Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21078&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21079are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21080lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21081
21082It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21083the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21084
21085
21086The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21087&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21088&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21089files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21090true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21091
21092
21093
21094.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21095.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21096Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21097This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21098default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21099let ordinary users do.
21100
21101
21102
21103.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21104This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21105as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21106Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21107configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21108for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21109
21110When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21111is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21112the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21113and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21114domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21115&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21116.code
21117\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21118.endd
21119Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21120&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21121originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21122(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21123&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21124&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21125file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21126original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21127
21128
21129.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21130When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21131when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21132&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21133&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21134deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21135is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21136&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21137
21138
21139
21140.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21141When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21142this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21143permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21144option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21145&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21146
21147
21148.option data redirect string&!! unset
21149This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21150set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21151list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21152expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21153has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21154
21155When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21156filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21157terminated with newline characters. For example:
21158.code
21159data = #Exim filter\n\
21160 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21161.endd
21162If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21163you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21164choice into a newline.
21165
21166
21167.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21168A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21169ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21170specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21171configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21172
21173
21174.option file redirect string&!! unset
21175This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21176is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21177use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21178failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21179must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21180data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21181entirely of comments), the router declines.
21182
21183.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21184If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21185runs a check on the containing directory,
21186unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21187If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21188happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21189is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21190not, the router declines.
21191
21192
21193.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21194.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21195A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21196ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21197specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21198configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21199it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21200
21201
21202.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21203When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21204relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21205relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21206relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21207
21208
21209.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21210.cindex "restricting access to features"
21211.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21212If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21213redirection list.
21214
21215
21216.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21217.cindex "restricting access to features"
21218.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21219If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21220&%allow_filter%& is true.
21221
21222
21223
21224
21225.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21226.cindex "restricting access to features"
21227.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21228.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21229.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21230.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21231If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21232specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21233conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21234set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21235locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21236
21237
21238.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21239.cindex "restricting access to features"
21240.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21241If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21242make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21243functions.
21244
21245.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21246.cindex "restricting access to features"
21247.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21248.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21249If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21250make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21251
21252.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21253.cindex "restricting access to features"
21254.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21255If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21256permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21257under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21258&_.forward_& files).
21259
21260
21261.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21262.cindex "restricting access to features"
21263.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21264If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21265to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21266
21267
21268.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21269.cindex "restricting access to features"
21270.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21271This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21272it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21273of the embedded Perl support.
21274
21275
21276.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21277.cindex "restricting access to features"
21278.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21279If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21280to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21281
21282
21283.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21284.cindex "restricting access to features"
21285.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21286If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21287to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21288
21289
21290.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21291.cindex "restricting access to features"
21292.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21293If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21294message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21295files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21296&%one_time%& is set.
21297
21298
21299.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21300.cindex "restricting access to features"
21301.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21302If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21303to make use of &%run%& items.
21304
21305
21306.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21307.cindex "restricting access to features"
21308.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21309If this option is true, items of the form
21310.code
21311:include:<path name>
21312.endd
21313are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21314
21315
21316.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21317.cindex "restricting access to features"
21318.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21319.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21320If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21321specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21322forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21323
21324
21325.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21326.cindex "restricting access to features"
21327.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21328If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21329&%allow_filter%& is true.
21330
21331
21332.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21333.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21334If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21335of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21336the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21337
21338
21339
21340
21341.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21342.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21343If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21344generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21345generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21346bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21347bounce may well quote the generated address.
21348
21349
21350.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21351.cindex "EACCES"
21352If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21353EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21354file did not exist.
21355
21356
21357.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21358.cindex "ENOTDIR"
21359If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21360ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21361router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21362
21363Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21364router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21365(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21366against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21367is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21368is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21369a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21370that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21371
21372
21373
21374.option include_directory redirect string unset
21375If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21376redirection list must start with this directory.
21377
21378
21379.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21380This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21381&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21382
21383
21384.option one_time redirect boolean false
21385.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21386.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21387.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21388.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21389.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21390Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21391files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21392of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21393is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21394but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21395message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21396lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21397before they subscribed.
21398
21399If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21400deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21401&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21402&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21403attempt.
21404
21405&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21406router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21407reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21408permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21409
21410&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21411to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21412and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21413
21414&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21415&%one_time%&.
21416
21417The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21418addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21419addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21420&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21421typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21422expansion.
21423
21424
21425.option owners redirect "string list" unset
21426.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21427.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21428.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21429.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21430This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21431This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21432See &%check_owner%& above.
21433
21434
21435.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21436This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21437The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21438&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21439
21440
21441.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21442.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21443A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21444starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21445transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21446name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21447When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21448
21449
21450.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21451.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21452If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21453generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21454in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21455expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21456to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21457&$qualify_recipient$&.
21458
21459This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21460but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21461not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21462addresses.
21463
21464.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21465.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21466.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21467.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21468If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21469set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21470without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21471address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21472&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21473this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21474
21475
21476.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21477If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21478any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21479the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21480only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21481&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21482
21483
21484.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21485A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21486&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21487by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21488transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21489are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21490
21491
21492.option rewrite redirect boolean true
21493.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21494If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21495subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21496and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21497
21498
21499.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21500The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21501:subaddress part of an address.
21502
21503.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21504The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21505of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21506(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21507
21508
21509.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21510.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21511To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21512&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21513(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21514&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21515needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21516
21517
21518
21519.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21520.cindex "forward file" "broken"
21521.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21522.cindex "alias file" "broken"
21523.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21524.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21525.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21526.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21527If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21528non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21529&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21530giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21531are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21532&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21533be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21534&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21535
21536If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21537errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21538the following routers.
21539
21540If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21541error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21542taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21543so it is passed to the following routers.
21544
21545.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21546Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21547action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21548&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21549
21550&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21551lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21552option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21553notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21554.code
21555userforward:
21556 driver = redirect
21557 allow_filter
21558 check_local_user
21559 file = $home/.forward
21560 file_transport = address_file
21561 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21562 reply_transport = address_reply
21563 no_verify
21564 skip_syntax_errors
21565 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21566 syntax_errors_text = \
21567 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21568 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21569 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21570 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21571 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21572 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21573 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21574 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21575 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21576 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21577.endd
21578You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21579&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21580put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21581.code
21582real_localuser:
21583 driver = accept
21584 check_local_user
21585 local_part_prefix = real-
21586 transport = local_delivery
21587.endd
21588For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21589router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21590.code
21591 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21592 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21593.endd
21594
21595
21596.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21597See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21598
21599
21600.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21601See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21602.ecindex IIDredrou1
21603.ecindex IIDredrou2
21604
21605
21606
21607
21608
21609
21610. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21611. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21612
21613.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21614 "Environment for local transports"
21615.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21616.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21617.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21618Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21619transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21620in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21621mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21622
21623Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21624some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21625transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21626&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21627
21628The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21629different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21630settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21631or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21632configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21633
21634
21635
21636.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21637.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21638.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21639If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21640simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21641the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21642rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21643time.
21644
21645However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21646locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21647.code
21648my_transport:
21649 driver = pipe
21650 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21651.endd
21652This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21653messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21654&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21655file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21656
21657
21658
21659
21660.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21661.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21662.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21663All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21664overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21665set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21666delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21667group (set by the transport). For example:
21668.code
21669# Routers ...
21670# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21671local_users:
21672 driver = accept
21673 check_local_user
21674 transport = group_delivery
21675
21676# Transports ...
21677# This transport overrides the group
21678group_delivery:
21679 driver = appendfile
21680 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21681 group = mail
21682.endd
21683If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21684address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21685gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21686set.
21687
21688.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21689When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21690function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21691&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21692by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21693for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21694
21695.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21696The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21697is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21698receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21699original gid is also used.
21700
21701This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21702following that is set is used:
21703
21704.ilist
21705A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21706.next
21707A &%group%& setting of the router;
21708.next
21709A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21710&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21711.next
21712The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21713.next
21714In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21715the uid is the creator's uid;
21716.next
21717The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21718.endlist
21719
21720If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21721no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21722This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21723The first of the following that is set is used:
21724
21725.ilist
21726A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21727.next
21728In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21729.next
21730A &%user%& setting of the router;
21731.next
21732A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21733.next
21734The Exim uid.
21735.endlist
21736
21737Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21738&%never_users%& list.
21739
21740
21741
21742
21743
21744.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21745.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21746.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21747.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21748.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21749Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21750the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21751However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21752are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21753for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21754
21755.ilist
21756The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21757.next
21758The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21759.next
21760The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21761.next
21762The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21763.endlist
21764
21765The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21766
21767.ilist
21768The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21769.next
21770The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21771.endlist
21772
21773
21774If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21775value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21776directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21777
21778
21779
21780.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21781.vindex "&$domain$&"
21782.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21783.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21784Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21785variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21786deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21787at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21788other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21789never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21790and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21791.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21792.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21793.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21794
21795
21796
21797
21798
21799
21800
21801. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21802. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21803
21804.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21805.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21806.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21807.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21808The following generic options apply to all transports:
21809
21810
21811.option body_only transports boolean false
21812.cindex "transport" "body only"
21813.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21814.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21815If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21816mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21817or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21818&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21819automatically suppress them.
21820
21821
21822.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21823.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21824This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21825transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21826If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21827logged, and delivery is deferred.
21828
21829
21830.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21831If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21832deliveries by the transport or for any
21833transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21834what you are doing.
21835
21836
21837.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21838.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21839If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21840option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21841transport is run.
21842If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21843output, and Exim carries on processing.
21844This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21845so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21846option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21847variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21848one.
21849The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21850transport and the router that called it.
21851
21852.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21853.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21854If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21855This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21856header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21857requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21858safely be resent to other recipients.
21859
21860
21861.option driver transports string unset
21862This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21863There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21864
21865
21866.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21867.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21868If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21869This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21870delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21871configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21872address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21873header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21874its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21875resent to other recipients.
21876
21877
21878.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21879.cindex events
21880This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21881For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21882
21883
21884.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21885.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21886This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21887value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21888&%user%& (see below).
21889
21890
21891.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21892.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21893.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21894This option specifies a list of text headers,
21895newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21896which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21897portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21898&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21899routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21900is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21901errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21902
21903Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21904for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21905
21906
21907.option headers_only transports boolean false
21908.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21909.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21910.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21911If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21912exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21913transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21914checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21915
21916
21917.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21918.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21919.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21920This option specifies a list of text headers,
21921colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21922to be removed from the message.
21923However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
21924Each list item is separately expanded.
21925If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21926is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21927errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21928.new
21929If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
21930.wen
21931
21932Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21933in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21934routers.
21935
21936Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21937for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21938
21939&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21940items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21941To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21942
21943
21944
21945.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21946.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21947.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21948This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21949that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21950option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21951the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21952message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21953example,
21954.code
21955headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21956 x@y w@z
21957.endd
21958changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21959&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21960header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21961only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21962the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21963filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21964affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21965envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21966change envelope recipients at this time.
21967
21968
21969.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21970.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21971.vindex "&$home$&"
21972This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21973overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21974placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21975used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21976&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21977&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21978for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21979deferred.
21980
21981
21982.option initgroups transports boolean false
21983.cindex "additional groups"
21984.cindex "groups" "additional"
21985.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21986If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21987transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21988to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21989
21990
21991.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21992.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21993.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21994.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21995.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21996If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21997it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21998The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21999
22000.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22001Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22002incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22003is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22004Obviously there is scope for
22005records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22006guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22007
22008If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22009relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22010start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22011may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22012are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22013
22014
22015.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22016.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22017.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22018.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22019This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22020expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22021digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22022including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22023delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22024message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22025the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22026ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22027&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22028delivered.
22029
22030
22031
22032.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22033.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22034.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22035.cindex "local part" "prefix"
22036.cindex "local part" "suffix"
22037When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22038affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22039form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22040that contains
22041.code
22042local_part_prefix = *-
22043.endd
22044routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22045is delivered with
22046.code
22047RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22048.endd
22049This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22050recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22051whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22052deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22053&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22054
22055
22056.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22057.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22058When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22059in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22060is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22061deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22062part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22063temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22064deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22065
22066However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22067as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22068(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22069this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22070
22071For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22072the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22073on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22074
22075
22076.option return_path transports string&!! unset
22077.cindex "envelope sender"
22078.cindex "envelope from"
22079.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22080.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22081If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22082the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22083that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22084designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22085SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22086only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22087header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22088
22089&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22090&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22091
22092.vindex "&$return_path$&"
22093The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22094either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22095&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22096replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22097option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22098section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22099
22100&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22101remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22102the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22103This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22104&%errors_to%& in a router.
22105
22106
22107
22108.option return_path_add transports boolean false
22109.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
22110If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22111Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22112mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22113have easy access to it.
22114
22115RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22116the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22117header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22118option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22119incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22120recipients.
22121
22122
22123.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22124See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22125
22126
22127.option shadow_transport transports string unset
22128.cindex "shadow transport"
22129.cindex "transport" "shadow"
22130A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22131another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22132
22133Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22134&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22135string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22136passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22137expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22138cause a log line to be written.
22139
22140The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22141subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22142provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22143is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22144ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22145of the form
22146.code
22147ST=<shadow transport name>
22148.endd
22149If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22150parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22151purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22152provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22153headers that some sites insist on.
22154
22155
22156.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22157.cindex "transport" "filter"
22158.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22159This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22160at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22161individual users or via a system filter.
22162If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22163
22164When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22165&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22166the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22167input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22168command must be specified as an absolute path.
22169
22170The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22171terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22172SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22173lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22174settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22175&(pipe)& transports.
22176
22177The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22178standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22179destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22180filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22181are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22182
22183The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22184care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22185test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22186SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22187
22188.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22189A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22190at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22191message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22192a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22193not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22194
22195.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22196A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22197being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22198support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22199at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22200more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22201the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22202additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22203
22204.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22205The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22206the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22207parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22208Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22209section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22210to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22211of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22212an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22213&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22214
22215.vindex "&$host$&"
22216.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22217The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22218transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22219which the message is being sent. For example:
22220.code
22221transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22222 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22223.endd
22224
22225Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22226generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22227command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22228.ilist
22229If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22230part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22231expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22232example:
22233.code
22234transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22235.endd
22236This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22237&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22238stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22239the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22240&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22241Exim tried to expand the first one.
22242.next
22243Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22244expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22245arguments. Consider this example:
22246.code
22247transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22248 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22249.endd
22250The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22251if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22252.code
22253transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22254 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22255.endd
22256.endlist
22257
22258The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22259For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22260normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22261A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22262serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22263the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22264bounced from a transport filter.
22265
22266If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22267passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22268message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22269
22270
22271.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22272.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22273When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22274that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22275temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22276&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22277way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22278error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22279becomes a temporary error.
22280
22281
22282.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22283.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22284.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22285This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22286run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22287given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22288associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22289option is not set.
22290
22291For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22292specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22293&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22294
22295.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22296For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22297sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22298to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22299retry data.
22300.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22301.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22302.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22303
22304
22305
22306
22307
22308
22309. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22310. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22311
22312.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22313 "Address batching"
22314.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22315The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22316one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22317remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22318normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22319transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22320copy of the message is delivered each time.
22321
22322.cindex "batched local delivery"
22323.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22324.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22325In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22326local transport, for example:
22327
22328.ilist
22329In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22330delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22331recipients saves space.
22332.next
22333In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22334a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22335.next
22336In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22337to a scanner program or
22338to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22339acceptable.
22340.endlist
22341
22342These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22343(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22344repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22345
22346The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22347delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22348(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22349&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22350(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22351to certain conditions:
22352
22353.ilist
22354.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22355If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22356batching is possible.
22357.next
22358.vindex "&$domain$&"
22359If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22360addresses with the same domain are batched.
22361.next
22362.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22363If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22364addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22365customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22366including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22367from taking place.
22368.next
22369Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22370delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22371group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22372be the same.
22373.endlist
22374
22375In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22376both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22377is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22378course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22379option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22380&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22381&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22382.code
22383check_string = "."
22384escape_string = ".."
22385.endd
22386when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22387given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22388&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22389
22390.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22391If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22392&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22393that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22394transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22395addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22396
22397.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22398.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22399If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22400transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22401the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22402of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22403argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22404delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22405are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22406
22407
22408
22409
22410. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22411. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22412
22413.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22414.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22415.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22416.cindex "directory creation"
22417.cindex "creating directories"
22418The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22419file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22420files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22421format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22422University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22423being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22424to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22425delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22426supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22427directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22428
22429The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22430default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22431SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22432included.
22433
22434.cindex "quota" "system"
22435Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22436also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22437system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22438
22439If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22440partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22441modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22442creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22443
22444Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22445file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22446private options.
22447
22448The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22449users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22450putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22451&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22452option).
22453
22454
22455
22456.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22457The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22458the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22459the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22460normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22461
22462.vindex "&$address_file$&"
22463.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22464However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22465directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22466forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22467user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22468the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22469name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22470operation. There are two cases:
22471
22472.ilist
22473If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22474must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22475common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22476different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22477default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22478name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22479&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22480.next
22481If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22482used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22483contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22484.endlist
22485.new
22486.cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
22487.cindex appendfile "tainted data"
22488Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
22489This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
22490as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
22491which returns a path (or component).
22492.wen
22493
22494
22495.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22496.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22497As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22498have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22499form:
22500.code
22501save folder23
22502.endd
22503or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22504.code
22505require "fileinto";
22506fileinto "folder23";
22507.endd
22508In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22509must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22510case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22511is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22512way of handling this requirement:
22513.code
22514file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22515 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22516 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22517 {$address_file} \
22518 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22519 }} \
22520 }
22521.endd
22522With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22523location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22524&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22525
22526&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22527&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22528the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22529you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22530&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22531path to the transport.
22532
22533&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22534the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22535
22536
22537
22538
22539.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22540.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22541
22542
22543
22544.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22545.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22546.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22547.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22548Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22549regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22550delivery is deferred.
22551
22552
22553.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22554.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22555.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22556By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22557that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22558are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22559what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22560are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22561
22562
22563.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22564See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22565However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22566happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22567file.
22568
22569
22570.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22571See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22572
22573
22574.option check_group appendfile boolean false
22575When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22576option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22577delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22578file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22579
22580
22581.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22582When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22583is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22584process is running.
22585
22586
22587.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22588.cindex "&""From""& line"
22589As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22590matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22591replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22592a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22593contains is significant.
22594
22595If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22596are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22597configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22598&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22599&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22600
22601The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22602suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22603&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22604if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22605.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22606.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22607.code
22608check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22609escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22610message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22611message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22612.endd
22613.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22614.cindex "directory creation"
22615When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22616directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22617is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22618
22619The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22620operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22621example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22622is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22623in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22624
22625
22626
22627.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22628This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22629by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22630directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22631delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22632beneath.
22633
22634The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22635&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22636set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22637given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22638are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22639by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22640&%file_must_exist%&.
22641
22642
22643.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22644This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22645or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22646redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22647
22648When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22649into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22650appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22651(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22652&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22653
22654
22655.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22656.cindex "base62"
22657.vindex "&$inode$&"
22658When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22659&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22660whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22661.code
22662q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22663.endd
22664This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22665inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22666option.
22667
22668
22669.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22670If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22671&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22672
22673
22674.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22675See &%check_string%& above.
22676
22677
22678.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22679This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22680&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22681of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22682specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22683&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22684&%file%&.
22685
22686.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22687.cindex "locking files"
22688.cindex "lock files"
22689If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22690mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22691
22692The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22693path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22694examples:
22695.code
22696file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22697file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22698file = $home/inbox
22699.endd
22700.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22701In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22702is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22703create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22704deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22705run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22706
22707
22708
22709.option file_format appendfile string unset
22710.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22711This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22712before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22713start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22714colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22715second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22716string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22717transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22718this added to it:
22719.code
22720file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22721 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22722.endd
22723Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22724a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22725to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22726to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22727is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22728match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22729delivery is deferred.
22730
22731
22732.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22733If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22734A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22735If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22736
22737
22738.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22739.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22740.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22741.cindex "locking files"
22742By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22743when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22744sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22745Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22746for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22747deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22748mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22749misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22750
22751On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22752not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22753is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22754and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22755
22756If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22757timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22758retries is
22759.code
22760(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22761.endd
22762rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22763which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22764&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22765
22766You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22767local deliveries because of errors of the form
22768.code
22769failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22770.endd
22771
22772.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22773This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22774&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22775&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22776
22777
22778.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22779This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22780for details of locking.
22781
22782
22783.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22784This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22785is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22786
22787
22788.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22789This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22790used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22791
22792
22793.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22794.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22795When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22796exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22797accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22798
22799
22800.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22801.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22802.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22803If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22804number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22805followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22806external source that maintains the data.
22807
22808
22809.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22810.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22811.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22812If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22813size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22814This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22815maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22816it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22817
22818
22819
22820.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22821.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22822If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22823file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22824transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22825&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22826&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22827directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22828SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22829&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22830
22831
22832.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22833.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22834.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22835This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22836a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22837directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22838calculation. The default value is:
22839.code
22840maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22841.endd
22842This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22843(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22844&_Trash_&
22845folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22846.code
22847maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22848.endd
22849This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22850directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22851calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22852directly into that directory.
22853
22854
22855.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22856This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22857&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22858
22859
22860.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22861This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22862section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22863
22864
22865.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22866.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22867The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22868If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22869creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22870quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22871value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22872&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22873
22874.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22875.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22876.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22877The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22878effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22879matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22880containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22881delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22882&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22883See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22884
22885
22886.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22887.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22888If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22889new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22890SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22891below for further details.
22892
22893
22894.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22895This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22896section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22897
22898
22899.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22900This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22901section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22902
22903
22904.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22905.cindex "locking files"
22906.cindex "file" "locking"
22907.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22908.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22909This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22910set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22911the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22912traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22913IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22914
22915&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22916automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22917empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22918combination:
22919.code
22920mbx_format = true
22921message_prefix =
22922message_suffix =
22923.endd
22924If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22925&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22926is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22927&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22928interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22929should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22930going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22931mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22932
22933If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22934the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22935(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22936append messages to it.
22937
22938
22939.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22940.cindex "&""From""& line"
22941The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22942The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22943in which case it is:
22944.code
22945message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22946 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22947.endd
22948&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22949&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22950
22951.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22952The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22953The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22954in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22955setting
22956.code
22957message_suffix =
22958.endd
22959&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22960&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22961
22962.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22963If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22964has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22965permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22966if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22967a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22968value, and this option is ignored.
22969
22970
22971.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22972This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22973mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22974true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22975continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22976
22977
22978.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22979If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22980successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22981on users about incoming mail.
22982
22983
22984.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22985.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22986This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22987or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22988is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22989all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22990individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22991&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22992have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22993
22994As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22995multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22996For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22997
22998A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22999may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23000If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23001become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23002Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23003the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23004
23005The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23006(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23007for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23008and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23009large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23010be handled.
23011
23012The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23013quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23014
23015&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23016
23017The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23018the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23019be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23020fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23021system quota failures.
23022
23023By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23024mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23025last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23026during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23027refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23028message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23029changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23030for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23031continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23032delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23033
23034
23035.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23036This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23037into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23038called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23039delivery directory.
23040
23041
23042.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23043This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23044number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23045can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23046failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23047&"no quota"&.
23048
23049The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23050quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23051
23052.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23053See &%quota%& above.
23054
23055
23056.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23057This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23058for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23059these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23060If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23061captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23062file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23063
23064This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23065&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23066facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23067the file length to the filename. For example:
23068.code
23069maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23070quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23071.endd
23072An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23073number of lines in the message.
23074
23075The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23076filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23077sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23078
23079Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23080
23081This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23082may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23083will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23084disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23085a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23086as is used to adjust the effective size.
23087
23088
23089.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23090See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23091&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23092.code
23093quota_warn_message = "\
23094 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23095 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23096 This message is automatically created \
23097 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23098 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23099 a warning threshold that is\n\
23100 set by the system administrator.\n"
23101.endd
23102
23103
23104.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23105.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23106.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23107.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23108This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23109resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23110size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23111threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23112may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23113sign. For example:
23114.code
23115quota = 10M
23116quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23117.endd
23118If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23119percent sign is ignored.
23120
23121The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23122and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23123warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23124the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23125can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23126&'From:'& line, the default is:
23127.code
23128From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23129.endd
23130.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23131If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23132option.
23133
23134The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23135are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23136percentage.
23137
23138
23139.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23140.cindex "envelope from"
23141.cindex "envelope sender"
23142If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23143format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23144you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23145so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23146for details of batch SMTP.
23147
23148
23149.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23150.cindex "carriage return"
23151.cindex "linefeed"
23152This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23153(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23154of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23155of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23156
23157&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23158(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23159in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23160carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23161have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23162changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23163
23164
23165.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23166This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23167exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23168&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23169that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23170&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23171
23172
23173.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23174This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23175the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23176&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23177each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23178
23179This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23180&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23181where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23182both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23183
23184.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23185Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23186have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23187&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23188the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23189error.
23190
23191&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23192is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23193
23194
23195.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23196If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23197appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23198&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23199sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23200&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23201delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23202
23203.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23204In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23205necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23206achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23207file corruption.
23208
23209The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23210It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23211except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23212
23213
23214.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23215This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23216set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23217locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23218of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23219are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23220the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23221rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23222does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23223
23224You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23225&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23226MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23227without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23228
23229
23230
23231
23232.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23233.cindex "appending to a file"
23234.cindex "file" "appending"
23235Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23236
23237.ilist
23238If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23239return is given.
23240
23241.next
23242.cindex "directory creation"
23243If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23244&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23245&%directory_mode%& option.
23246
23247.next
23248If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23249indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23250transport.
23251
23252.next
23253.cindex "file" "locking"
23254.cindex "locking files"
23255.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23256If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23257reliably over NFS, as follows:
23258
23259.olist
23260Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23261current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23262as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23263.next
23264Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23265.next
23266If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23267Unlink the hitching post name.
23268.next
23269Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23270then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23271of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23272restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23273.next
23274If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23275up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23276mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23277lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23278existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23279it before trying again.
23280.endlist olist
23281
23282.next
23283A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23284so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23285than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23286
23287.next
23288.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23289.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23290If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23291&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23292checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23293is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23294ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23295directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23296idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23297checked.
23298
23299.next
23300If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23301and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23302different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23303delivery is deferred.
23304
23305.next
23306If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23307If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23308is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23309permissions.
23310
23311.next
23312The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23313If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23314hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23315
23316.next
23317If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23318changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23319have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23320
23321.next
23322If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23323option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23324directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23325open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23326except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23327set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23328the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23329that prevents link following.
23330
23331.next
23332.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23333If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23334existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23335being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23336after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23337
23338.next
23339If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23340
23341.next
23342.cindex "file" "locking"
23343.cindex "locking files"
23344Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23345are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23346&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23347However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23348file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23349.code
23350/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23351.endd
23352using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23353the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23354the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23355
23356If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23357depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23358&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23359
23360If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23361&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23362to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23363delivery is deferred.
23364
23365If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23366&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23367waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23368immediately. It retries up to
23369.code
23370(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23371.endd
23372times (rounded up).
23373.endlist
23374
23375At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23376and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23377
23378
23379.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23380.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23381.cindex "&""From""& line"
23382When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23383delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23384activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23385&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23386router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23387configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23388ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23389
23390No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23391locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23392separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23393of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23394newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23395&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23396any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23397
23398If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23399the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23400different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23401deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23402
23403
23404.cindex "maildir format"
23405.cindex "mailstore format"
23406There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23407done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23408&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23409formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23410SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23411
23412.cindex "directory creation"
23413In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23414sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23415option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23416constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23417the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23418&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23419deferred.
23420
23421
23422
23423.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23424.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23425If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23426it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23427directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23428directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23429&_new_& subdirectory.
23430
23431In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23432<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23433Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23434before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23435filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23436opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23437Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23438
23439Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23440called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23441do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23442path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23443&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23444contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23445&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23446&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23447
23448These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23449and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23450folders. Consider this example:
23451.code
23452maildir_format = true
23453directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23454 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23455 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23456maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23457.endd
23458If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23459delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23460the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23461not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23462&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23463&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23464
23465However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23466delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23467does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23468&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23469directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23470
23471&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23472not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23473&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23474
23475.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23476.cindex "maildir++"
23477If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23478&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23479the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23480Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23481down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23482the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23483amount of space used.
23484
23485One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23486computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23487checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23488needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23489use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23490of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23491
23492
23493
23494
23495.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23496If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23497When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23498tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23499name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23500the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23501
23502
23503.vindex "&$message_size$&"
23504Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23505&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23506happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23507variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23508forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23509be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23510Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23511empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23512colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23513maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23514backwards compatibility).
23515
23516For one common implementation, you might set:
23517.code
23518maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23519.endd
23520but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23521
23522It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23523as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23524&[stat()]& each message file.
23525
23526
23527.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23528.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23529.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23530If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23531storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23532within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23533creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23534the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23535to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23536
23537The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23538messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23539in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23540value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23541is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23542need to know the quota.
23543
23544If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23545file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23546
23547A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23548maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23549See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23550details.
23551
23552
23553.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23554.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23555If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23556files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23557message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23558this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23559contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23560itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23561
23562During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23563&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23564&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23565mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23566file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23567the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23568
23569The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23570option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23571the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23572There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23573greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23574appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23575
23576If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23577failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23578configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23579&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23580
23581
23582.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23583If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23584file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23585messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23586section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23587.code
23588directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23589.endd
23590might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23591then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23592expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23593.ecindex IIDapptra1
23594.ecindex IIDapptra2
23595
23596
23597
23598
23599
23600
23601. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23602. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23603
23604.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23605.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23606.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23607The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23608the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23609automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23610&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23611to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23612
23613If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23614&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23615delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23616that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23617another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23618
23619
23620The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23621&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23622directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23623message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23624empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23625
23626The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23627by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23628passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23629transport is run as a consequence of a
23630&%mail%&
23631or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23632supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23633that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23634case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23635is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23636&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23637
23638&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23639command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23640gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23641&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23642
23643There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23644that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23645&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23646address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23647separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23648the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23649message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23650
23651Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23652message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23653immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23654the transport defers.
23655Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23656controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23657
23658If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23659&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23660of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23661&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23662
23663.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23664If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23665the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23666as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23667is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23668problems. They are just discarded.
23669
23670
23671
23672.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23673.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23674
23675.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23676This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23677message when the message is specified by the transport.
23678
23679
23680.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23681This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23682when the message is specified by the transport.
23683
23684
23685.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23686The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23687is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23688string comes first.
23689
23690
23691.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23692If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23693subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23694
23695
23696.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23697If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23698option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23699
23700
23701.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23702This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23703specified by the transport.
23704
23705
23706.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23707This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23708when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23709&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23710
23711
23712.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23713This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23714the message is specified by the transport.
23715
23716
23717.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23718If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23719used.
23720
23721
23722.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23723If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23724item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23725discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23726generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23727
23728
23729
23730.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23731This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23732recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23733This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23734
23735If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23736By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23737is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23738However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23739message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23740this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23741prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23742infinity.
23743
23744If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23745and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23746greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23747Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23748regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23749
23750In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23751which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23752be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23753means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23754unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23755file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23756
23757
23758.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23759See &%once%& above.
23760
23761
23762.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23763See &%once%& above.
23764After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23765
23766
23767.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23768This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23769specified by the transport.
23770
23771
23772.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23773If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23774message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23775configuration option.
23776
23777
23778.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23779This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23780specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23781automatic responses. For example:
23782.code
23783subject = Re: $h_subject:
23784.endd
23785There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23786subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23787bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23788non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23789small.
23790
23791
23792
23793.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23794This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23795message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23796the text comes first.
23797
23798
23799.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23800This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23801when the message is specified by the transport.
23802.ecindex IIDauttra1
23803.ecindex IIDauttra2
23804
23805
23806
23807
23808. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23809. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23810
23811.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23812.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23813.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23814.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23815.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23816The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23817specified command
23818or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23819This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23820transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23821implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23822to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23823has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23824.code
23825TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23826.endd
23827.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23828is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23829included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23830as follows:
23831
23832.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23833See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23834
23835
23836.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23837This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23838Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23839good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23840batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23841
23842
23843.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23844This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23845is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23846arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23847number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23848is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23849LMTP protocol.
23850
23851.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23852.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23853If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23854commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23855in its response to the LHLO command.
23856
23857.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23858This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23859be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23860delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23861
23862
23863.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23864The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23865respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23866is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23867LMTP transport:
23868.code
23869lmtp:
23870 driver = lmtp
23871 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23872 batch_max = 20
23873 user = exim
23874.endd
23875This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23876necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23877
23878
23879
23880. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23881. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23882
23883.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23884.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23885.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23886The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23887running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23888pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23889(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23890their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23891following ways:
23892
23893.ilist
23894.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23895A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23896transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23897contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23898is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23899.next
23900.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23901If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23902transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23903more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23904(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23905(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23906that are routed to the transport.
23907.next
23908.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23909A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23910alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23911pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23912&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23913(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23914this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23915.endlist
23916
23917
23918The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23919deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23920implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23921
23922In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23923&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23924other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23925transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23926directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23927details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23928for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23929
23930.new
23931.cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
23932.cindex pipe "tainted data"
23933Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
23934.wen
23935
23936
23937.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23938If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23939delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23940any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23941write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23942Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23943of "1" to enforce serialization.
23944
23945
23946
23947
23948.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23949.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23950If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23951have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23952the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23953in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23954later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23955logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23956&"local delivery failed"&.
23957
23958If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23959the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23960will be sent as normal.
23961
23962If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23963script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23964value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23965apply in this case.
23966
23967If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23968return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23969asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23970a non-existent command may be the problem.
23971
23972The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23973set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23974error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23975return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23976included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23977similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23978failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23979&%temp_errors%&.
23980
23981
23982
23983.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23984.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23985The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23986by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23987&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23988run.
23989
23990.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23991Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23992double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23993way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23994
23995String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23996traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23997expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23998For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23999quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24000.code
24001command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24002.endd
24003will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24004arguments. You have to write
24005.code
24006command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24007.endd
24008to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24009argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24010result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24011interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24012generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24013expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24014example:
24015.code
24016command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24017.endd
24018
24019.cindex "transport" "filter"
24020.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24021.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24022Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24023&`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24024This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24025place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24026transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24027inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24028avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24029&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24030
24031If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24032for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24033is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24034argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24035&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24036the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24037should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24038run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24039
24040After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24041in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24042message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24043standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24044read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24045may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24046control what is done with it.
24047
24048Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24049in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24050taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24051explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24052where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24053under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24054an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24055works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24056as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24057&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24058with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24059
24060
24061
24062.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24063.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24064.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24065The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24066This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24067the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24068environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24069to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24070.display
24071&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24072&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24073&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24074&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24075&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24076&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24077&`LOGNAME `& see below
24078&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24079&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24080&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24081&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24082&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24083&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24084&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24085&`USER `& see below
24086.endd
24087When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24088router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24089called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24090the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24091removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24092LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24093same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24094
24095.cindex "HOST"
24096HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24097associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24098pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24099the router.
24100
24101.cindex "HOME"
24102If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24103for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24104by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24105user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24106
24107
24108.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24109.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24110
24111
24112
24113.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24114.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24115The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24116permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24117permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24118paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24119&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24120in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24121the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24122&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24123otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24124example, if
24125.code
24126allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24127.endd
24128and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24129&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24130&%use_shell%& is set.
24131
24132
24133.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24134See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24135
24136
24137.option batch_max pipe integer 1
24138This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24139See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24140
24141
24142.option check_string pipe string unset
24143As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24144&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24145by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24146&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24147any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24148of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24149the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24150ignored.
24151
24152
24153.option command pipe string&!! unset
24154This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24155obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24156set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24157the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24158Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24159&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24160
24161
24162.option environment pipe string&!! unset
24163.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24164.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24165This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24166command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24167a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24168environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24169
24170
24171.option escape_string pipe string unset
24172See &%check_string%& above.
24173
24174
24175.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24176.cindex "exec failure"
24177.cindex "failure of exec"
24178.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24179Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24180any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24181is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24182frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24183
24184
24185.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24186.cindex "signal exit"
24187.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24188Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24189a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24190frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24191
24192
24193.option force_command pipe boolean false
24194.cindex "force command"
24195.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24196Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24197the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24198is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24199useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24200command. For example:
24201.code
24202command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24203force_command
24204.endd
24205
24206Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24207&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24208separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24209
24210
24211.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24212If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24213run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24214Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24215from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24216&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24217
24218&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24219See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24220
24221
24222.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24223.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24224If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24225one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24226and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24227written to the main log.
24228
24229
24230.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24231If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24232stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24233the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24234failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24235option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24236be set.
24237
24238
24239.option log_output pipe boolean false
24240If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24241stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24242the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24243exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24244
24245
24246.option max_output pipe integer 20K
24247This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24248standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24249process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24250catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24251the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24252&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24253exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24254
24255
24256.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24257The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24258The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24259.code
24260message_prefix = \
24261 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24262 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24263.endd
24264.cindex "Cyrus"
24265.cindex "&%tmail%&"
24266.cindex "&""From""& line"
24267This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24268However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24269or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24270setting
24271.code
24272message_prefix =
24273.endd
24274&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24275&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24276
24277
24278.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24279The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24280The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24281The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24282.code
24283message_suffix =
24284.endd
24285&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24286&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24287
24288
24289.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24290This option is expanded and
24291specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24292variable of the subprocess.
24293If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24294sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24295apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24296
24297
24298.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24299Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24300a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24301during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24302It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24303for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24304resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24305installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24306of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24307
24308
24309.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24310.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24311If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24312process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24313to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24314&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24315accept the message is used.
24316
24317
24318.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24319When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24320contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24321in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24322command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24323handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24324
24325
24326.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24327If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24328return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24329is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24330However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24331message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24332&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24333
24334
24335
24336.option return_output pipe boolean false
24337If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24338deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24339is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24340However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24341output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24342option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24343of them may be set.
24344
24345
24346
24347.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24348.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24349This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24350asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24351and &%return_output%& is not set,
24352and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24353temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24354numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24355codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24356defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24357compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24358and 73, respectively.
24359
24360
24361.option timeout pipe time 1h
24362If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24363causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24364specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24365command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24366and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24367if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24368
24369.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24370A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24371runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24372treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24373is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24374delivery to be deferred.
24375
24376.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24377This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24378
24379
24380.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24381.cindex "envelope sender"
24382If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24383SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24384commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24385you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24386&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24387
24388.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24389.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24390This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24391BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24392resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24393limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24394class database.
24395
24396
24397.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24398.cindex "carriage return"
24399.cindex "linefeed"
24400This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24401(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24402of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24403of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24404
24405The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24406written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24407are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24408&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24409values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24410
24411
24412.option use_shell pipe boolean false
24413.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24414If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24415instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24416&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24417where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24418modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24419&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24420command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24421its &%-c%& option.
24422
24423
24424
24425.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24426.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24427.cindex "&'procmail'&"
24428.cindex "external local delivery"
24429.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24430.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24431The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24432delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24433this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24434uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24435by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24436necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24437appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24438configuration for &%procmail%&:
24439.code
24440# transport
24441procmail_pipe:
24442 driver = pipe
24443 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24444 return_path_add
24445 delivery_date_add
24446 envelope_to_add
24447 check_string = "From "
24448 escape_string = ">From "
24449 umask = 077
24450 user = $local_part
24451 group = mail
24452
24453# router
24454procmail:
24455 driver = accept
24456 check_local_user
24457 transport = procmail_pipe
24458.endd
24459In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24460&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24461or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24462user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24463&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24464home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24465
24466&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24467.code
24468IFS=" "
24469.endd
24470as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24471use a shell to run pipe commands.
24472
24473.cindex "Cyrus"
24474The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24475deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24476.code
24477# transport
24478local_delivery_cyrus:
24479 driver = pipe
24480 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24481 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24482 user = cyrus
24483 group = mail
24484 return_output
24485 log_output
24486 message_prefix =
24487 message_suffix =
24488
24489# router
24490local_user_cyrus:
24491 driver = accept
24492 check_local_user
24493 local_part_suffix = .*
24494 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24495.endd
24496Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24497&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24498sender.
24499.ecindex IIDpiptra1
24500.ecindex IIDpiptra2
24501
24502
24503. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24504. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24505
24506.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24507.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24508.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24509The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24510or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24511that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24512explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24513&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24514
24515
24516.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24517The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24518two ways:
24519
24520.ilist
24521If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24522routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24523that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24524the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24525does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24526value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24527section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24528.next
24529.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24530When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24531looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24532connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24533for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24534process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24535process.
24536.endlist
24537
24538
24539For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24540incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24541no further messages are sent over that connection.
24542
24543
24544
24545.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24546.vindex "&$host$&"
24547.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24548At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24549&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24550passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24551specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24552&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24553that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24554&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24555
24556
24557.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24558.vindex &$tls_bits$&
24559.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24560.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24561.vindex &$tls_sni$&
24562At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24563&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24564are the values that were set when the message was received.
24565These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24566SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24567variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24568appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24569are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24570&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24571
24572These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24573and will be removed in a future release.
24574
24575
24576.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24577.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24578The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24579
24580
24581.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24582.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24583When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24584is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24585runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24586reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24587setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24588problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24589
24590.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24591.cindex "local host" "sending to"
24592.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24593When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24594to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24595deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24596the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24597configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24598configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24599
24600
24601.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24602.cindex "Cyrus"
24603When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24604is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24605overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24606forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24607to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24608ignored.
24609
24610The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24611started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24612&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24613particular connection.
24614
24615If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24616&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24617deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24618unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24619
24620This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24621deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24622&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24623.code
24624authenticated_sender = $local_part
24625.endd
24626This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24627allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24628
24629Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24630domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24631value.
24632
24633
24634.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24635If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24636is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24637authenticated as a client.
24638
24639
24640.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24641This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24642sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24643remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24644
24645
24646.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24647This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24648to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24649several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24650less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24651systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24652option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24653
24654
24655.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24656.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24657.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24658.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24659This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24660over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24661For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24662option.
24663
24664
24665.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24666.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24667.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24668.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24669This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24670where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24671If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24672Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24673configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24674been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24675TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24676counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24677If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24678be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24679
24680
24681.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24682This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24683the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24684of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24685
24686
24687.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24688DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24689.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24690DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24691.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24692DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24693.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24694DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24695.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24696DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24697.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24698DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24699.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24700DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24701.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24702DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24703.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24704DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24705
24706
24707.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24708.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24709.cindex retry "final cutoff"
24710This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24711domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24712cutoff times.
24713
24714In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24715them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24716Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24717retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24718a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24719unhappy at this prospect, so...
24720
24721If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24722addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24723IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24724none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24725delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24726addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24727continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24728&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24729to them.
24730
24731
24732.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24733If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24734and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24735the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24736in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24737
24738
24739.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24740If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24741&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24742See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24743details.
24744
24745
24746.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24747.cindex "MX record" "security"
24748.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24749.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24750.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24751DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24752the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24753transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24754router option.
24755
24756
24757
24758.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24759.cindex "MX record" "security"
24760.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24761.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24762.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24763DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24764the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24765useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24766&%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24767
24768
24769
24770.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24771.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24772This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24773of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24774The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24775Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24776&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24777
24778The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24779(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24780that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24781equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24782Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24783
24784
24785.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24786.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24787String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24788colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24789port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24790&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24791item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24792in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24793
24794Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24795addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24796&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24797not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24798&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24799However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24800
24801If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24802the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24803transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24804address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24805list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24806
24807Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24808re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24809addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24810copy of the message is sent.
24811
24812The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24813&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24814both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24815from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24816fails"& facility.
24817
24818
24819.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24820This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24821line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24822zero.
24823
24824.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24825If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24826being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24827(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24828instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24829it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24830
24831.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24832This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24833server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24834implementations of TLS.
24835
24836.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24837.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24838.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24839.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24840The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24841been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24842command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24843option is:
24844.code
24845$primary_hostname
24846.endd
24847During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24848the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24849&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24850used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24851servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24852that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24853interface address, you could use this:
24854.code
24855helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24856 {$primary_hostname}}
24857.endd
24858The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24859callouts.
24860
24861.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24862Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24863finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24864&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24865email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24866all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24867
24868The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24869processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24870&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24871&%hosts_override%& is set.
24872
24873The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24874list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24875separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24876&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24877item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24878in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24879of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24880
24881If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24882the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24883well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24884address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24885&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24886&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24887that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24888address are used.
24889
24890During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24891unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24892
24893
24894.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24895.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24896.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24897.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24898.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24899This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24900example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24901matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24902start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24903facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24904
24905
24906.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24907.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24908Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24909that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24910
24911.option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24912.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24913.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24914If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24915this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24916and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24917
24918The retry hints database is used for the record,
24919and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24920When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24921It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24922so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24923
24924See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
24925
24926Note:
24927When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24928will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24929is filled in.
24930A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24931presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24932can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24933You have been warned.
24934
24935
24936.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24937.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24938Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24939matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24940
24941.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24942.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24943Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24944or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24945to any host that matches this list.
24946
24947
24948.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24949.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24950.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24951.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24952.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24953This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24954delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24955&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24956
24957
24958.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24959This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24960tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24961why it exists.
24962
24963
24964
24965.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24966.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24967.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24968.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24969For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24970been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24971message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24972explanation of when this might be needed.
24973
24974.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24975.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24976.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24977.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24978For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24979been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24980message on the same session.
24981
24982The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24983process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24984sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24985instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24986the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24987The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24988logging.
24989
24990
24991
24992.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24993If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24994attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24995&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24996&%fallback_hosts%&.
24997
24998
24999.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25000.cindex "randomized host list"
25001.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25002.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25003If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25004&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25005were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25006router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25007is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25008list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25009
25010When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25011order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25012behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25013&`+`& in the host list. For example:
25014.code
25015hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25016.endd
25017The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25018randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25019If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25020
25021.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25022.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25023This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25024before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25025servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25026authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25027temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25028hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25029&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25030
25031
25032.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
25033.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25034Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25035TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25036&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25037
25038.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25039.cindex DANE "transport options"
25040.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25041If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25042TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25043and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25044the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25045There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25046See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25047
25048.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25049.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25050Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25051TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25052&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25053
25054.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25055.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25056Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25057matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25058&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25059incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25060
25061.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25062.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25063This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25064authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25065connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
25066unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
25067&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25068
25069.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25070.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25071.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25072.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25073This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25074CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25075.new
25076Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25077.wen
25078BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25079
25080.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25081.cindex DANE "transport options"
25082.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25083If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25084TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25085and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25086the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25087There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25088See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25089
25090.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25091.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25092.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25093.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25094This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25095the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25096perform a TCP Fast Open.
25097No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25098supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25099the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25100
25101The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25102as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25103
25104On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25105in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25106There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25107it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25108such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25109
25110.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25111.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25112This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25113PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25114for multi-recipient messages.
25115The option can usually be left as default.
25116
25117.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25118.cindex "bind IP address"
25119.cindex "IP address" "binding"
25120.vindex "&$host$&"
25121.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25122This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25123call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25124&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25125message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25126&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25127outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25128interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25129unknown.
25130
25131During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25132&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25133during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25134string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25135string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25136separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25137For example:
25138.code
25139interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25140.endd
25141The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25142connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25143&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25144interface to use if the host has more than one.
25145
25146
25147.option keepalive smtp boolean true
25148.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25149This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25150connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25151periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25152of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25153or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25154that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25155that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25156TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25157unreachable hosts.
25158
25159
25160.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25161.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25162If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25163string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25164has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25165
25166.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25167.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25168This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25169SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25170so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25171permits this.
25172
25173
25174.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25175.vindex "&$domain$&"
25176When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25177addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25178to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25179handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25180&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25181is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25182
25183It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25184&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25185&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25186
25187.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25188.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25189.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25190This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25191&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25192received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25193The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25194variable that contains an outgoing port.
25195
25196If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25197otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25198normally &"smtp"&,
25199but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25200and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25201If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25202is deferred.
25203
25204Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25205to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25206
25207
25208
25209.option protocol smtp string smtp
25210.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25211.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25212.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25213.vindex "&$port$&"
25214If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25215the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25216protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25217deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25218over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25219
25220If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25221changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25222connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25223The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25224but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25225(as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25226
25227
25228.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25229Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25230constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25231means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25232tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25233addresses is not affected.
25234
25235However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25236each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25237the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25238Exim to use only the host name.
25239Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25240
25241
25242.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25243.cindex "serializing connections"
25244.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25245Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25246host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25247the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25248slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25249Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25250&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25251
25252.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25253Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25254written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25255is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25256records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25257guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25258
25259If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25260relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25261start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25262may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25263are used for ETRN serialization.
25264
25265See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25266
25267
25268.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25269.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25270.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25271.cindex "size" "of message"
25272.cindex "transport" "filter"
25273.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25274If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25275MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25276an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25277sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25278configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25279this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25280
25281Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25282the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25283
25284
25285.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25286.cindex proxy SOCKS
25287This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25288transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25289
25290
25291.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25292.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25293.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25294.vindex "&$host$&"
25295.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25296The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25297client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25298connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25299address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25300details of TLS.
25301
25302&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25303certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25304name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25305assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25306client.
25307
25308
25309.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25310.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25311.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25312This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25313be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25314
25315
25316.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25317.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25318When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25319key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25320for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25321If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25322will fail.
25323
25324Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25325
25326
25327.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25328.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25329.vindex "&$host$&"
25330.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25331The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25332client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25333connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25334&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25335expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25336result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25337the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25338
25339
25340.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25341.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25342.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25343.vindex "&$host$&"
25344.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25345The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25346when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25347the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25348&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25349expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25350is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25351&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25352ciphers is a preference order.
25353
25354
25355
25356.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25357.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25358.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25359If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25360TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25361the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25362certificate and private key for the session.
25363
25364See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25365
25366Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25367TLS extensions.
25368
25369
25370
25371
25372.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25373.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25374When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25375setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25376to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25377current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25378option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25379response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25380TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25381unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25382in clear.
25383
25384
25385.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25386.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25387.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25388This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25389certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25390The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25391Note that unless the host is in this list
25392TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25393when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25394The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25395certificate verification succeeds.
25396
25397
25398.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25399.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25400.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25401This option give a list of hosts for which,
25402while verifying the server certificate,
25403checks will be included on the host name
25404(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25405versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25406limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25407
25408There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25409
25410
25411.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25412.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25413.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25414.vindex "&$host$&"
25415.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25416The value of this option must be either the
25417word "system"
25418or the absolute path to
25419a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25420for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25421
25422The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25423This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25424is taken as empty and an explicit location
25425must be specified.
25426
25427The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25428preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25429
25430With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25431explicitly
25432either by file or directory
25433are added to those given by the system default location.
25434
25435The values of &$host$& and
25436&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25437expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25438
25439For back-compatibility,
25440if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25441(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25442and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25443
25444
25445.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25446.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25447.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25448This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25449certificate verification must succeed.
25450The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25451If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25452operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25453
25454.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25455.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25456.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25457If built with internationalization support,
25458this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25459to a-label form.
25460For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25461
25462
25463
25464
25465.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25466 "SECTvalhosmax"
25467.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25468.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25469There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25470tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25471&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25472
25473
25474The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25475for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25476option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25477multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25478retrying.
25479
25480Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25481multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25482created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25483
25484Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25485several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25486problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25487&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25488delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25489
25490Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25491arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25492limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25493some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25494&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25495that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25496see below for an exception).
25497
25498Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25499list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25500If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25501but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25502that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25503
25504Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25505higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25506hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25507which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25508tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25509reached their retry times.
25510
25511However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25512large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25513Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25514of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25515time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25516without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25517all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25518there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25519the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25520every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25521reached.
25522
25523The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25524particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25525out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25526reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25527been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25528take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25529
25530The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25531Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25532and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25533possible IP addresses have been tried.
25534.ecindex IIDsmttra1
25535.ecindex IIDsmttra2
25536
25537
25538
25539
25540
25541. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25542. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25543
25544.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25545.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25546There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25547addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25548(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25549abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25550
25551Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25552messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25553&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25554appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25555locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25556unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25557lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25558
25559One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25560when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25561such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25562do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25563
25564
25565.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25566This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25567main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25568&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25569
25570Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25571Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25572facility; you do not have to use it.
25573
25574The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25575configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25576addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25577address to which it applies.
25578
25579Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25580the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25581rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25582those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25583by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25584are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25585rules.
25586
25587Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25588applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25589well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25590headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25591
25592
25593In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25594legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25595in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25596used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25597Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25598discouraged.
25599
25600There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25601illustrated by these examples:
25602
25603.ilist
25604The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25605exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25606gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25607&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25608.next
25609A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25610&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25611.endlist
25612
25613
25614
25615.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25616.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25617.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25618Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25619message's processing.
25620
25621.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25622At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25623by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25624ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25625is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25626rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25627rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25628RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25629rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25630
25631.vindex "&$domain$&"
25632.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25633Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25634may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25635rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25636from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25637for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25638value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25639as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25640SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25641
25642As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25643recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25644the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25645any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25646.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25647before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25648
25649When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25650rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25651redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25652
25653.cindex "envelope from"
25654.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25655.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25656.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25657At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25658specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25659This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25660section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25661header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25662applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25663
25664The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25665transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25666transport time.
25667
25668
25669
25670
25671.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25672.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25673.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25674Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25675configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25676&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
256772822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25678transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25679appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25680envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25681.code
25682exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25683.endd
25684might produce the output
25685.code
25686sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25687from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25688to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25689cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25690bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25691reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25692env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25693env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25694.endd
25695which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25696the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25697present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25698set for a particular transport.
25699
25700
25701.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25702.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25703The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25704rules in the form
25705.display
25706<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25707.endd
25708Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25709transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25710takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25711any colons must be doubled, of course).
25712
25713The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25714Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25715case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25716characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25717ignored.
25718
25719For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25720order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25721replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25722
25723The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25724releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25725received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25726lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25727address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25728(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25729that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25730
25731.vindex "&$domain$&"
25732.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25733The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25734string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25735rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25736.code
25737*@* ${lookup ...
25738.endd
25739where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25740refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25741
25742
25743.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25744.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25745.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25746The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25747address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25748single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25749against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25750you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25751facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25752
25753Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25754case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25755can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25756
25757.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25758After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25759depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25760replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25761refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25762numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25763of pattern they are set as follows:
25764
25765.ilist
25766If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25767refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25768the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25769pattern
25770.code
25771*queen@*.fict.example
25772.endd
25773is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25774.code
25775$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25776$1 = hearts-
25777$2 = wonderland
25778.endd
25779Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25780does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25781
25782.next
25783If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25784of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25785for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25786rewriting rule of the form
25787.display
25788&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25789.endd
25790and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25791.code
25792$1 = foo
25793$2 = bar
25794$3 = baz.example
25795.endd
25796If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25797wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25798&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25799partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25800whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25801.endlist
25802
25803
25804.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25805.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25806If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25807match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25808rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25809.code
25810hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25811.endd
25812specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25813&'From:'& headers.
25814
25815.vindex "&$domain$&"
25816.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25817If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25818yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25819&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25820Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25821cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25822matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25823the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25824current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25825expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25826entry written to the panic log.
25827
25828
25829
25830.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25831There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25832
25833.ilist
25834Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25835c, f, h, r, s, t.
25836.next
25837A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25838.next
25839Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25840.endlist
25841
25842For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25843E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25844
25845
25846
25847.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25848 "SECID154"
25849.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25850If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25851&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25852and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25853transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25854rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25855.display
25856&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25857&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25858&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25859&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25860&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25861&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25862&`h`& rewrite all headers
25863&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25864&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25865&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25866.endd
25867"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25868individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25869other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25870
25871You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25872restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25873
25874
25875.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25876.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25877.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25878.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25879The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25880SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25881before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25882required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25883data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25884
25885.vindex "&$domain$&"
25886.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25887This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25888compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25889input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25890the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25891expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25892original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25893
25894
25895.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25896There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25897take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25898correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25899
25900.ilist
25901If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25902unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25903absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25904.next
25905If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25906even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25907expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25908(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25909.next
25910The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25911address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25912rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25913.next
25914.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25915When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25916to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25917left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25918.code
25919From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25920.endd
25921into
25922.code
25923From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25924.endd
25925.cindex "RFC 2047"
25926Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25927done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25928causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25929replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
259302822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25931brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25932(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25933is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25934
25935When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25936rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25937.endlist
25938
25939
25940.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25941Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25942.code
25943*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25944*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25945 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25946.endd
25947Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25948the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25949has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25950consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25951present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25952explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25953at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25954error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25955
25956The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25957domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25958.code
25959root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25960.endd
25961were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25962local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25963
25964Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25965&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25966messages that originate outside the local host:
25967.code
25968*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25969 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25970.endd
25971The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25972space.
25973
25974.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25975.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25976Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25977an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25978the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25979remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25980sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25981components. For example, the rule
25982.code
25983\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25984.endd
25985rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25986&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25987a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25988method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25989to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25990use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25991can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25992.ecindex IIDaddrew
25993
25994
25995
25996
25997
25998. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25999. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26000
26001.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26002.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26003.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26004The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26005retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26006be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26007empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26008errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26009general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26010line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26011address, domain and error.
26012
26013The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26014host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26015Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26016address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26017been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26018tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26019log selector is set, the message
26020.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26021&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26022skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26023the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26024
26025Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26026in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26027actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26028failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26029the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26030added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26031same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26032domain are maintained independently.
26033
26034When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26035receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26036always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26037behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26038quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26039suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26040subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26041the local address is reached.
26042
26043.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26044If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26045whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26046files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26047always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26048
26049The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26050rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26051record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26052timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26053and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26054messages that it should now be retaining.
26055
26056
26057
26058.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26059.cindex "retry" "rules"
26060Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26061separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26062addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26063enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26064in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26065present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26066message's sender, respectively.
26067
26068
26069The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26070&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26071which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26072has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26073list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26074which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26075example,
26076.code
26077lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26078.endd
26079provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26080whereas
26081.code
26082alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26083.endd
26084applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26085In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26086part.
26087
26088.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26089&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26090must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26091expressions work in address lists.
26092.display
26093&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26094&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26095.endd
26096
26097
26098.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26099When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26100example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26101against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26102router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26103regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26104A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26105&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26106&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26107
26108Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26109failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26110configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26111&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26112local transports).
26113
26114.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26115However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26116suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26117whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26118rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26119failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26120recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26121reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26122&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26123lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26124commands.
26125
26126
26127
26128.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26129 "SECID160"
26130For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26131example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26132twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26133&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26134the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26135suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26136.code
26137a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26138 MX 6 p.q.r.example
26139 MX 7 m.n.o.example
26140.endd
26141and the retry rules are
26142.code
26143p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26144a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26145.endd
26146and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26147first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26148rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26149to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26150tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26151first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26152
26153In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26154first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26155&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26156routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26157
26158&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26159However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26160host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26161.code
26162route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26163.endd
26164then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26165textual form of the IP address.
26166
26167.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26168.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26169The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26170asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26171
26172.vlist
26173.vitem &%auth_failed%&
26174Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26175&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26176
26177.vitem &%data_4xx%&
26178A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26179after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26180
26181.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26182A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26183
26184.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26185A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26186.endlist
26187
26188For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26189as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26190recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26191and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26192retry rule of this form:
26193.code
26194the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26195.endd
26196These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26197LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26198
26199.vlist
26200.vitem &%lost_connection%&
26201A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26202legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26203for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26204
26205.vitem &%lookup%&
26206A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26207Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26208its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26209Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26210its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26211
26212.vitem &%refused_MX%&
26213A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26214
26215.vitem &%refused_A%&
26216A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26217
26218.vitem &%refused%&
26219A connection was refused.
26220
26221.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26222A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26223
26224.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26225A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26226
26227.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26228A connection attempt timed out.
26229
26230.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26231There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26232obtained from an MX record.
26233
26234.vitem &%timeout_A%&
26235There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26236obtained from an MX record.
26237
26238.vitem &%timeout%&
26239There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26240
26241.vitem &%tls_required%&
26242The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26243&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26244to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26245
26246.vitem &%quota%&
26247A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26248transport.
26249
26250.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26251.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26252.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26253A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26254transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26255&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26256for four days.
26257.endlist
26258
26259.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26260The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26261timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26262it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26263However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26264heuristic rules:
26265
26266.ilist
26267If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26268used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26269quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26270.next
26271.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26272For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26273subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26274the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26275change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26276MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26277time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26278.next
26279For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26280obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26281.endlist
26282
26283The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26284mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26285when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26286error).
26287
26288
26289
26290.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26291.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26292You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26293specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26294apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26295form:
26296.display
26297&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26298.endd
26299The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26300.code
26301* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26302.endd
26303matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26304host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26305For example:
26306.code
26307a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26308.endd
26309&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26310(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26311only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26312its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26313all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26314
26315When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26316&%-f%& command line option, like this:
26317.code
26318exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26319.endd
26320If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26321list is never matched.
26322
26323
26324
26325
26326
26327.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26328.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26329The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26330sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26331.display
26332<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26333.endd
26334The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26335time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26336arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26337time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26338relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26339
26340.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26341.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26342.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26343.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26344The available algorithms are:
26345
26346.ilist
26347&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26348the interval.
26349.next
26350&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26351specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26352is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26353.next
26354&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26355retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26356maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26357the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26358rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26359members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26360queue processing times.
26361.endlist
26362
26363When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26364order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26365used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26366case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26367current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26368computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26369interval is found. The main configuration variable
26370.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26371.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26372.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26373&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26374cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26375
26376A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26377host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26378basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26379for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26380generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26381time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26382time.
26383
26384.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26385Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26386run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26387starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26388new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26389If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26390occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26391messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26392processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26393your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26394number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26395sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26396
26397The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26398&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26399&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26400&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26401are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26402deliveries that have been deferred.
26403
26404
26405.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26406Here are some example retry rules:
26407.code
26408alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26409wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26410wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26411lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26412* refused_A F,2h,20m;
26413* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26414.endd
26415The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26416&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26417mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26418hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26419parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26420effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26421fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26422days.
26423
26424The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26425happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26426intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26427first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26428so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26429
26430The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26431They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26432all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26433were not obtained from an MX record.
26434
26435The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26436first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26437not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26438hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
264391.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26440
26441
26442
26443.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26444.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26445.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26446.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26447.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26448Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26449consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26450set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26451been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26452arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26453failing for the first time.
26454
26455This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26456backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26457Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26458down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26459
26460If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26461every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26462message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26463
26464
26465
26466
26467.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26468.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26469.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26470Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26471that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26472default retry rule:
26473.code
26474* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26475.endd
26476the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26477long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26478failure for the recipient address that counts.
26479
26480When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26481addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26482causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26483In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26484time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26485
26486For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26487messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26488post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26489
26490.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26491.cindex retry "final cutoff"
26492If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26493.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26494&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26495default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26496as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26497reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26498attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26499those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26500the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26501
26502In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26503for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26504times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26505behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26506to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26507notice.
26508
26509If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26510addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26511addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26512no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26513words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26514addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26515If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26516&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26517deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26518true.
26519
26520.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26521.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26522Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26523intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26524its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26525because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26526host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26527failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26528reached.
26529
26530Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26531applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26532Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26533examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26534commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26535time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26536is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26537time out the address.
26538
26539The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26540the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26541given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26542time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26543not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26544considered immediately.
26545.ecindex IIDretconf1
26546.ecindex IIDregconf2
26547
26548
26549
26550
26551
26552
26553. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26554. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26555
26556.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26557.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26558.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26559The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26560with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26561described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26562to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26563permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26564transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26565other.
26566
26567.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26568Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26569
26570.ilist
26571The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26572the client's EHLO command.
26573.next
26574The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26575may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26576.next
26577The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26578appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26579just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26580any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26581with the AUTH command.
26582.next
26583The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26584.next
26585If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26586option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26587mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26588connection.
26589.next
26590If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26591authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26592unauthenticated connection.
26593.endlist
26594
26595If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26596mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26597SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26598includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26599.display
26600&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26601&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26602&`Connected to server.example.`&
26603&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26604&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26605&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26606&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26607&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26608&`250-PIPELINING`&
26609&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26610&`250 HELP`&
26611.endd
26612The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26613authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26614mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26615routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26616controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26617included by setting
26618.code
26619AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26620AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26621AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26622AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26623AUTH_GSASL=yes
26624AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26625AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26626AUTH_SPA=yes
26627AUTH_TLS=yes
26628.endd
26629in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26630authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26631the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26632The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26633work via a socket interface.
26634The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26635as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26636The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26637provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26638The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26639supporting setting a server keytab.
26640The seventh can be configured to support
26641the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26642not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26643The eighth authenticator
26644supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26645The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26646instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26647
26648The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26649section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26650authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26651authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26652is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26653messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26654options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26655
26656To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26657&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26658either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26659functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26660to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26661both sets of options, is required. For example:
26662.code
26663cram:
26664 driver = cram_md5
26665 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26666 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26667 client_name = ph10
26668 client_secret = secret2
26669.endd
26670The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26671&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26672
26673Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26674The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26675authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26676in Exim.
26677
26678&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26679per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26680account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26681authenticating data.
26682
26683Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26684&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26685and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26686Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26687used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26688second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26689user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26690configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26691&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26692as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26693choose to honour.
26694
26695A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26696to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26697mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26698typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26699
26700
26701
26702.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26703.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26704.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26705
26706.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26707When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26708&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26709used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26710encrypted by a setting such as:
26711.code
26712client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26713.endd
26714
26715
26716.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26717When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26718result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26719Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26720
26721
26722.option driver authenticators string unset
26723This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26724authenticators is to be used.
26725
26726
26727.option public_name authenticators string unset
26728This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26729implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26730contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26731but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26732defaults to the driver's instance name.
26733
26734
26735.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26736When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26737is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26738mechanism is not advertised.
26739If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26740forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26741See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26742
26743
26744.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26745This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26746is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26747for details.
26748
26749For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26750mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26751
26752For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26753authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26754authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26755authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26756to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26757error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26758string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26759expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26760other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26761the error text.
26762
26763
26764.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26765If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26766command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26767output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26768out the values of variables.
26769If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26770output, and Exim carries on processing.
26771
26772
26773.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26774.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26775.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26776When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26777expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26778messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26779lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26780configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26781refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26782On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26783the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26784If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26785
26786
26787.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26788This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26789as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26790driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26791as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26792remembered for later use.
26793How it is used is described in the following section.
26794
26795
26796
26797
26798
26799.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26800.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26801.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26802When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26803the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26804message:
26805
26806.ilist
26807If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26808than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26809.next
26810If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26811.next
26812.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26813If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26814running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26815from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26816&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26817return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26818given for the MAIL command.
26819.next
26820If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26821is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26822authenticated.
26823.next
26824If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26825the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26826&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26827valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26828fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26829&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26830the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26831message.
26832.endlist
26833
26834
26835When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26836hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26837&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26838process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26839
26840.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26841Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26842MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26843therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26844value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26845ACL is run.
26846
26847
26848
26849.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26850.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26851When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26852authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26853conditions:
26854
26855.ilist
26856The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26857.next
26858It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26859yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26860.endlist
26861
26862The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26863the mechanisms are advertised.
26864
26865Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26866provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26867even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26868set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26869You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26870For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26871that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26872.code
26873auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26874.endd
26875so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26876
26877The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26878authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26879advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26880such as:
26881.code
26882server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26883.endd
26884.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26885If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26886yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26887
26888When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26889immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26890command. This is the case if
26891
26892.ilist
26893The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26894.next
26895No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26896.next
26897Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26898server authenticators.
26899.endlist
26900
26901
26902Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26903to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26904AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26905
26906If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26907server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26908that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26909the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26910fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26911rejected with a 504 error.
26912
26913.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26914.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26915When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26916&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26917or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26918public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26919client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26920no successful authentication.
26921
26922.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26923Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26924&%authresults%& expansion item.
26925
26926
26927
26928
26929.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26930.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26931.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26932.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26933Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26934configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26935encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26936script:
26937.code
26938use MIME::Base64;
26939printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26940.endd
26941.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26942This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26943interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26944some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26945command line to run this script on such data might be
26946.code
26947encode '\0user\0password'
26948.endd
26949Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26950backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26951whose code value is zero.
26952
26953&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26954digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26955you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26956interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26957
26958&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26959specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26960example, a command such as
26961.code
26962encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26963.endd
26964gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26965
26966If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26967base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26968.code
26969echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26970.endd
26971The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26972in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26973output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26974should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26975
26976
26977
26978.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26979.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26980The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26981&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26982announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26983of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26984
26985.ilist
26986For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26987they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26988mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26989of the authenticator.
26990.next
26991.vindex "&$host$&"
26992.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26993When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26994variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26995that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26996any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26997Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26998delivery to be deferred.
26999.next
27000If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27001Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27002try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27003usual way.
27004.next
27005If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27006carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27007possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27008no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27009what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27010&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27011delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27012turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27013deliver the message unauthenticated.
27014.endlist
27015
27016Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27017confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27018upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27019router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27020the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27021running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27022check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27023No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27024
27025For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27026
27027.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27028When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27029parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27030the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27031is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27032incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27033allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27034to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27035&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27036&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27037the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27038.ecindex IIDauthconf1
27039.ecindex IIDauthconf2
27040
27041
27042
27043
27044
27045
27046. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27047. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27048
27049.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27050.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27051.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27052The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27053LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27054plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27055security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27056(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27057use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27058connections as you do for login accounts.
27059
27060.section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27061The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27062TLS is not being used:
27063.code
27064 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27065 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27066.endd
27067
27068&*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27069but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27070(including their names) have been properly verified.
27071
27072.section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27073.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27074When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27075
27076.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27077This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
27078configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
27079
27080.option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27081The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27082prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27083given.
27084
27085.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27086.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27087.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27088.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27089 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27090.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27091.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27092
27093When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27094expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27095response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27096values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27097a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27098are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27099(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27100
27101For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27102the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27103variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27104string expansions that also use them for other things.
27105
27106If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27107supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27108data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27109
27110.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27111Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
27112&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27113authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27114to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27115&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27116expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27117generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27118For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27119string as the error text.
27120
27121&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
27122password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
27123There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
27124
27125
27126
27127.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
27128.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
27129.cindex authentication PLAIN
27130.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27131The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
27132sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
27133separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
27134subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
27135
27136The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
27137Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
27138configured as follows:
27139.code
27140fixed_plain:
27141 driver = plaintext
27142 public_name = PLAIN
27143 server_prompts = :
27144 server_condition = \
27145 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27146 server_set_id = $auth2
27147.endd
27148Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27149are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27150password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27151or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27152
27153The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27154the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27155AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27156authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27157.code
27158250-AUTH PLAIN
27159.endd
27160and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27161.code
27162AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27163.endd
27164As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27165data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27166.code
27167AUTH PLAIN
27168.endd
27169to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27170prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27171
27172The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27173when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27174represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27175is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27176second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27177
27178Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27179realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27180authenticating clients it could make sense.
27181
27182A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27183&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27184comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27185this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27186This is an incorrect example:
27187.code
27188server_condition = \
27189 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27190.endd
27191The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27192which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27193incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27194non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27195strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27196the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27197name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27198.code
27199server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27200 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27201.endd
27202In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27203fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27204used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27205always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27206writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27207
27208
27209.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27210.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27211.cindex authentication LOGIN
27212The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27213in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27214user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27215plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27216.code
27217fixed_login:
27218 driver = plaintext
27219 public_name = LOGIN
27220 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27221 server_condition = \
27222 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27223 server_set_id = $auth1
27224.endd
27225Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27226with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27227if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27228strings are used to obtain two data items.
27229
27230Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27231example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27232&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27233strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27234name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27235.code
27236login:
27237 driver = plaintext
27238 public_name = LOGIN
27239 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27240 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27241 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27242 ldapauth{\
27243 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27244 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27245 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27246 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27247.endd
27248We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27249does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27250operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27251&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27252correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27253the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27254uninterpreted string.
27255
27256
27257.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27258A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27259interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27260traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27261Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27262&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27263
27264
27265
27266
27267.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27268.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27269The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27270
27271.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27272If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27273authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27274the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27275usual.
27276
27277.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27278The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27279string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27280string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27281to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27282most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27283with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27284way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27285(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27286so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27287&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27288&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27289
27290&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27291splitting takes priority and happens first.
27292
27293Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27294the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27295there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27296NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27297the string.
27298
27299This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27300authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27301.code
27302fixed_plain:
27303 driver = plaintext
27304 public_name = PLAIN
27305 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27306.endd
27307The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27308command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27309that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27310.code
27311fixed_login:
27312 driver = plaintext
27313 public_name = LOGIN
27314 client_send = : username : mysecret
27315.endd
27316The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27317the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27318prompts.
27319.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27320.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27321
27322
27323
27324
27325. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27326. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27327
27328.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27329.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27330.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27331.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27332.cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
27333The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27334sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27335name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27336string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27337is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27338secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27339available in plain text at either end.
27340
27341
27342.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27343.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27344This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27345authenticator as a server:
27346
27347.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27348.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27349When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27350the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27351obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27352that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27353string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27354fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27355returned to the client.
27356
27357For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27358in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27359deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27360numeric variables for other things.
27361
27362For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27363client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27364user name, authentication fails.
27365.code
27366fixed_cram:
27367 driver = cram_md5
27368 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27369 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27370 server_set_id = $auth1
27371.endd
27372.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27373If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27374name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27375secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27376.code
27377lookup_cram:
27378 driver = cram_md5
27379 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27380 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27381 {$value}fail}
27382 server_set_id = $auth1
27383.endd
27384Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27385because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27386
27387As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27388using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27389lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27390realm, with:
27391.code
27392cyrusless_crammd5:
27393 driver = cram_md5
27394 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27395 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27396 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27397 server_set_id = $auth1
27398.endd
27399
27400.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27401.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27402When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27403
27404
27405
27406.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27407This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27408computing the response to the server's challenge.
27409
27410
27411.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27412This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27413expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27414
27415
27416.vindex "&$host$&"
27417.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27418Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27419to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27420expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27421prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27422authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27423send the message to the current server.
27424
27425A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27426strings, is:
27427.code
27428fixed_cram:
27429 driver = cram_md5
27430 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27431 client_name = ph10
27432 client_secret = secret
27433.endd
27434.ecindex IIDcramauth1
27435.ecindex IIDcramauth2
27436
27437
27438
27439. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27440. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27441
27442.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27443.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27444.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27445.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27446.cindex "Kerberos"
27447The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27448at A L Digital Ltd.
27449
27450The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27451library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27452Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27453including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27454directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27455
27456The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27457the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27458then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27459name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27460
27461Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27462or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27463user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27464by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27465depending on the driver you are using.
27466
27467The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27468be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27469Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27470changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27471layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27472implementation.
27473
27474For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27475may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27476variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27477Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27478With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27479environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27480is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27481the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27482
27483
27484.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27485The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27486(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27487previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27488use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27489confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27490things.
27491
27492
27493.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27494This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27495library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27496SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27497
27498
27499.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27500This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27501default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27502you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27503example:
27504.code
27505sasl:
27506 driver = cyrus_sasl
27507 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27508 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27509 server_set_id = $auth1
27510.endd
27511
27512.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27513This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27514
27515
27516.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27517This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27518
27519
27520For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27521private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27522the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27523PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27524.code
27525sasl_cram_md5:
27526 driver = cyrus_sasl
27527 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27528 server_set_id = $auth1
27529
27530sasl_plain:
27531 driver = cyrus_sasl
27532 public_name = PLAIN
27533 server_set_id = $auth2
27534.endd
27535Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27536not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27537but it is present in many binary distributions.
27538.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27539.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27540
27541
27542
27543
27544. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27545. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27546.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27547.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27548.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27549This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27550Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27551Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27552If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27553to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27554authenticator only. There is only one option:
27555
27556.option server_socket dovecot string unset
27557
27558This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27559authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27560mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27561authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27562.code
27563dovecot_plain:
27564 driver = dovecot
27565 public_name = PLAIN
27566 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27567 server_set_id = $auth1
27568
27569dovecot_ntlm:
27570 driver = dovecot
27571 public_name = NTLM
27572 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27573 server_set_id = $auth1
27574.endd
27575If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27576&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27577option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27578connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27579option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27580who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27581
27582.new
27583The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27584something like:
27585.code
27586conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27587
27588service auth {
27589...
27590#SASL
27591 unix_listener auth-client {
27592 mode = 0660
27593 user = mail
27594 }
27595...
27596}
27597
27598conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27599
27600auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27601.endd
27602.wen
27603
27604.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27605.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27606
27607
27608. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27609. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27610.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27611.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27612.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27613.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27614.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27615.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27616.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27617.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27618.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27619.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27620.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27621.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
27622The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27623library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27624and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27625scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27626made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27627without code changes in Exim.
27628
27629.new
27630The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27631realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27632The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
27633when this happens.
27634
27635
27636.option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
27637This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
27638which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
27639by &%client_username%& option.
27640If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
27641which is the common case.
27642
27643.option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27644See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
27645
27646.option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
27647This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27648the password to be used, in clear.
27649
27650.option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
27651This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27652the account name to be used.
27653.wen
27654
27655.new
27656.option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
27657If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
27658it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
27659The value after expansion should be
27660a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
27661with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
27662Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
27663supplied by the server.
27664.wen
27665
27666
27667
27668.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27669Do not set this true and rely on the properties
27670without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27671
27672Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27673of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27674authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27675ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27676context.
27677
27678This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27679non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27680server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27681
27682.new
27683This is
27684only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27685writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27686When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
27687.wen
27688
27689This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27690this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27691of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27692
27693However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
27694Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27695with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27696
27697
27698.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27699This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27700library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27701Some mechanisms will use this data.
27702
27703
27704.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27705This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27706default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27707you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27708example:
27709.code
27710sasl:
27711 driver = gsasl
27712 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27713 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27714 server_set_id = $auth1
27715.endd
27716
27717
27718.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27719Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27720that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27721the password itself.
27722
27723The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27724In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27725The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27726if available, else the empty string.
27727The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27728else the empty string.
27729
27730A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27731
27732If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27733option to be simply "true".
27734
27735
27736.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27737This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27738Some mechanisms will use this data.
27739
27740
27741.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
27742This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27743.new
27744The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27745when this option is expanded.
27746
27747The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
27748and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
27749a compute cost factor imposed on the client
27750(if it does not cache results, or the server changes
27751either the iteration count or the salt).
27752A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
27753for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
27754.wen
27755
27756.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27757This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27758.new
27759The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
27760when this option is expanded.
27761The value should be a base64-encoded string,
27762of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
27763If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
27764protocol conversation.
27765.wen
27766
27767
27768.new
27769.option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
27770.option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
27771These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
27772to provide stored information related to a password,
27773the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
27774
27775&%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
27776&%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
27777
27778They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
27779When this is so, the macros
27780_OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
27781and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
27782will be defined.
27783
27784The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
27785
27786If set, the results of expansion should for each
27787should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
27788of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
27789&%server_password%& option.
27790If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
27791
27792The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
27793to generate these values.
27794.wen
27795
27796
27797.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27798This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27799Some mechanisms will use this data.
27800
27801
27802.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27803.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27804These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27805They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27806
27807Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27808meanings for these variables:
27809
27810.ilist
27811.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27812&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27813.next
27814.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27815&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27816.next
27817.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27818&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27819.endlist
27820
27821On a per-mechanism basis:
27822
27823.ilist
27824.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27825EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27826the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27827.next
27828.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27829ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27830the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27831.next
27832.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27833GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27834&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27835the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27836.endlist
27837
27838An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27839identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27840email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27841
27842
27843An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27844and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27845.code
27846gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27847 driver = gsasl
27848 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27849 server_realm = imap.example.org
27850 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27851 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27852 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27853 server_condition = yes
27854.endd
27855
27856
27857. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27858. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27859
27860.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27861.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27862.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27863.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27864.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27865The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27866Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27867reliably.
27868
27869.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27870This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27871for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27872identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27873
27874.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27875If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27876&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27877The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27878
27879.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27880This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27881&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27882from the keytab.
27883
27884
27885.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27886Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27887to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27888not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27889
27890The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27891Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27892Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27893role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27894
27895.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27896.ilist
27897.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27898&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27899.next
27900.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27901&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27902authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27903GSS Display Name.
27904.endlist
27905
27906
27907. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27908. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27909
27910.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27911.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27912.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27913.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27914.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27915.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27916.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27917The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27918Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27919which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27920this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27921taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27922server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27923follows:
27924
27925.ilist
27926After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27927authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27928.next
27929The server sends back a challenge.
27930.next
27931The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27932and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27933.endlist
27934
27935Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27936
27937
27938
27939.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27940.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27941The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27942
27943.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27944.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27945This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27946authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27947compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27948&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27949it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27950for other things. For example:
27951.code
27952spa:
27953 driver = spa
27954 public_name = NTLM
27955 server_password = \
27956 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27957.endd
27958If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27959failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27960
27961
27962
27963
27964
27965.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27966.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27967The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27968
27969
27970
27971.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27972This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27973
27974
27975.option client_password spa string&!! unset
27976This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27977
27978
27979.option client_username spa string&!! unset
27980This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27981configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27982&'msn.com'&:
27983.code
27984msn:
27985 driver = spa
27986 public_name = MSN
27987 client_username = msn/msn_username
27988 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27989 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27990.endd
27991.ecindex IIDspaauth1
27992.ecindex IIDspaauth2
27993
27994
27995
27996
27997
27998. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27999. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28000
28001.chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28002.scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28003.scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28004.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28005.cindex "authentication" "X509"
28006.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28007The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28008authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28009The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28010(&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28011It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28012the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28013by the server configuration.
28014
28015The client presents an identity in-clear.
28016It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28017and for clients to only attempt,
28018this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28019
28020One possible use, compatible with the
28021K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28022is for using X509 client certificates.
28023
28024It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28025(see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28026but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28027rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28028client certificates only.
28029
28030The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28031client-certificate authentication is being done.
28032
28033The client must present a certificate,
28034for which it must have been requested via the
28035&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28036(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28037For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28038verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28039
28040.section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28041.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28042The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28043
28044.option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28045.option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28046.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28047These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28048and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28049If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28050failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28051
28052They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
28053
28054.section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
28055.cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28056.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28057 "in &(external)& authenticator"
28058.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28059.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28060
28061When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
28062expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28063response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28064values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
28065an identity for authentication and
28066placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
28067
28068For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
28069the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
28070variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28071string expansions that also use them for other things.
28072
28073.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28074Once an identity has been received,
28075&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28076authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28077to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28078&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28079expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28080generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28081For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28082string as the error text.
28083
28084Example:
28085.code
28086ext_ccert_san_mail:
28087 driver = external
28088 public_name = EXTERNAL
28089
28090 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
28091 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28092 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28093 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
28094 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
28095 server_set_id = $auth1
28096.endd
28097This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28098of your configured trust-anchors
28099(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28100and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
28101
28102&*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
28103The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28104TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28105in this way.
28106
28107
28108.section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
28109.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
28110The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
28111
28112.option client_send external string&!! unset
28113This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
28114identity being asserted.
28115
28116Example:
28117.code
28118ext_ccert:
28119 driver = external
28120 public_name = EXTERNAL
28121
28122 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
28123 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
28124.endd
28125
28126
28127.ecindex IIDexternauth1
28128.ecindex IIDexternauth2
28129
28130
28131
28132
28133
28134. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28135. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28136
28137.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
28138.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
28139.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
28140.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28141.cindex "authentication" "X509"
28142.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28143The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
28144authentication based on client certificates.
28145
28146It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
28147advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
28148It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
28149the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
28150by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
28151the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
28152
28153The client must present a verifiable certificate,
28154for which it must have been requested via the
28155&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28156(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28157
28158If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
28159run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
28160and can authenticate the connection.
28161If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
28162
28163A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
28164
28165
28166.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
28167The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
28168
28169.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
28170.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
28171This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
28172the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
28173If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28174failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28175
28176.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
28177.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
28178As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
28179
28180&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
28181
28182
28183Example:
28184.code
28185tls:
28186 driver = tls
28187 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28188 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28189 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28190 {forany {$auth1} \
28191 {!= {0} \
28192 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28193 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28194 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28195 } } } }}}
28196 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28197.endd
28198This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28199of your configured trust-anchors
28200(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28201and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28202
28203Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28204The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28205TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28206in this way.
28207Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28208
28209. An alternative might use
28210. .code
28211. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28212. .endd
28213. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28214. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28215. This would help for per-device use.
28216.
28217. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28218. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28219
28220.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28221.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28222
28223
28224Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28225the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28226a connect- or helo-ACL.
28227
28228
28229
28230. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28231. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28232
28233.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28234 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28235.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28236.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28237.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28238.cindex "OpenSSL"
28239.cindex "GnuTLS"
28240Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28241Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28242GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28243cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28244order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28245version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28246You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28247level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28248certificates are used.
28249
28250RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28251connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28252server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28253mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28254between them is encrypted.
28255
28256Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28257and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28258certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28259possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28260encryption state.
28261
28262&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28263disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28264in order to get TLS to work.
28265
28266
28267
28268.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28269 "SECID284"
28270.cindex "submissions protocol"
28271.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28272.cindex "smtps protocol"
28273.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28274.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28275.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28276The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28277contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28278allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28279instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28280by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28281
28282The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28283clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28284Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28285
28286This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28287standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28288reassigned for other use.
28289Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28290this port.
28291In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28292not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28293Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28294
28295Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28296global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28297the most common use is expected to be:
28298.code
28299tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28300.endd
28301The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28302via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28303the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28304the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28305an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28306defined elsewhere.
28307
28308There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28309&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28310
28311
28312
28313
28314
28315
28316.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28317.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28318TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28319To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28320.code
28321USE_OPENSSL=yes
28322.endd
28323in Local/Makefile.
28324
28325To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28326.code
28327USE_GNUTLS=yes
28328.endd
28329in Local/Makefile.
28330
28331You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28332include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28333
28334There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28335
28336.ilist
28337The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28338cannot be the path of a directory
28339for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28340(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28341.next
28342The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28343.next
28344.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28345.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28346Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28347separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28348affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28349.next
28350OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28351DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28352RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28353in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28354for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28355to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28356&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28357option).
28358.next
28359The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28360sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28361.next
28362The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28363When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28364(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28365let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28366.next
28367With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28368main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28369.next
28370Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28371This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28372explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28373implementation, then patches are welcome.
28374.endlist
28375
28376
28377.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28378This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28379an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28380but not the chosen filename.
28381By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28382See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28383
28384GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28385to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28386Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28387&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28388of bits requested.
28389The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28390its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28391parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28392that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28393renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28394this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28395place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28396
28397For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28398recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28399If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28400are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28401not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28402
28403Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28404values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28405parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28406If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28407until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28408a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28409
28410The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28411in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28412generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28413
28414To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28415and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28416&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28417renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28418.code
28419# ls
28420[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28421# rm -f new-params
28422# touch new-params
28423# chown exim:exim new-params
28424# chmod 0600 new-params
28425# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28426# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28427[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28428 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28429 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28430# chmod 0400 new-params
28431# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28432.endd
28433If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28434stalling is removed.
28435
28436The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28437Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28438the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28439a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28440and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28441failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28442of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28443which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28444GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28445to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28446limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28447
28448The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28449value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28450&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
284512432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28452
28453In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28454increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28455bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28456procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28457the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28458
28459
28460.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28461.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28462.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28463There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28464suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28465are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28466The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28467DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28468directly to this function call.
28469Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28470&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28471The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28472documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28473
28474.ilist
28475It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28476.next
28477It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28478or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28479ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28480SSL v3 algorithms.
28481.next
28482Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28483the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28484SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28485algorithms.
28486.endlist
28487
28488Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28489&`-`& or &`+`&.
28490.ilist
28491If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28492ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28493stated.
28494.next
28495If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28496of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28497.next
28498If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28499option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28500.endlist
28501
28502If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28503a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28504includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28505not be moved to the end of the list.
28506.endlist
28507
28508The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28509string:
28510.code
28511# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28512$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28513.endd
28514
28515This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28516there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28517submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28518choice of clients used:
28519.code
28520# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28521tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28522 {DEFAULT}\
28523 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28524.endd
28525
28526This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28527.code
28528tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28529.endd
28530
28531For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28532and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28533The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28534TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28535
28536As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28537.code
28538TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28539.endd
28540
28541
28542.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28543 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28544.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28545.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28546.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28547.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28548.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28549.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28550.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28551The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28552as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28553ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28554
28555The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28556and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28557
28558The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28559controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28560&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28561the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28562the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28563aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28564
28565Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28566"Priority strings". This is online as
28567&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28568but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28569installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28570then the example code
28571&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28572on that site can be used to test a given string.
28573
28574For example:
28575.code
28576# Disable older versions of protocols
28577tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28578.endd
28579
28580Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28581additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28582"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28583
28584This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28585there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28586by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28587where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28588used:
28589.code
28590# GnuTLS variant
28591tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28592 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28593 {SECURE128}}
28594.endd
28595
28596
28597.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28598.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28599When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28600the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28601but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28602that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28603this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28604
28605If STARTTLS is to be used you
28606need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28607
28608If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28609problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28610persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28611with the error
28612.code
28613554 Security failure
28614.endd
28615If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28616rejected with a 554 error code.
28617
28618To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28619must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28620
28621If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28622meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28623You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28624from someone able to intercept the communication.
28625
28626Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28627
28628To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28629.code
28630tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28631tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28632.endd
28633These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28634the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28635contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28636that goes with it. These files need to be
28637PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28638always be given as full path names.
28639The key must not be password-protected.
28640They can be the same file if both the
28641certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28642set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28643is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28644certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28645the server's certificate.
28646
28647For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28648colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28649algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28650public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28651client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28652ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28653
28654If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28655source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28656few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28657
28658&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28659they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28660Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28661transport.
28662
28663With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28664require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28665this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28666.code
28667tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28668.endd
28669is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28670with the parameters contained in the file.
28671Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28672available:
28673.code
28674tls_dhparam = none
28675.endd
28676This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28677DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28678used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28679documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28680
28681See the command
28682.code
28683openssl dhparam
28684.endd
28685for a way of generating file data.
28686
28687The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28688host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28689for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28690in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28691forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28692
28693.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28694.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28695.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28696The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28697an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28698incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28699also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28700&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28701condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28702
28703Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28704can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28705cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28706example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28707contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28708documentation for more details.
28709
28710For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28711(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28712
28713
28714.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28715.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28716.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28717If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28718session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28719&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28720apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28721Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28722contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28723expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28724These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28725an explicit file or,
28726depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28727&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28728
28729A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28730directory is used
28731(OpenSSL only),
28732each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28733of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28734certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28735.code
28736openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28737.endd
28738where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28739
28740There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28741Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28742
28743The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28744what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28745does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28746&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28747attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28748dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28749session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28750fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28751example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28752relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28753
28754.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28755When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28756the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28757&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28758
28759.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28760Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28761&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28762&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28763&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28764certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28765
28766
28767.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28768.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28769.cindex "revocation list"
28770.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28771.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28772Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28773certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28774server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28775an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28776of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28777CRL in PEM format.
28778The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28779file from every certificate authority they know of.
28780
28781The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28782Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28783against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28784usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28785private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28786is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28787
28788The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28789comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28790connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28791re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28792
28793The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28794issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28795the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28796negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28797CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28798resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28799starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28800proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28801
28802Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28803or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28804support for OCSP stapling is included.
28805
28806There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28807The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28808an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28809option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28810contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28811
28812Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28813proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28814Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28815contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28816on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28817next connection.
28818
28819When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28820in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28821ignored.
28822
28823For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28824also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28825certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28826of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28827intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28828file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28829
28830Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28831not any of the chain from CA to it.
28832
28833There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28834
28835.code
28836 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28837 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28838 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28839
28840 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28841 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28842 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28843.endd
28844
28845
28846
28847
28848.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28849.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28850.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28851.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28852.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28853The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28854deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28855server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28856within the &(smtp)& transport.
28857
28858It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28859transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28860server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28861this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28862transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28863
28864If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28865to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28866&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28867those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28868set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28869usual way.
28870
28871When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28872the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28873a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28874session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28875&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28876delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28877it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28878STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28879negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28880unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28881unencrypted.
28882
28883The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28884transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28885if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28886&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28887
28888&*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28889for client use (they are usable for server use).
28890As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28891in failed connections.
28892
28893If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28894specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28895These may be
28896the system default set (depending on library version),
28897a file,
28898or (depending on library version) a directory.
28899The client verifies the server's certificate
28900against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28901in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28902Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28903&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28904
28905The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28906certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28907or need not succeed respectively.
28908
28909The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28910checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28911is valid for the certificate.
28912The option defaults to always checking.
28913
28914The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28915&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28916is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28917value is empty.
28918&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28919a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28920value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28921otherwise.
28922
28923The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28924&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28925for OCSP to be relevant.
28926
28927If
28928&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28929list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28930the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28931alternative hosts, if any.
28932
28933 &*Note*&:
28934These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28935is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28936by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28937client.
28938
28939.vindex "&$host$&"
28940.vindex "&$host_address$&"
28941All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28942&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28943which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28944behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28945
28946.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28947.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28948.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28949.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28950Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28951&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28952variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28953that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28954successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28955outgoing connection.
28956
28957
28958
28959.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28960.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28961.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28962.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28963With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28964information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28965extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28966&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28967client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28968within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28969for this session.
28970
28971This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28972which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28973address.
28974
28975With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28976against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28977provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28978be of limited use in that environment.
28979
28980With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28981connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28982choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28983wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28984different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28985
28986The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28987if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28988nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28989only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28990for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28991
28992Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28993received from a client.
28994It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28995
28996If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28997option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28998during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28999
29000.ilist
29001&%tls_certificate%&
29002.next
29003&%tls_crl%&
29004.next
29005&%tls_privatekey%&
29006.next
29007&%tls_verify_certificates%&
29008.next
29009&%tls_ocsp_file%&
29010.endlist
29011
29012Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
29013attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
29014can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
29015arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
29016Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
29017an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
29018when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
29019
29020The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
29021are re-expanded.
29022
29023When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
29024for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
29025enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
29026see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
29027
29028When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
290290.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
29030built, then you have SNI support).
29031
29032
29033
29034.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
29035 "SECTmulmessam"
29036.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
29037.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
29038Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
29039an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
29040one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
29041of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
29042connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
29043to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
29044starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
29045unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
29046
29047An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
29048&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
29049this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
29050shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
29051before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
29052try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
29053if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
29054
29055The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
29056after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
29057just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
29058reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
29059successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
29060SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
29061should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
29062subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
29063and delay other deliveries to that host.
29064
29065To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
29066closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
29067closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
29068information is recorded.
29069
29070There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
29071&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
29072connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
29073
29074
29075
29076
29077.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
29078.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
29079In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
29080certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
29081This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
29082reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
29083
29084The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
29085documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
29086document is currently at
29087.display
29088&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
29089.endd
29090and their FAQ is at
29091.display
29092&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
29093.endd
29094
29095Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
290960-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
29097descriptions.
29098More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
29099published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
29100Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
29101&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
29102
29103
29104.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
29105The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
29106certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
29107sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
29108not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
29109First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
29110certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
29111intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
29112certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
29113The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
29114validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
29115root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
29116install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
29117
29118Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
29119even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
29120server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
29121diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
29122
29123
29124
29125.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
29126.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
29127You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
29128with OpenSSL, like this:
29129. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
29130. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
29131.code
29132openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
29133 -days 9999 -nodes
29134.endd
29135&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
29136delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
29137specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
29138important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
29139that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
29140prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
29141this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
29142
29143. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
29144. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
29145. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
29146. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
29147. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
29148. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
29149. ==== -pdp, 2012
29150NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
29151epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
29152the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
29153the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
29154of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
29155writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
29156progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
29157be a sensible resolution).
29158
29159A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
29160may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
29161encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
29162
29163However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
29164user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
29165certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
29166must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
29167authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
29168signed with that self-signed certificate.
29169
29170For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
29171user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
29172Open-source PKI book, available online at
29173&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
29174.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
29175.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
29176
29177
29178
29179.section DANE "SECDANE"
29180.cindex DANE
29181DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
29182it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
29183operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
29184you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
29185Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
29186certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
29187
29188What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29189that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29190by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29191
29192It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29193fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
29194
29195DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
29196for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
29197client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
29198
29199DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
29200that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
29201to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
29202DNSSEC.
292032) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
292043) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29205
29206There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29207Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29208in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29209If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29210
29211A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29212"Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29213For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29214&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29215
29216The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29217These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29218The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29219(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29220this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29221DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29222well-known one.
29223A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29224attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29225does require careful arrangement.
29226With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29227the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29228DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29229all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29230DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29231
29232Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29233because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29234your certificate.
29235You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29236"MTA-STS", described below.
29237
29238When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29239outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29240connections to you.
29241If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29242technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29243In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29244operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29245Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29246because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29247
29248When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29249and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29250than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29251random serial numbers.
29252The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29253If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29254requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29255CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29256
29257The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29258a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29259
29260For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29261
29262.code
29263 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29264 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29265 | openssl sha512 \
29266 | awk '{print $2}'
29267.endd
29268
29269are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29270
29271An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29272
29273.code
29274 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29275.endd
29276
29277At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29278is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29279
29280
29281For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29282
29283The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29284issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29285Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29286re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29287libraries.
29288This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29289interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29290
29291The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29292be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29293default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29294
29295.code
29296 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29297 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29298 {*}{}}
29299.endd
29300
29301The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29302The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29303found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29304string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29305control the OCSP request.
29306
29307This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29308those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29309
29310
29311For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29312and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29313The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29314DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29315the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29316
29317DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29318
29319A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29320If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29321will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29322be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29323
29324If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29325prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29326back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29327This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29328crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29329which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29330limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29331
29332If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29333.code
29334 hosts_require_tls
29335 tls_verify_hosts
29336 tls_try_verify_hosts
29337 tls_verify_certificates
29338 tls_crl
29339 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29340.endd
29341
29342If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29343verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29344
29345The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29346set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29347
29348If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29349
29350There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29351verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29352in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29353and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29354
29355.cindex DANE reporting
29356An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29357to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29358required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29359&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29360The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29361Section 4.3 of that document.
29362
29363Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29364
29365DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29366selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29367to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29368instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29369time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29370Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29371can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29372MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29373information.
29374
29375The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29376which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29377That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29378
29379The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29380&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29381renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29382records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29383information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29384domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29385incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29386
29387
29388
29389. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29390. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29391
29392.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29393.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29394.cindex "control of incoming mail"
29395.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29396.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29397Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29398configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29399name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29400one very small ACL:
29401.code
29402begin acl
29403small_acl:
29404 accept hosts = one.host.only
29405.endd
29406You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29407which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29408
29409The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29410certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29411when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29412option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29413in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29414local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29415a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29416&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29417
29418
29419.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29420The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29421configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29422
29423
29424.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29425.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29426In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29427options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29428.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29429.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29430.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29431.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29432.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29433.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29434.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29435.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29436.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29437.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29438.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29439.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29440.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29441.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29442.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29443.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29444
29445.table2 140pt
29446.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29447.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29448.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29449.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29450.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29451.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29452.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29453.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29454.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29455.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29456.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29457.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29458.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29459.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29460.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29461.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29462.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29463.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29464.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29465.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29466.endtable
29467
29468For example, if you set
29469.code
29470acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29471.endd
29472the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29473in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29474done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29475sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29476command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29477trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29478testing as possible at RCPT time.
29479
29480
29481.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29482.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29483The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29484apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29485really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29486the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29487relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29488are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29489&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29490&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29491in any of these ACLs.
29492
29493The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29494non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29495analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29496batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29497result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29498really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29499on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29500controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29501.code
29502control = suppress_local_fixups
29503.endd
29504This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29505run, it is too late.
29506
29507The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29508content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29509
29510The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29511kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29512temporary error for these kinds of message.
29513
29514
29515.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29516.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29517.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29518The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29519session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29520an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29521accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29522the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29523&%smtp_banner%& option.
29524
29525
29526.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29527.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29528.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29529The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29530EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29531&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29532Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29533session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29534setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29535
29536Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29537mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29538&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29539
29540If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29541modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29542at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29543affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29544an EHLO response.
29545
29546
29547.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29548.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29549Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29550command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29551When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29552is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29553the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29554response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29555added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29556are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29557
29558You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29559in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29560tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29561received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29562the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29563associated with the DATA command.
29564
29565.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29566.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29567.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29568If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29569the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29570. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29571The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29572the data specified is received.
29573
29574For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29575error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29576MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29577before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29578and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29579your resources.
29580
29581The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29582the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29583the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29584and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29585
29586.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29587The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29588enabled (which is the default).
29589
29590The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29591received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29592otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29593
29594This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29595
29596For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29597
29598
29599.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29600The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29601content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29602
29603This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29604
29605
29606.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29607.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29608.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29609The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29610with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29611It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29612client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29613has been accepted.
29614
29615The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29616has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29617with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29618The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29619The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29620can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29621for some or all recipients.
29622
29623PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29624one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29625content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29626.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29627for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29628is &"yes"&.
29629Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29630ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29631will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29632
29633See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29634and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29635
29636This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29637If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29638the feature was not requested by the client.
29639
29640.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29641.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29642The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29643does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29644does not in fact control any access.
29645For this reason, it may only accept
29646or warn as its final result.
29647
29648This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29649session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29650messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29651more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29652
29653&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29654the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29655
29656You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29657&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29658response to QUIT.
29659
29660This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29661failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29662because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29663client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29664connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29665
29666
29667.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29668.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29669The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29670an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29671trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29672because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29673situation even worse.
29674
29675Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29676logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29677modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29678and &%warn%&.
29679
29680.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29681When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29682to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29683connection. The possible values are:
29684.table2
29685.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29686.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29687.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29688.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29689.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29690.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29691.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29692.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29693.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29694.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29695.endtable
29696In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29697Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29698With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29699overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29700&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29701used.
29702
29703
29704.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29705.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29706The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29707you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29708.code
29709acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29710 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29711.endd
29712In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29713providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29714an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29715expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29716more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29717
29718The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29719configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29720string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29721
29722.ilist
29723If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29724contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29725Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29726lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29727If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29728causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29729.code
29730acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29731 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29732 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29733.endd
29734This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29735back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29736file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29737can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29738.next
29739If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29740Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29741matches the string.
29742.next
29743If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29744the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29745want to have something like
29746.code
29747acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29748.endd
29749in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29750newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29751.endlist
29752
29753
29754
29755
29756.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29757.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29758Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29759section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29760&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29761database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29762return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29763&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29764This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29765
29766For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29767&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29768submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29769
29770
29771ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29772has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29773individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29774blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29775
29776If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29777ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29778RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29779recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29780run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29781remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29782&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29783
29784If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29785is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29786
29787
29788.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29789The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29790recipients; it may create new recipients.
29791
29792
29793
29794.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29795.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29796The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29797all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29798not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29799reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29800
29801For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29802these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29803used to accept or reject anything.
29804
29805For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29806&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29807&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29808when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29809
29810For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29811&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29812This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29813messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29814configuration file.
29815
29816
29817
29818
29819.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29820.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29821.vindex &$domain$&
29822.vindex &$local_part$&
29823.vindex &$sender_address$&
29824.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29825.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29826When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29827that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29828&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29829statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29830&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29831is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29832
29833When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29834contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29835set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29836how it is used.
29837
29838.vindex "&$message_size$&"
29839The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29840the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29841that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29842the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29843received).
29844
29845.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29846.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29847The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29848The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29849accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29850of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29851&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29852&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29853
29854
29855
29856
29857
29858.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29859.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29860.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29861.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29862When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29863the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29864and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29865These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29866here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29867encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29868does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29869unencrypted connections.
29870.code
29871acl_check_auth:
29872 accept encrypted = *
29873 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29874 {CRAM-MD5}}
29875 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29876.endd
29877(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29878that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29879encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29880option to do this.)
29881
29882
29883
29884.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29885.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29886.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29887An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29888with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29889Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29890set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29891
29892If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29893used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29894provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29895example:
29896.code
29897deny dnslists = list1.example
29898 dnslists = list2.example
29899.endd
29900If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29901the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29902happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29903all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29904test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29905
29906
29907.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29908The ACL verbs are as follows:
29909
29910.ilist
29911.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29912&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29913of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29914appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29915is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29916after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29917check a RCPT command:
29918.code
29919accept domains = +local_domains
29920 endpass
29921 verify = recipient
29922.endd
29923If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29924passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29925the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29926fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29927&%endpass%&.
29928
29929The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29930use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29931that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29932configuration.
29933
29934.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29935If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29936depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29937(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29938statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29939SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29940.display
29941&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29942&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29943.endd
29944You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29945response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29946same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29947
29948If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29949an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29950for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29951of &%endpass%&.
29952
29953
29954.next
29955.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29956&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29957an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29958&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29959temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29960&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29961be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29962
29963
29964.next
29965.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29966&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29967the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29968example,
29969.code
29970deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29971.endd
29972rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29973
29974
29975.next
29976.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29977&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29978&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29979that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29980the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29981recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29982recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29983message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29984do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29985
29986If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29987its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29988The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29989
29990
29991.next
29992.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29993&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29994forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29995.code
29996drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29997 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29998.endd
29999There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
30000The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
30001
30002.next
30003.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
30004&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
30005statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
30006example, when checking a RCPT command,
30007.code
30008require message = Sender did not verify
30009 verify = sender
30010.endd
30011passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
30012verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
30013&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
30014discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
30015
30016.next
30017.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30018&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
30019&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
30020to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
30021written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
30022message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
30023duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
30024
30025If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
30026and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
30027&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
30028first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
30029&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30030
30031If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
30032some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
30033This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
30034is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
30035conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
30036is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
30037onwards.
30038
30039
30040.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30041When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
30042text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
30043want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
30044.code
30045warn !verify = sender
30046 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
30047.endd
30048.endlist
30049
30050At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
30051
30052As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
30053written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
30054subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
30055continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
30056mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
30057
30058
30059
30060.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
30061.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
30062There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
30063can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
30064of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
30065transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
30066variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
30067an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
30068alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
30069the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
30070.ilist
30071The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
30072throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
30073while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
30074on the same SMTP connection.
30075.next
30076The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
30077while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
30078reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
30079.endlist
30080
30081When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
30082preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
30083time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
30084.code
30085accept hosts = whatever
30086 set acl_m4 = some value
30087accept authenticated = *
30088 set acl_c_auth = yes
30089.endd
30090&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
30091be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
30092&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
30093
30094.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
30095What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
30096referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
30097false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
30098error is generated.
30099
30100Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
30101their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
30102
30103
30104.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
30105.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
30106.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
30107An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
30108.code
30109deny domains = *.dom.example
30110 !verify = recipient
30111.endd
30112causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
30113&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
30114negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
30115two statements are equivalent:
30116.code
30117deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
30118deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
30119.endd
30120However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
30121side negation of the whole condition is possible.
30122
30123The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
30124of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
30125condition is true. Consider these two statements:
30126.code
30127accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30128 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
30129accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30130 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
30131.endd
30132Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
30133the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
30134different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
30135condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
30136therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
30137the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
30138and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
30139
30140ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
30141specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
30142others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
30143warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
30144message is handled.
30145
30146The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
30147processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
30148modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
30149consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
30150.code
30151require message = Can't verify sender
30152 verify = sender
30153 message = Can't verify recipient
30154 verify = recipient
30155 message = This message cannot be used
30156.endd
30157If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
30158&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
30159so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
30160recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
30161verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
30162because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
30163
30164For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
30165modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
30166happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
30167the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
30168.code
30169deny hosts = ...
30170 !senders = *@my.domain.example
30171 message = Invalid sender from client host
30172.endd
30173The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
30174by which time Exim has set up the message.
30175
30176
30177
30178.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
30179.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
30180The ACL modifiers are as follows:
30181
30182.vlist
30183.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30184This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
30185incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
30186accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30187
30188.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30189.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30190.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30191This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30192continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
30193the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
30194update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
30195write rather ugly lines like this:
30196.display
30197&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
30198.endd
30199Instead, all you need is
30200.display
30201&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
30202.endd
30203
30204.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30205.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30206This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30207incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30208lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30209lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30210controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30211even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30212
30213As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30214separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30215in several different ways. For example:
30216
30217. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30218. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30219. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30220. ==== way.
30221
30222.ilist
30223It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30224.code
30225 accept ...some conditions
30226 control = queue
30227.endd
30228In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30229other words, when the conditions are all true.
30230
30231.next
30232It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30233.code
30234 accept ...some conditions...
30235 control = queue
30236 ...some more conditions...
30237.endd
30238If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30239statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30240In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30241to be relevant.
30242
30243.next
30244It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30245decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30246example:
30247.code
30248 warn ...some conditions...
30249 control = freeze
30250 accept ...
30251.endd
30252This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30253&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30254log entry.
30255
30256.next
30257If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30258&%require%& verb. For example:
30259.code
30260 require control = no_multiline_responses
30261.endd
30262.endlist
30263
30264.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30265.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30266.oindex "&%-bh%&"
30267This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30268the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30269&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30270output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30271happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30272output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30273
30274Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30275example:
30276.code
30277deny ...some conditions...
30278 delay = 30s
30279.endd
30280The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30281&"deny"&. Compare this with:
30282.code
30283deny delay = 30s
30284 ...some conditions...
30285.endd
30286which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30287can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30288.code
30289warn ...some conditions...
30290 delay = 2m
30291 control = freeze
30292accept ...
30293.endd
30294
30295If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30296responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30297they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30298delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30299appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30300unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30301using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30302
30303
30304.vitem &*endpass*&
30305.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30306This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30307&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30308failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30309failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30310confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30311&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30312
30313
30314.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30315.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30316This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30317ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30318.code
30319require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30320 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30321.endd
30322&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30323example:
30324.display
30325&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30326&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30327.endd
30328When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30329that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30330recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30331message.
30332
30333The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30334the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30335denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30336available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30337variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30338&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30339ignored.
30340
30341.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30342If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30343verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30344error message.
30345
30346If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30347the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30348more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30349actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30350of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30351is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30352
30353If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30354example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30355the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30356logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30357both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30358logging rejections.
30359
30360
30361.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30362.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30363.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30364This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30365about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30366be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30367may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30368ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30369.display
30370&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30371&` log_reject_target =`&
30372.endd
30373This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30374permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30375current ACL.
30376
30377
30378.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30379.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30380.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30381This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30382processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30383&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30384access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30385ACLs. For example:
30386.display
30387&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30388&` control = freeze`&
30389&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30390.endd
30391By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30392with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30393another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30394example:
30395.code
30396logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30397logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30398.endd
30399
30400
30401.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30402.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30403This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30404message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30405or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30406there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30407&%accept%& for details.)
30408
30409The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30410to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30411generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30412&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30413the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30414.code
30415require message = Host not recognized
30416 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30417.endd
30418(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30419processed.)
30420
30421.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30422.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30423For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30424of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30425is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30426is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30427overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30428accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30429truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30430EHLO options.
30431
30432When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30433consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30434of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30435.code
30436deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30437 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30438.endd
30439The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30440by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30441access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
304422&'xx'&.
30443
30444Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30445the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30446
30447The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30448literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30449anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30450response.
30451
30452.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30453For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30454stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30455
30456If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30457specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30458However, the original message is available in the variable
30459&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30460wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30461routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30462use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30463
30464For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30465is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30466modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30467all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30468&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30469&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30470effect.
30471
30472
30473.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30474.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30475.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30476This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30477for the message.
30478It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30479the DATA ACL).
30480This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30481of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30482Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30483If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30484
30485
30486.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30487This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30488 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30489the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30490
30491
30492.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30493.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30494This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30495&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30496
30497
30498.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30499.cindex "UDP communications"
30500This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30501collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30502the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30503of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30504server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30505separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30506example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30507when:
30508.code
30509udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30510 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30511.endd
30512.endlist
30513
30514
30515
30516
30517.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30518.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30519The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30520
30521.vlist
30522.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30523This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30524has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30525apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30526HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30527really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30528not work without it. For example:
30529.code
30530warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30531 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30532.endd
30533Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30534the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30535matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30536mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30537by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30538
30539
30540.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30541 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30542.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30543.cindex "case of local parts"
30544.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30545These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30546(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30547are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30548any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30549for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30550is encountered.
30551
30552These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30553local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30554in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30555handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30556configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30557
30558This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30559containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30560spam score:
30561.code
30562warn control = caseful_local_part
30563 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30564 $acl_m4 + \
30565 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30566 }
30567 control = caselower_local_part
30568.endd
30569Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30570is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30571
30572
30573.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30574.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30575.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30576This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30577
30578The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30579If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30580and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30581is used for all recipients of the message,
30582then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30583and data is copied from one to the other.
30584
30585An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30586for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30587If a recipient-verify callout
30588(with use_sender)
30589connection is subsequently
30590requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30591any subsequent recipients and the data,
30592otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30593
30594Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30595and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30596Note also that headers cannot be
30597modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30598Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30599The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30600rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30601this will affect the timestamp.
30602
30603All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30604rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30605the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30606Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30607message body.
30608
30609Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30610of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30611before the entire message has been received from the source.
30612It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30613or CHUNKING
30614options in use.
30615
30616Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30617a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30618If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30619the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30620before the acceptance "<=" line.
30621
30622If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30623usual fashion.
30624This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30625to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30626&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30627and does not queue the message.
30628Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30629
30630Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30631(possibly faked)
30632sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30633
30634
30635.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30636.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30637.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30638This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30639with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30640by default called &'debuglog'&.
30641The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30642may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30643the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30644option.
30645Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30646with the &'kill'& option.
30647Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30648contexts):
30649.code
30650 control = debug
30651 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30652 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30653 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30654 control = debug/kill
30655.endd
30656
30657
30658.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30659.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30660.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30661This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30662the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30663
30664
30665.vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
30666.cindex "disable DMARC verify"
30667.cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
30668This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
30669the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
30670
30671
30672.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30673.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30674.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30675This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30676connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30677strings or to numeric value.
30678The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30679Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30680&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30681
30682The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30683(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30684that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30685equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30686Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30687
30688
30689.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30690 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30691.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30692.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30693These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30694is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30695state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30696in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30697
30698The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30699connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30700messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30701&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30702before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30703synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30704work with.
30705
30706
30707.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30708.cindex "fake defer"
30709.cindex "defer, fake"
30710This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30711except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30712550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30713messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30714use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30715
30716.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30717.cindex "fake rejection"
30718.cindex "rejection, fake"
30719This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30720words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30721message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30722However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30723only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30724the same SMTP connection.
30725
30726The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30727message is supplied, the following is used:
30728.code
30729550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30730550-kept for evaluation.
30731550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30732550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30733.endd
30734This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30735
30736.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30737.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30738This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30739other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30740it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30741current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30742SMTP connection.
30743
30744This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30745&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30746is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30747are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30748
30749.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30750.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30751Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30752avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30753use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30754disables such output flushing.
30755
30756.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30757.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30758Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30759avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30760use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30761that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30762
30763.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30764This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30765extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30766of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30767or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30768needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30769only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30770the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30771to be useful in production.
30772
30773.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30774.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30775This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30776It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30777SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30778
30779If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30780suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30781one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30782(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30783responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30784sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30785
30786.ilist
30787Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30788sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30789verification failed"&) is sent.
30790.next
30791If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30792line is output.
30793.endlist
30794
30795The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30796calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30797
30798.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30799.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30800This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30801the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30802response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30803controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30804&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30805
30806.new
30807.vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
30808 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30809.oindex "&%queue%&"
30810.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30811.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30812.cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
30813.cindex "first pass routing"
30814This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30815other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30816it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30817runner.
30818If used with no options set,
30819no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30820effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
30821
30822If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
30823the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
30824a delivery process is started which stops short of making
30825any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
30826the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
30827able to send all such messages on a single connection.
30828
30829The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
30830 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30831.wen
30832
30833.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30834.cindex "message" "submission"
30835.cindex "submission mode"
30836This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30837latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30838the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30839operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30840necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30841This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30842late (the message has already been created).
30843
30844Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30845messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30846submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30847The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30848that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30849
30850.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30851.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30852This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30853complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30854normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30855
30856.ilist
30857Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30858dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30859.next
30860No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30861.next
30862There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30863.endlist ilist
30864
30865This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30866passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30867used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30868and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30869data is read.
30870
30871&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30872that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30873
30874.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30875This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30876to a-label form.
30877For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30878.endlist vlist
30879
30880
30881.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30882All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30883
30884.ilist
30885Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30886.next
30887Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30888&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30889.next
30890Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30891.next
30892Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30893.endlist
30894
30895
30896
30897.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30898.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30899.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30900.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30901The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30902to an incoming message, as in this example:
30903.code
30904warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30905 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30906 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30907.endd
30908The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30909MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30910receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30911&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30912any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30913RCPT ACL).
30914
30915Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30916DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30917
30918Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30919the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30920contains one or more newlines that
30921are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30922lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30923front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30924
30925Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30926They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30927However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30928is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30929during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30930with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30931lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30932In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30933non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30934message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30935are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30936
30937.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30938Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30939of message headers
30940until they are added to the
30941message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30942ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30943header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30944ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30945passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30946this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30947&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30948
30949The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30950
30951The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30952processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30953.display
30954&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30955&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30956
30957&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30958&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30959.endd
30960In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30961condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30962condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30963ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30964honoured.
30965
30966.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30967For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30968&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30969effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30970them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30971usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30972are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30973specifications.
30974
30975By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30976header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30977be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30978after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30979that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30980
30981This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30982&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30983header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30984to be a header name first.) For example:
30985.code
30986warn add_header = \
30987 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30988.endd
30989If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30990each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30991you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30992up in reverse order.
30993
30994&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30995added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30996system filter or in a router or transport.
30997
30998
30999
31000.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
31001.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
31002.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
31003.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
31004The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
31005from an incoming message, as in this example:
31006.code
31007warn message = Remove internal headers
31008 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31009.endd
31010The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31011MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31012receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31013&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
31014with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
31015any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
31016
31017Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
31018DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31019
31020More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
31021list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
31022not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
31023create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
31024are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
31025.code
31026warn hosts = +internal_hosts
31027 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31028warn message = Remove internal headers
31029 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
31030.endd
31031Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31032Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31033If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
31034There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
31035a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
31036during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
31037if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
31038accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
31039all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
31040ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
31041would have been removed.
31042
31043.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
31044Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
31045is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
31046not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
31047removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
31048this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
31049passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
31050you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
31051&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31052
31053The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31054processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31055.display
31056&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
31057&` `&<&'some condition'&>
31058
31059&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31060&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
31061.endd
31062In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
31063condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
31064condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
31065same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
31066are honoured.
31067
31068&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31069present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
31070in a system filter or in a router or transport.
31071
31072
31073
31074
31075.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
31076.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
31077Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
31078compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
31079for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
31080content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31081
31082Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
31083senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
31084result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
31085done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
31086can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
31087same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
31088The conditions are as follows:
31089
31090
31091.vlist
31092.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
31093.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
31094.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
31095.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
31096.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
31097The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
31098&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
31099&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
31100false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
31101condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
31102condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
31103ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
31104
31105If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
31106can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
31107and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
31108Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
31109The name and values are expanded separately.
31110Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
31111will act as argument separators.
31112
31113If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
31114the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
31115&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
31116conditions are tested.
31117
31118ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
31119loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
31120circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
31121for different local users or different local domains.
31122
31123.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31124.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
31125.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
31126.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
31127If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
31128the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
31129authentication by any authenticator, you can set
31130.code
31131authenticated = *
31132.endd
31133
31134.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
31135.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
31136.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
31137.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
31138.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
31139This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
31140expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
31141&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
31142number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
31143any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
31144&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
31145ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
31146negative.
31147
31148.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
31149.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
31150This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31151content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31152&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
31153If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
31154problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
31155chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31156
31157.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
31158.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
31159.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31160.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31161.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31162This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
31163&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
31164use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
31165different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
31166&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
31167
31168.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31169.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
31170.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
31171.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
31172.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
31173This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
31174of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
31175enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
31176lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
31177&%domains%& test.
31178
31179&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
31180use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
31181
31182
31183.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31184.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
31185.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
31186.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
31187If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
31188name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
31189encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
31190.code
31191encrypted = *
31192.endd
31193
31194
31195.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
31196.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
31197.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
31198.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
31199This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
31200name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
31201you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
31202.code
31203accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31204.endd
31205The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
31206the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
31207and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
31208
31209The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
31210Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
31211but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
31212find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
31213opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
31214found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
31215
31216If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
31217address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
31218.code
31219accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31220accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31221.endd
31222The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31223is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31224statement can then check the IP address.
31225
31226.vindex "&$host_data$&"
31227If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31228of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31229allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31230.code
31231deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31232message = $host_data
31233.endd
31234which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31235
31236.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31237.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31238.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31239.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31240.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31241This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31242part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31243enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31244result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31245the next &%local_parts%& test.
31246
31247.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31248.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31249.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31250.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31251This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31252content-scanning extension
31253and only after a DATA command.
31254It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31255viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31256
31257.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31258.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31259.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31260This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31261content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31262&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31263with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31264&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31265
31266.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31267.cindex "rate limiting"
31268This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31269messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31270
31271.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31272.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31273.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31274.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31275This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31276recipient address against a list of recipients.
31277
31278.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31279.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31280.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31281This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31282content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31283non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31284any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31285
31286.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31287.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31288.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31289.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31290.vindex "&$domain$&"
31291.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31292This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31293domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31294&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31295of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31296lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31297RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31298influence the sender checking.
31299
31300&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31301relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31302
31303.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31304.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31305.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31306.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31307This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31308for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31309.code
31310senders = :
31311.endd
31312&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31313relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31314
31315.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31316.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31317.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31318This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31319content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31320SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31321
31322.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31323.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31324.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31325.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31326.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31327.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31328This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31329certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31330server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31331or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31332
31333.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31334.cindex "CSA verification"
31335This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31336send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31337&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31338
31339.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31340.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31341.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31342.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31343.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31344This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31345received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31346&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31347there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31348allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31349
31350Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31351problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31352detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31353
31354.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31355.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31356.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31357.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31358.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31359.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31360This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31361received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31362&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31363of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31364is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31365However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31366that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31367to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31368might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31369
31370Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31371section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31372&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31373condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31374.code
31375deny senders = :
31376 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31377 !verify = header_sender
31378.endd
31379
31380.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31381.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31382.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31383.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31384.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31385This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31386received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31387&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31388lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31389and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31390Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31391permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31392&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31393appropriate.
31394
31395Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31396ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31397.code
31398To: @
31399.endd
31400and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31401common as they used to be.
31402
31403.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31404.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31405.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31406.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31407.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31408.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31409.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31410This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31411client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31412attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31413condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31414&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31415independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31416
31417For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31418option), this condition is always true.
31419
31420
31421.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31422.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31423.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31424This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31425Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31426&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31427case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31428&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31429used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31430
31431There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31432local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31433
31434There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31435recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31436
31437
31438.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31439.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31440.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31441.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31442.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31443.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31444This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31445recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31446&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31447of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31448This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31449verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31450address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31451value for the child address.
31452
31453.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31454.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31455.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31456.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31457This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31458address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31459was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31460Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31461one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31462original IP address.
31463
31464There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31465DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31466
31467If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31468is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31469
31470.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31471.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31472.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31473.cindex "sender" "verifying"
31474.cindex "verifying" "sender"
31475This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31476message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31477the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31478condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31479
31480.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31481.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31482If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31483value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31484value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31485statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31486want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31487
31488Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31489&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31490to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31491
31492.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31493.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31494This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31495verified as a sender.
31496
31497Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31498(eg. is generated from the received message)
31499they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31500.code
31501verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31502.endd
31503.endlist
31504
31505
31506
31507.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31508.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31509.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31510.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31511In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31512is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31513address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31514domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31515special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31516address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31517.code
31518deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31519 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31520.endd
31521the following records are looked up:
31522.code
3152343.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3152443.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31525.endd
31526As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31527Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31528to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31529use two separate conditions:
31530.code
31531deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31532 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31533.endd
31534If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31535behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31536record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31537processed.
31538
31539This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31540(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31541blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31542following special items in the list:
31543.display
31544&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31545&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31546&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31547.endd
31548.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31549.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31550.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31551Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31552.code
31553deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31554.endd
31555Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31556warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31557.code
31558deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31559warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31560 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31561.endd
31562.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31563.cindex DNS TTL
31564DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31565(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31566so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31567connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31568Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31569connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31570
31571There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31572or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31573&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31574
31575
31576
31577.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31578.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31579By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31580of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31581after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31582.code
31583deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31584.endd
31585This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31586use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31587MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31588&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31589
31590
31591
31592
31593.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31594.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31595There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31596addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31597&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31598with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31599listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31600.code
31601deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31602 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31603.endd
31604This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31605RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31606example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31607up by this example is
31608.code
31609tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31610.endd
31611A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31612addresses. For example:
31613.code
31614deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31615 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31616.endd
31617The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31618name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31619
31620
31621
31622
31623.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31624.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31625The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31626names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31627name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31628As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31629this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31630either to double the separators like this:
31631.code
31632dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31633.endd
31634or to change the separator character, like this:
31635.code
31636dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31637.endd
31638If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31639blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31640occurs. Consider this condition:
31641.code
31642dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31643.endd
31644The DNS lookups that occur are:
31645.code
316462.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31647a.domain.black.list.tld
31648.endd
31649Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31650address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31651are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31652or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31653only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31654successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31655error for a previous item.
31656
31657The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31658syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31659.code
31660dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31661dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31662.endd
31663However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31664is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31665.code
31666deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31667 $sender_address_domain \
31668 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31669 see $dnslist_text.
31670 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31671 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31672 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31673.endd
31674Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31675multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31676and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31677of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31678.code
31679dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31680.endd
31681Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31682domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31683
31684The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31685&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31686
31687
31688
31689
31690.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31691.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31692DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31693just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31694RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31695The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31696.display
31697127.1.0.1 RBL
31698127.1.0.2 DUL
31699127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31700127.1.0.4 RSS
31701127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31702127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31703127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31704.endd
31705Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31706different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31707see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31708
31709
31710.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31711.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31712.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31713.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31714.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31715.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31716.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31717When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31718the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31719&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31720(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31721the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31722&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31723cases, for example:
31724.code
31725deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31726.endd
31727the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31728&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31729For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31730might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31731.code
31732deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31733.endd
31734If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31735&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31736
31737If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31738addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31739The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31740record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31741very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31742information.
31743
31744You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31745&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31746expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31747.code
31748deny hosts = !+local_networks
31749 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31750 at $dnslist_domain
31751 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31752.endd
31753
31754
31755
31756.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31757.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31758You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31759in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31760For example,
31761.code
31762deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31763.endd
31764rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31765any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31766that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31767describes how multiple records are handled.
31768
31769More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31770separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31771&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31772.code
31773deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31774.endd
31775If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31776addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31777first. For example:
31778.code
31779deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31780 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31781.endd
31782
31783If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31784listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31785In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31786true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31787tested. For example:
31788.code
31789dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31790.endd
31791matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31792want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31793being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31794.code
31795dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31796.endd
31797matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31798an odd number.
31799
31800
31801
31802.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31803You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31804condition. Whereas
31805.code
31806deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31807.endd
31808means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31809IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31810.code
31811deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31812.endd
31813means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31814IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31815words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31816the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31817
31818&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31819host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31820
31821If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31822previous example is precisely equivalent to
31823.code
31824deny dnslists = a.b.c
31825 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31826.endd
31827However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31828Consider this example:
31829.code
31830deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31831 list.dsbl.org : \
31832 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31833 relays.ordb.org
31834.endd
31835Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31836.code
31837deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31838 list.dsbl.org
31839deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31840 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31841deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31842.endd
31843which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31844
31845
31846
31847
31848.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31849A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31850thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31851is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31852the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31853the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31854.code
31855dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31856.endd
31857What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31858127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31859condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31860because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31861affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31862additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31863
31864.ilist
31865If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31866IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31867condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31868.next
31869If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31870looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31871changed to:
31872.code
31873dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31874.endd
31875and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31876false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31877.code
31878dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31879.endd
31880for the condition to be true.
31881.endlist
31882
31883When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31884the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31885.ilist
31886If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31887addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31888.code
31889dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31890.endd
31891If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31892false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31893.next
31894If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31895looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31896.code
31897dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31898.endd
31899If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31900true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31901.code
31902dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31903.endd
31904for the condition to be false.
31905.endlist
31906When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31907between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31908
31909
31910
31911
31912.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31913.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31914When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31915the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31916the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31917address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31918only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31919can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31920in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31921lists.
31922
31923A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31924two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31925do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31926If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31927restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31928a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31929domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31930.code
31931deny message = \
31932 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31933 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31934 dnslists = \
31935 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31936 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31937.endd
31938For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31939&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31940match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31941value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31942record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31943The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31944
31945If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31946given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31947the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31948.code
31949deny dnslists = \
31950 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31951 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31952 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31953 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31954.endd
31955In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31956values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31957done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31958
31959
31960
31961.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31962.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31963.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31964If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31965nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
319663ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31967.code
319681.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31969 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31970.endd
31971(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31972lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31973IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31974.code
31975*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31976.endd
31977is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31978Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31979
31980You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31981&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31982.code
31983deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31984 dnslists = some.list.example
31985.endd
31986
31987If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31988address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31989(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31990.code
31991 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31992.endd
31993
31994.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31995.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31996.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31997.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31998The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31999which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
32000&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
32001commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
32002works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
32003host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
32004.display
32005&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
32006.endd
32007If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
32008period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
32009
32010As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
32011&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
32012configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
32013of &'p'&.
32014
32015The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
32016time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
32017means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
32018parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
32019send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
32020in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
32021constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
32022changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
32023both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
32024
32025There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
32026log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
32027when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
32028instructions when it is run with no arguments.
32029
32030The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
32031sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
32032retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
32033which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
32034By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
32035of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
32036user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
32037&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
32038example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
32039authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
32040
32041The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
32042rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
32043&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
32044ACL.
32045
32046Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
32047specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
32048or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
32049&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
32050using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
32051separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
32052
32053Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
32054any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
32055stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
32056remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
32057remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
32058behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
32059the &%count=%& option.
32060
32061
32062.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
32063.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
32064The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
32065normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
32066&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
32067
32068The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
32069the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
32070&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
32071&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32072
32073The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
32074the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
32075in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
32076used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
32077in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
32078follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
32079in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
32080
32081The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
32082accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32083&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
32084&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
32085ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
32086in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
32087recipients as a large high-speed burst.
32088
32089The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
32090number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
32091last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
32092recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
32093&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
32094
32095The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
32096condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
32097command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
32098multiple different commands.
32099
32100The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
32101measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
32102&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
32103increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
32104other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
32105
32106The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
32107
32108
32109.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
32110.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
32111You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
32112control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
32113mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
32114
32115If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
32116previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
32117
32118For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
32119it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
32120can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
32121in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
32122new rate.
32123.code
32124acl_check_connect:
32125 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
32126 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32127 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32128# ...
32129acl_check_mail:
32130 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
32131 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32132 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32133.endd
32134
32135If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
32136processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
32137it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
32138in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
32139same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
32140multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
32141checks.
32142
32143The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
32144use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
32145update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
32146&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
32147next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
32148
32149
32150.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
32151.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
32152If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
32153engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
32154&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
32155counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
32156rest of the ACL.
32157
32158The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
32159updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
32160client's average rate of successfully sent email,
32161up to the given limit.
32162This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
32163consists of refusing the message, and
32164is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
32165If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
32166likely not what is wanted.
32167
32168The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
32169updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
32170of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
32171actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
32172counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
32173pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
32174again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
32175attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
32176.code
32177 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
32178.endd
32179
32180
32181.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
32182.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
32183The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
32184rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
32185mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
32186sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
32187&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
32188measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
32189options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
32190
32191For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
32192has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
32193rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
32194per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
32195go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
32196recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
32197
32198When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
32199&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
32200rate.
32201
32202The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
32203other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
32204unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
32205required increases with larger limits.
32206
32207The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
32208will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
32209the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
32210the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
32211events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
32212times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
32213throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
32214limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
32215are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
32216as intended.
32217
32218
32219.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
32220Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32221when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32222(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32223policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32224message. For example:
32225.code
32226# Log all senders' rates
32227warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32228 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32229
32230# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32231# at the decimal point.
32232warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32233 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32234 $sender_rate_limit }s
32235
32236# Keep authenticated users under control
32237deny authenticated = *
32238 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32239
32240# System-wide rate limit
32241defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32242 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32243
32244# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32245# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32246defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32247 messages per $sender_rate_period
32248 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32249 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32250 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32251.endd
32252&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32253especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32254bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32255making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32256RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32257this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32258hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32259
32260
32261
32262.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32263.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32264.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32265Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32266&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32267&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32268The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32269verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32270other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32271.code
32272verify = sender/callout
32273verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32274.endd
32275The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32276address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32277difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32278be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32279(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32280The available options are as follows:
32281
32282.ilist
32283If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32284remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32285check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32286.next
32287If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32288normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32289options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32290verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32291.next
32292The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32293discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32294.next
32295The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32296immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32297generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32298discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32299.endlist
32300
32301.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32302.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32303.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32304.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32305After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32306error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32307coding like this:
32308.code
32309warn !verify = sender
32310 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32311.endd
32312If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32313denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32314verification failure.
32315
32316In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32317appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32318
32319.ilist
32320&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32321was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32322.next
32323&%route%&: Routing failed.
32324.next
32325&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32326occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32327connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32328.next
32329&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32330.next
32331&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32332.endlist
32333
32334The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32335rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32336
32337The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32338address verification to:
32339
32340.ilist
32341&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32342.endlist
32343
32344
32345
32346
32347.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32348.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32349.cindex "callout" "verification"
32350.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32351For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32352checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32353the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32354&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32355a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32356address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32357sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32358deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32359sender's domain.
32360
32361Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32362request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32363described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32364lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32365cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32366caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32367
32368Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32369the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32370callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32371callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32372on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32373
32374If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32375second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32376one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32377&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32378router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32379&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32380&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32381supplies a host list.
32382Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32383
32384The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32385remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32386specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32387specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32388specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32389the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32390&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32391
32392For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32393test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32394following SMTP commands are sent:
32395.display
32396&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32397&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32398&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32399&`QUIT`&
32400.endd
32401LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32402set to &"lmtp"&.
32403
32404The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32405settings.
32406
32407A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32408for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32409the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32410that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32411do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32412&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32413
32414If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32415succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32416Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32417hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32418&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32419
32420.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32421A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32422output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32423clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32424disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32425
32426
32427
32428
32429.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32430.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32431The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32432optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32433.code
32434verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32435.endd
32436The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32437separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32438deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32439
32440
32441.vlist
32442.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32443.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32444This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32445For example:
32446.code
32447verify = sender/callout=5s
32448.endd
32449The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32450remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32451the &%connect%& parameter.
32452
32453
32454.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32455.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32456This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32457for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32458.code
32459verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32460.endd
32461If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32462
32463.vitem &*defer_ok*&
32464.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32465When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32466of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32467updated in this circumstance.
32468
32469.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32470.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32471This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32472&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32473accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32474unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32475
32476
32477.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32478.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32479When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32480verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32481sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32482whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32483MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32484as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32485(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32486address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32487.code
32488require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32489.endd
32490This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32491
32492
32493.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32494.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32495This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32496For example:
32497.code
32498verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32499.endd
32500This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32501commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32502be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32503very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32504(for example, when network connections are timing out).
32505
32506
32507.vitem &*no_cache*&
32508.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32509.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32510When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32511
32512.vitem &*postmaster*&
32513.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32514When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32515check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32516rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32517the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32518used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32519made, until the cache record expires.
32520
32521.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32522The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32523You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32524For example:
32525.code
32526require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32527.endd
32528If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32529one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32530.code
32531require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32532.endd
32533&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32534account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32535a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32536postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32537
32538
32539.vitem &*random*&
32540.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32541When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32542check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32543really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32544&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32545.code
32546$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32547.endd
32548The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32549parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32550specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32551a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32552succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32553
32554.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32555.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32556This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32557.code
32558deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32559.endd
32560.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32561It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32562performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32563that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32564domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32565
32566.vitem &*use_sender*&
32567This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32568.code
32569require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32570.endd
32571It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32572command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32573need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32574sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32575usefulness of callout caching.
32576
32577.vitem &*hold*&
32578This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32579.code
32580require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32581.endd
32582It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32583and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32584Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32585when that is used for the connections.
32586The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32587(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32588if the use_sender option is used,
32589if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32590and if no other callouts intervene.
32591.endlist
32592
32593If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32594command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32595&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32596usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32597that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32598Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32599these circumstances.
32600
32601However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32602host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32603callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32604sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32605callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32606own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32607is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32608
32609Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32610caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32611by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32612actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32613
32614
32615
32616
32617.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32618.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32619.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32620.cindex "caching" "callout"
32621Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32622used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32623option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32624different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32625a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32626entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32627
32628When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32629the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32630is not available.
32631
32632The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32633independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32634(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32635
32636If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32637commands up to and including
32638.code
32639MAIL FROM:<>
32640.endd
32641(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32642any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32643domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32644making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32645separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32646&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32647&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32648
32649Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32650cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32651Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32652ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32653will eventually be noticed.
32654
32655The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32656being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32657behaviour will be the same.
32658
32659
32660
32661.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32662.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32663See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32664verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32665failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32666relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32667you might see:
32668.code
32669MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32670250 OK
32671RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32672550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32673550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32674550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32675550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32676550 Sender verification failed
32677.endd
32678If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32679only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32680out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32681&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32682example:
32683.code
32684verify = sender/no_details
32685.endd
32686
32687.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32688.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32689.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32690A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32691during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32692or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32693it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32694
32695.ilist
32696When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32697continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32698verification also fails.
32699.next
32700When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32701verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32702.endlist
32703
32704This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32705way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32706example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32707.code
32708A.Wol: aw123
32709aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32710.endd
32711work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32712redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32713mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32714verification to succeed.
32715
32716It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32717redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32718generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32719option. For example:
32720.code
32721require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32722.endd
32723In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32724the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32725
32726When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32727redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32728also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32729address and a report is output for each of them.
32730
32731
32732
32733.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32734.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32735Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32736which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32737special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32738domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32739Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32740.code
32741verify = csa
32742.endd
32743This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32744valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32745succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32746&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32747&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32748be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32749
32750The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32751detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32752looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32753address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32754
32755.ilist
32756The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32757.next
32758The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32759.next
32760The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32761(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32762.next
32763The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32764that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32765.endlist
32766
32767The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32768use for the DNS query. The default is:
32769.code
32770verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32771.endd
32772This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32773is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32774address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32775the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32776meaningful to say:
32777.code
32778verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32779.endd
32780In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32781This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32782&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32783
32784If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32785is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32786making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32787using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32788default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32789default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32790(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32791of legitimate HELO domains.
32792
32793The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32794direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32795search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32796addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32797lookup such as:
32798.code
32799${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32800.endd
32801has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32802The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32803authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32804
32805
32806
32807
32808.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32809.cindex "BATV, verifying"
32810Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32811of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32812Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32813recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32814bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32815spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32816
32817There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32818&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32819the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32820address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32821item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32822The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32823&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32824The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32825
32826As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32827database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32828like this:
32829.code
32830PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32831 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32832 }{$value}}
32833.endd
32834Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32835list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32836use this:
32837.code
32838# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32839deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32840 senders = :
32841 recipients = +batv_senders
32842
32843# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32844deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32845 senders = :
32846 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32847 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32848 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32849.endd
32850The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32851to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32852send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32853recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32854the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32855
32856A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32857&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32858prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32859the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32860the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32861timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32862of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32863
32864There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32865you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32866deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32867router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32868.code
32869batv_redirect:
32870 driver = redirect
32871 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32872.endd
32873This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32874of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32875address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32876local addresses.
32877
32878To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32879can be used:
32880.code
32881external_smtp_batv:
32882 driver = smtp
32883 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32884 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32885 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32886 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32887 {$value}fail}}}
32888.endd
32889If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32890
32891
32892
32893.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32894.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32895.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32896.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32897An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32898delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32899within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32900passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32901.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32902but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32903
32904Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32905A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32906relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32907a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32908with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32909same host is fulfilling both functions,
32910. ///
32911. as illustrated in the diagram below,
32912. ///
32913but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32914not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32915system to arbitrary domains.
32916
32917
32918You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32919runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32920Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32921example, suppose you want to do the following:
32922
32923.ilist
32924Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32925locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32926&'my.dom2.example'&.
32927.next
32928Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32929These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32930.next
32931Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32932Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32933.endlist
32934
32935
32936In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32937.code
32938domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32939domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32940hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32941.endd
32942Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32943command:
32944.code
32945acl_check_rcpt:
32946 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32947 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32948.endd
32949The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32950the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32951statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32952hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32953than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32954default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32955in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32956
32957
32958
32959.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32960.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32961You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32962that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32963the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32964.ecindex IIDacl
32965
32966
32967
32968. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32969. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32970
32971.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32972.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32973The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32974as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32975was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32976maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32977specification.
32978
32979It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32980&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32981scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32982messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32983chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32984
32985If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32986Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32987&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32988
32989.ilist
32990Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32991for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32992.next
32993Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32994&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32995run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32996.next
32997An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32998of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32999.next
33000Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
33001conditions.
33002.next
33003Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
33004.endlist
33005
33006Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
33007added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
33008changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
33009EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
33010this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
33011&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
33012
33013All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
33014temporarily created in a file called:
33015.display
33016<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
33017.endd
33018The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
33019expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
33020first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
33021scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
33022removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
33023.code
33024control = no_mbox_unspool
33025.endd
33026has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
33027same directory by default.
33028
33029
33030
33031.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
33032.cindex "virus scanning"
33033.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
33034.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
33035The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
33036It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
33037specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
33038in memory and thus are much faster.
33039
33040Since message data needs to have arrived,
33041the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
33042&%acl_smtp_data%&,
33043&%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
33044&%acl_smtp_mime%& or
33045&%acl_smtp_dkim%&
33046
33047A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
33048if it expires then a defer action is taken.
33049
33050.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
33051You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
33052to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
33053are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
33054.display
33055&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
33056.endd
33057If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
33058.code
33059av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
33060.endd
33061If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
33062before use.
33063The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
33064The following scanner types are supported in this release,
33065though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
33066
33067.vlist
33068.vitem &%avast%&
33069.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
33070This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
33071Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
33072You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
33073at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
33074This scanner type takes one option,
33075which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33076or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33077The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33078single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33079A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
33080Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
33081the daemon as options before the main scan command.
33082
33083.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
33084If &`pass_unscanned`&
33085is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
33086decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
33087care.
33088
33089For example:
33090.code
33091av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33092av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33093av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
33094.endd
33095If you omit the argument, the default path
33096&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
33097is used.
33098If you use a remote host,
33099you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
33100as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
33101For information about available commands and their options you may use
33102.code
33103$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
33104 FLAGS
33105 SENSITIVITY
33106 PACK
33107.endd
33108
33109If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
33110permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
33111written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
33112
33113.vitem &%aveserver%&
33114.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33115This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
33116at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
33117which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
33118example:
33119.code
33120av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
33121.endd
33122
33123
33124.vitem &%clamd%&
33125.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
33126This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
33127&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
33128unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
33129in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
33130
33131The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
33132a UNIX socket specification,
33133a TCP socket specification,
33134or a (global) option.
33135
33136A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
33137For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
33138for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
33139and the second a port number,
33140Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
33141These per-server options are supported:
33142.code
33143retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33144.endd
33145
33146The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33147a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
33148
33149If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
33150
33151Examples:
33152.code
33153av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
33154av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
33155av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
33156av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
33157av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
33158.endd
33159If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
33160&`local`&
33161option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
33162to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
33163more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
33164Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
33165
33166The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
33167randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
33168that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
33169socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
33170unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
33171When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
33172not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
33173selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
33174email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
33175.code
331762013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
33177 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
33178 (Connection refused)
33179.endd
33180
33181If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
33182contributing the code for this scanner.
33183
33184.vitem &%cmdline%&
33185.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
33186This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
33187used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
33188type takes 3 mandatory options:
33189
33190.olist
33191The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
33192and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
33193
33194.next
33195A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
33196virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
33197absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
33198the &"trigger"& expression.
33199
33200.next
33201Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
33202match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
33203&"name"& expression.
33204.endlist olist
33205
33206For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
33207.code
33208Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
33209.endd
33210For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
33211name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
33212for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
33213configuration setting:
33214.code
33215av_scanner = cmdline:\
33216 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
33217 found in file:'(.+)'
33218.endd
33219.vitem &%drweb%&
33220.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33221The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33222takes one option,
33223either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33224or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33225The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33226single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33227For example:
33228.code
33229av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33230av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33231.endd
33232If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33233is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33234
33235.vitem &%f-protd%&
33236.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33237The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33238One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33239(or port-range).
33240For example:
33241.code
33242av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33243.endd
33244If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33245
33246.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33247.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33248The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33249One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33250For example:
33251.code
33252av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33253.endd
33254If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33255
33256.vitem &%fsecure%&
33257.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33258The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33259argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33260.code
33261av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33262.endd
33263If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33264Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33265
33266.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33267.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33268This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33269Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33270scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33271For example:
33272.code
33273av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33274.endd
33275The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33276
33277.vitem &%mksd%&
33278.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33279This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33280though some documentation was available in English.
33281The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33282and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33283we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33284to integrate.
33285The only option for this scanner type is
33286the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33287provided that mksd has
33288been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33289.code
33290av_scanner = mksd:2
33291.endd
33292You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33293
33294.vitem &%sock%&
33295.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33296This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33297running on the local machine.
33298There are four options:
33299an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33300a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33301the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33302an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33303and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33304For example:
33305.code
33306av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33307.endd
33308Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33309there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33310The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33311Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33312specify an empty element to get this.
33313
33314.vitem &%sophie%&
33315.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33316Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33317You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33318for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33319client communication. For example:
33320.code
33321av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33322.endd
33323The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33324the option.
33325.endlist
33326
33327When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33328the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33329ACL.
33330
33331The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33332makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33333The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33334for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33335However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33336which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33337message.
33338
33339The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33340use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33341The first element can then be one of
33342
33343.ilist
33344&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33345The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33346recommended usage.
33347.next
33348&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33349the condition fails immediately.
33350.next
33351A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33352condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33353expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33354Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33355unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33356.endlist
33357
33358You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33359messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33360Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33361
33362You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33363specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33364For example:
33365.code
33366malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33367.endd
33368A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33369
33370.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33371When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33372is set to record the actual address used.
33373
33374.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33375When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33376&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33377&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33378logging data.
33379
33380Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33381imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33382
33383Here is a very simple scanning example:
33384.code
33385deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33386 malware = *
33387.endd
33388The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33389.code
33390deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33391 malware = */defer_ok
33392.endd
33393The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33394aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33395.code
33396av_scanner = $acl_m0
33397.endd
33398in the main Exim configuration.
33399.code
33400deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33401 set acl_m0 = sophie
33402 malware = *
33403
33404deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33405 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33406 malware = *
33407.endd
33408
33409
33410.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33411.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33412.cindex "spam scanning"
33413.cindex "SpamAssassin"
33414.cindex "Rspamd"
33415The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33416score and a report for the message.
33417Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33418
33419For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33420Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33421&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33422
33423SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33424.code
33425perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33426.endd
33427SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33428documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33429nicely, however.
33430
33431.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33432By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33433intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33434&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33435you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33436configuration as follows (example):
33437.code
33438spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33439.endd
33440The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33441If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33442iptables firewall, consider setting
33443&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33444timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33445server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33446connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33447soon.
33448
33449
33450To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33451on TCP port 11333)
33452you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33453.code
33454spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33455.endd
33456
33457As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33458sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33459filename instead of an address/port pair:
33460.code
33461spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33462.endd
33463You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33464reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33465&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33466option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33467.code
33468spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33469 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33470 192.168.2.12 783
33471.endd
33472Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33473When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33474servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33475condition defers.
33476
33477Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33478Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33479and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33480take care to not double the separator.
33481
33482For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33483subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33484and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33485In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33486
33487Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33488are options.
33489The supported options are:
33490.code
33491pri=<priority> Selection priority
33492weight=<value> Selection bias
33493time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33494retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33495tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33496variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33497.endd
33498
33499The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33500higher values being tried first.
33501The default priority is 1.
33502
33503The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33504Within a priority set
33505servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33506The default value for selection bias is 1.
33507
33508Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33509in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33510Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33511characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33512
33513Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33514are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33515
33516The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33517The default value is two minutes.
33518
33519The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33520a failed connect is made.
33521The default is to not retry.
33522
33523The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33524a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33525used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33526expansion.
33527
33528.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33529When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33530is set to record the actual address used.
33531
33532.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33533Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33534.code
33535deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33536 spam = joe
33537.endd
33538The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33539relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33540to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33541default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33542Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33543right-hand side.
33544
33545The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33546principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33547have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33548&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33549read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33550are not set.
33551Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33552(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33553after the first),
33554or the use of PRDR,
33555.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33556are needed to use this feature.
33557
33558The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33559you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33560&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33561
33562
33563Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33564large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33565are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33566example:
33567.code
33568deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33569 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33570 spam = nobody
33571.endd
33572
33573The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33574SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33575&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33576it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33577
33578.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33579When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33580variables.
33581Except for &$spam_report$&,
33582these variables are saved with the received message so are
33583available for use at delivery time.
33584
33585.vlist
33586.vitem &$spam_score$&
33587The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33588for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33589
33590.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33591The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33592example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33593because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33594The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33595
33596.vitem &$spam_bar$&
33597A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33598integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33599&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33600headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33601spam bar is 50 characters.
33602
33603.vitem &$spam_report$&
33604A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33605message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33606This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33607Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33608when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33609unencoded in headers.
33610
33611.vitem &$spam_action$&
33612For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33613spam score versus threshold.
33614For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33615
33616.endlist
33617
33618The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33619spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33620does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33621
33622The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33623the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33624failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33625statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33626spam condition, like this:
33627.code
33628deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33629 spam = joe/defer_ok
33630.endd
33631This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33632
33633Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33634condition:
33635.code
33636# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33637warn spam = nobody:true
33638 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33639 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33640
33641# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33642# is over threshold
33643warn spam = nobody
33644 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33645
33646# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33647deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33648 spam = nobody:true
33649 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33650.endd
33651
33652
33653
33654.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33655.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33656.cindex "MIME content scanning"
33657.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33658.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33659The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33660each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33661of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33662specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33663options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33664cases.
33665
33666These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33667ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33668the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33669message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33670ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33671result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33672&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33673
33674You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33675only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33676condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33677&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33678&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33679
33680At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33681information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33682of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33683parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33684part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33685syntax is:
33686.display
33687&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33688.endd
33689The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33690the value can be:
33691
33692.olist
33693&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33694.next
33695The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33696&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33697a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33698full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33699.next
33700A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33701directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33702is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33703the full path and filename.
33704.next
33705If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33706filename, and the default path is then used.
33707.endlist
33708The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33709errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33710a file with its original, proposed filename using
33711.code
33712decode = $mime_filename
33713.endd
33714However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33715anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33716automatically unlinked.
33717
33718For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33719content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33720as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33721variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33722before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33723
33724The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33725used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33726respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33727
33728.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33729The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33730available in the MIME ACL:
33731
33732.vlist
33733.vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
33734 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
33735.vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
33736.vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
33737If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
33738the detected issue.
33739
33740.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33741.vindex &$mime_boundary$&
33742If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
33743have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33744has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33745contains the empty string.
33746
33747.vitem &$mime_charset$&
33748.vindex &$mime_charset$&
33749This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33750&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33751.code
33752us-ascii
33753gb2312 (Chinese)
33754iso-8859-1
33755.endd
33756Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33757case-insensitively.
33758
33759.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33760.vindex &$mime_content_description$&
33761This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33762header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33763implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33764only used for display purposes.
33765
33766.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33767.vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
33768This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33769header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33770
33771.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33772.vindex &$mime_content_id$&
33773This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33774This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33775
33776.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33777.vindex &$mime_content_size$&
33778This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33779successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33780size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33781has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33782
33783.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33784.vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33785This variable contains the normalized content of the
33786&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33787type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33788
33789.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33790.vindex &$mime_content_type$&
33791If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33792value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33793are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33794.code
33795text/plain
33796text/html
33797application/octet-stream
33798image/jpeg
33799audio/midi
33800.endd
33801If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33802empty string.
33803
33804.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33805.vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33806This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33807successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33808containing the decoded data.
33809.endlist
33810
33811.cindex "RFC 2047"
33812.vlist
33813.vitem &$mime_filename$&
33814.vindex &$mime_filename$&
33815This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33816proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33817&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33818RFC2047
33819or RFC2231
33820decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33821 If no filename was
33822found, this variable contains the empty string.
33823
33824.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33825.vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33826This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33827attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33828content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33829
33830The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33831cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33832follows:
33833
33834.olist
33835The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33836
33837.next
33838If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33839so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33840
33841.next
33842If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33843and the rest are attachments.
33844
33845.next
33846All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33847.endlist olist
33848
33849As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33850alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33851coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33852.code
33853deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33854!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33855condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33856condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33857.endd
33858
33859.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33860.vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
33861This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33862&"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33863Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33864want to carry out specific actions on them.
33865
33866.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33867.vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33868This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33869checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33870decoding is fully recursive.
33871
33872.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33873.vindex &$mime_part_count$&
33874This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33875starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33876counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33877&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33878complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33879parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33880.endlist
33881
33882
33883
33884.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33885.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33886.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33887You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33888the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33889
33890The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33891matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33892MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33893linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33894have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33895
33896The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33897to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33898part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33899is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33900and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3390132K characters are checked.
33902
33903The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33904literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33905expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33906with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33907Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33908.code
33909deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33910 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33911.endd
33912The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33913&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33914matching regular expression.
33915The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33916are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33917
33918&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33919CPU-intensive.
33920
33921.ecindex IIDcosca
33922
33923
33924
33925
33926. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33927. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33928
33929.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33930 "Local scan function"
33931.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33932.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33933.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33934In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33935want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33936
33937The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33938passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33939a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33940condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33941non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33942
33943To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33944possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33945in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33946can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33947
33948The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33949when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33950It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33951well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33952
33953Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33954option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33955Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33956Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33957before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33958are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33959incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33960For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33961code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33962
33963
33964
33965.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33966.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33967To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33968function is before building Exim, by setting
33969both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33970LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33971&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33972directory, so you might set
33973.code
33974HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33975LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33976.endd
33977for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
33978.new
33979the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
33980and then #include "local_scan.h".
33981.wen
33982It is called by
33983Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33984be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33985function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33986commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33987_src/local_scan.c_.
33988
33989If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33990for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33991.code
33992LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33993.endd
33994in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33995
33996
33997
33998
33999.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
34000.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
34001.cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
34002You must include this line near the start of your code:
34003.code
34004#define LOCAL_SCAN
34005#include "local_scan.h"
34006.endd
34007This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
34008prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
34009almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
34010for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
34011It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
34012strings and pointers to character strings:
34013.code
34014#define CS (char *)
34015#define CCS (const char *)
34016#define CSS (char **)
34017#define US (unsigned char *)
34018#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
34019#define USS (unsigned char **)
34020.endd
34021The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
34022.code
34023extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
34024.endd
34025The arguments are as follows:
34026
34027.ilist
34028&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
34029(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
34030recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
34031
34032The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
34033character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
34034id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
34035macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
34036case this changes in some future version.
34037.next
34038&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
34039string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
34040.endlist
34041
34042The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
34043
34044.vlist
34045.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
34046.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
34047The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
34048the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
34049newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
34050maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
34051
34052.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
34053This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34054queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
34055
34056.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
34057This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34058queued without immediate delivery.
34059
34060.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
34061The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
34062passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
34063they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
34064&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
34065used.
34066
34067.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
34068The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
34069message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
34070problem"& is used.
34071
34072.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34073This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
34074message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
34075&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
34076&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
34077&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
34078same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34079
34080.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34081This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
34082LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34083.endlist
34084
34085If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
34086reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
34087&%-oe%& command line options.
34088
34089
34090
34091.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
34092.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
34093It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
34094that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
34095want to do this, you must have the line
34096.code
34097LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34098.endd
34099in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
34100&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
34101file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
34102to define them.
34103
34104The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
34105&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
34106and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
34107alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
34108variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
34109entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
34110.code
34111static int my_integer_option = 42;
34112static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
34113
34114optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
34115 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
34116 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
34117};
34118
34119int local_scan_options_count =
34120 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
34121.endd
34122The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
34123configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
34124.code
34125begin local_scan
34126my_integer = 99
34127my_string = some string of text...
34128.endd
34129The available types of option data are as follows:
34130
34131.vlist
34132.vitem &*opt_bool*&
34133This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
34134variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
34135that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
34136whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
34137TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
34138values.)
34139
34140.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
34141This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
34142The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
34143multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
34144
34145.vitem &*opt_int*&
34146This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
34147&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
34148Exim.
34149
34150.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
34151This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
34152&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
34153printed with the suffix K or M.
34154
34155.vitem &*opt_octint*&
34156This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
34157octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
34158always output in octal.
34159
34160.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
34161This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
34162variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
34163
34164.vitem &*opt_time*&
34165This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
34166type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
34167.endlist
34168
34169If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
34170out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
34171
34172
34173
34174.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
34175.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
34176The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
34177are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
34178Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
34179including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
34180C variables are as follows:
34181
34182.vlist
34183.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
34184This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
34185It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34186
34187.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
34188This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
34189It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34190
34191.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
34192This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
34193is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
34194&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
34195
34196.ilist
34197The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
34198testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
34199other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
34200
34201.next
34202The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
34203by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
34204of debugging bits.
34205.endlist ilist
34206
34207Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
34208selected, you should use code like this:
34209.code
34210if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34211 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34212.endd
34213.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
34214After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
34215variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
34216
34217.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
34218A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
34219discussed below.
34220
34221.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
34222A pointer to the last of the header lines.
34223
34224.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
34225The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
34226
34227.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
34228This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
34229&%-bh%& command line option.
34230
34231.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
34232The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
34233is NULL for locally submitted messages.
34234
34235.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
34236The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
34237command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
34238specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
34239
34240.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
34241This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
34242&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
34243
34244.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34245The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34246
34247.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34248The number of accepted recipients.
34249
34250.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34251.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34252.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34253The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34254&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34255can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34256below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34257adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34258&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34259value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34260blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34261and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34262
34263.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34264The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34265
34266.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34267The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34268locally-submitted messages.
34269
34270.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34271The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34272was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34273
34274.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34275The name of the sending host, if known.
34276
34277.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34278The port on the sending host.
34279
34280.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34281This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34282
34283.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34284This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34285
34286.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34287The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34288requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34289.endlist
34290
34291
34292.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34293The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34294You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34295(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34296their type to *.
34297
34298
34299.vlist
34300.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34301A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34302
34303.vitem &*int&~type*&
34304A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34305characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34306Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34307with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34308rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34309lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34310
34311.vitem &*int&~slen*&
34312The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34313internal newlines.
34314
34315.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34316A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34317a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34318.endlist
34319
34320
34321
34322.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34323The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34324
34325.vlist
34326.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34327This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34328
34329.vitem &*int&~pno*&
34330This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34331the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34332and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34333
34334.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34335If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34336recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34337envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34338router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34339an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34340&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34341is NULL for all recipients.
34342.endlist
34343
34344
34345
34346.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34347.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34348The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34349These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34350release:
34351
34352.vlist
34353.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34354 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34355
34356This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34357&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34358be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34359for the process in &%newumask%&.
34360
34361Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34362and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34363standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34364descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34365argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34366
34367The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34368
34369.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34370This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34371seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34372return value is as follows:
34373
34374.ilist
34375>= 0
34376
34377The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34378ending status.
34379
34380.next
34381< 0 and > &--256
34382
34383The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34384signal number.
34385
34386.next
34387&--256
34388
34389The process timed out.
34390.next
34391&--257
34392
34393The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34394.endlist
34395
34396.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34397This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34398Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34399want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34400forks a subprocess that is running
34401.code
34402exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34403.endd
34404and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34405that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34406of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34407recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34408
34409When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34410finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34411fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34412addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34413
34414
34415.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34416 *sender_authentication)*&
34417This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34418that it runs is:
34419.display
34420&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34421.endd
34422The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34423
34424
34425.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34426This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34427output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34428calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34429conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34430.code
34431if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34432 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34433.endd
34434
34435.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34436This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34437expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34438The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34439expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34440the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34441block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34442&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34443
34444.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34445This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34446existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34447character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34448substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34449if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34450
34451.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34452 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34453This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34454chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34455
34456If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34457&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34458NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34459matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34460&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34461found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34462marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34463option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34464top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34465headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34466.code
34467header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34468 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34469.endd
34470Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34471there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34472
34473
34474.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34475This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34476occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34477particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34478match the specification, the function does nothing.
34479
34480
34481.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34482 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34483This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34484a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34485colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34486&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34487.code
34488if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34489.endd
34490.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34491.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34492This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34493The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34494back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34495zero-terminated.
34496
34497.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34498This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34499zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34500to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34501string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34502yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34503easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34504added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34505
34506.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34507This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34508matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34509.display
34510&`OK `& match succeeded
34511&`FAIL `& match failed
34512&`DEFER `& match deferred
34513.endd
34514DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34515inability to contact a database.
34516
34517.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34518 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34519This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34520controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34521&'lss_match_domain()'&.
34522
34523.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34524 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34525This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34526controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34527matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34528
34529.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34530 uschar&~*list)*&"
34531This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34532expected to be
34533.code
34534lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34535.endd
34536.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34537An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34538is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34539looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34540values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34541returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34542failed.
34543
34544.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34545 *format,&~...)*&"
34546This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34547is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34548&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34549them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34550arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34551contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34552
34553
34554.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34555This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34556is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34557with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34558
34559This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34560described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34561the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34562value afterwards. For example:
34563.code
34564 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34565 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34566 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34567.endd
34568
34569.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34570This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34571recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34572matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34573address.
34574.endlist
34575
34576
34577.cindex "RFC 2047"
34578.vlist
34579.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34580 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34581This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34582these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34583from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34584a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34585made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34586binary string is returned with an error message.
34587
34588The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34589maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34590encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34591
34592.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34593.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34594If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34595contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34596not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34597
34598The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34599&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34600which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34601
34602If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34603argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34604set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34605returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34606with translation.
34607
34608
34609.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34610This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34611below.
34612
34613.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34614The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34615output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34616stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34617SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34618is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34619opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34620test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34621is involved.
34622
34623If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34624output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34625
34626The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34627(when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34628This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34629sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34630
34631The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
34632Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
34633ABI version number was incremented.
34634
34635Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34636must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34637LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34638LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34639initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34640to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34641that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34642.code
34643smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34644return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34645.endd
34646Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34647the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34648&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34649multiple output lines.
34650
34651The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34652does not
34653guarantee a flush of
34654pending output, and therefore does not test
34655the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34656detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34657you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34658dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34659arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34660is an error.
34661
34662.new
34663.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
34664This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34665chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
34666The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
34667data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
34668FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
34669Exim bombs out if it ever
34670runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34671.wen
34672
34673.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
34674This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34675permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34676
34677.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34678See below.
34679
34680.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34681See below.
34682
34683.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34684These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34685The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34686number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34687and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34688pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34689more discussion.
34690.endlist
34691
34692
34693
34694.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34695.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34696No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34697The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34698recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34699to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34700message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34701terminates.
34702
34703Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34704data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34705connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34706one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34707
34708If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34709in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34710.code
34711store_pool = POOL_PERM
34712.endd
34713before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34714restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34715the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34716set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34717
34718The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34719&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34720There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34721block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34722&%store_pool%&.
34723.ecindex IIDlosca
34724
34725
34726
34727
34728. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34729. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34730
34731.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34732.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34733.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34734.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34735The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34736that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34737also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34738they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34739
34740The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34741is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34742It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34743commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34744The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34745
34746The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34747is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34748the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34749If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34750of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34751prevent it happening on retries.
34752
34753.vindex "&$domain$&"
34754.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34755&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34756specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34757&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34758you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34759independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34760described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34761
34762
34763.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34764.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34765.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34766The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34767setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34768other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34769&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34770.code
34771system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34772system_filter_user = exim
34773.endd
34774If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34775&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34776specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34777&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34778&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34779by the &%reply%& command.
34780
34781
34782.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34783You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34784filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34785are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34786
34787If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34788you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34789
34790
34791
34792.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34793The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34794files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34795mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34796available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34797If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34798they cause errors.
34799
34800.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34801There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34802files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34803is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34804&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34805subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34806manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34807
34808&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34809specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34810succeed, it will not be tried again.
34811If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34812arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34813
34814When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34815&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34816users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34817to which users' filter files can refer.
34818
34819
34820
34821.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34822.vindex "&$recipients$&"
34823The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34824of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34825filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34826
34827
34828
34829.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34830.cindex "freezing messages"
34831.cindex "message" "freezing"
34832.cindex "message" "forced failure"
34833.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34834.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34835.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34836There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34837always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34838filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34839for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34840word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34841.code
34842fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34843.endd
34844The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34845
34846The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34847message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34848and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34849delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34850that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34851run.
34852
34853The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34854not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34855filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34856is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34857
34858.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34859.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34860The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34861well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34862up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34863log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34864two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34865strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34866message. For example:
34867.code
34868fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34869 because it contains attachments that we are \
34870 not prepared to receive."
34871.endd
34872
34873.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34874Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34875the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34876the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34877command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34878Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34879use, for example
34880.code
34881if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34882then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34883.endd
34884though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34885alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34886generated by the filter.
34887
34888The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34889&%defer%&,
34890&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34891set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34892as
34893.code
34894mail ...
34895freeze
34896.endd
34897to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34898failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34899take place.
34900
34901
34902
34903.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34904.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34905.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34906.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34907Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34908.code
34909headers add <string>
34910headers remove <string>
34911.endd
34912The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34913added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34914filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34915space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34916forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34917
34918You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34919continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34920including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34921example:
34922.code
34923headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34924 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34925 X-header-2: ...."
34926.endd
34927Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34928be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34929space after input continuations is ignored.
34930
34931The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34932This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34933those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34934&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34935header with the same name, they are all removed.
34936
34937The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34938of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34939from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34940modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34941Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34942used for all recipients of the message.
34943
34944During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34945header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34946that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34947routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34948routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34949until the message is actually being written (see section
34950&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34951
34952If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34953added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34954present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34955present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34956message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34957conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34958modified more than once.
34959
34960Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34961use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34962For example:
34963.code
34964headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34965headers remove "Subject"
34966headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34967headers remove "Old-Subject"
34968.endd
34969
34970
34971
34972.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34973.cindex "envelope from"
34974.cindex "envelope sender"
34975In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34976.code
34977errors_to <some address>
34978.endd
34979in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34980delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34981user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34982might use
34983.code
34984unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34985.endd
34986to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34987address if its delivery failed.
34988
34989
34990
34991.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34992.vindex "&$domain$&"
34993.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34994In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34995delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34996operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34997such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34998filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34999which implements such a filter:
35000.code
35001central_filter:
35002 check_local_user
35003 driver = redirect
35004 domains = +local_domains
35005 file = /central/filters/$local_part
35006 no_verify
35007 allow_filter
35008 allow_freeze
35009.endd
35010The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
35011&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
35012the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
35013use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
35014
35015Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
35016specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
35017its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
35018address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
35019normal way.
35020.ecindex IIDsysfil1
35021.ecindex IIDsysfil2
35022.ecindex IIDsysfil3
35023
35024
35025
35026
35027
35028
35029. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35030. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35031
35032.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
35033.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
35034Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
35035all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
35036these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
35037this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
35038removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
35039before it is placed on Exim's queue.
35040
35041Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
35042&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
35043that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
35044its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
35045set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
35046
35047&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
35048or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
35049loopback interface specially in any way.
35050
35051If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
35052that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
35053
35054
35055
35056
35057.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
35058.cindex "message" "submission"
35059.cindex "submission mode"
35060Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
35061&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
35062received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
35063state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
35064.code
35065control = submission
35066.endd
35067in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
35068&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
35069a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
35070known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
35071example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
35072interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
35073.code
35074warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
35075 control = submission
35076.endd
35077.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
35078There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
35079is used to separate options. For example:
35080.code
35081control = submission/sender_retain
35082.endd
35083Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
35084true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
35085of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
35086the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
35087authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
35088&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
35089attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
35090
35091When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
35092domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
35093example:
35094.code
35095control = submission/domain=some.domain
35096.endd
35097The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
35098&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
35099that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
35100&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
35101.code
35102accept authenticated = *
35103 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
35104 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
35105 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
35106.endd
35107Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
35108option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
35109the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
35110.code
35111bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
35112.endd
35113then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
35114line would be:
35115.code
35116Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
35117.endd
35118.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
35119By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
35120used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
35121specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
35122
35123&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
35124ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
35125untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
35126specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
35127does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
35128spoof another's address.
35129
35130.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
35131.cindex "line endings"
35132.cindex "carriage return"
35133.cindex "linefeed"
35134RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
35135linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
35136SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
35137conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
35138use CRLF or just CR.
35139
35140Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
35141using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
35142receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
35143Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
35144MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
35145has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
35146that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
35147other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
35148follows:
35149
35150.ilist
35151LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
35152.next
35153CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
35154is ignored.
35155.next
35156The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
35157nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
35158terminator.
35159.next
35160If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
35161the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
35162is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
35163people trying to play silly games.
35164.next
35165If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
35166bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
35167line.
35168.endlist
35169
35170
35171
35172
35173
35174.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
35175.cindex "unqualified addresses"
35176.cindex "address" "qualification"
35177By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
35178host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
35179SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
35180messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
35181requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
35182
35183Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
35184sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
35185&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
35186cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
35187value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
35188
35189.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
35190.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
35191Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
35192that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
35193line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
35194are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
35195other words, such qualification is also controlled by
35196&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
35197
35198
35199
35200
35201.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
35202.cindex "&""From""& line"
35203.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
35204.cindex "sender" "address"
35205.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
35206.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
35207.cindex "envelope from"
35208.cindex "envelope sender"
35209.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35210Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
35211with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
35212&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
35213.code
35214From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
35215From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
35216.endd
35217This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
35218Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
35219via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
35220such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
35221&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
35222and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
35223regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
35224default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
35225that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
35226
35227.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
35228When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
35229a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
35230contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
35231then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
35232qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
35233the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
35234
35235If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
35236sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
35237that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
35238
35239Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
35240treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
35241as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
35242incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
35243
35244
35245
35246.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35247.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35248.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35249RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35250&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35251recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35252&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35253&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35254
35255.blockquote
35256&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35257processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35258.endblockquote
35259
35260This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35261address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35262follows:
35263
35264.ilist
35265A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35266is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35267.next
35268If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35269&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35270&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35271.next
35272For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35273also removed.
35274.next
35275For a locally-submitted message,
35276if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35277&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35278the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35279included in log lines in this case.
35280.next
35281The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35282&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35283.endlist
35284
35285
35286
35287
35288.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35289Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35290includes the header line:
35291.code
35292Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35293.endd
35294
35295.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35296.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35297If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35298message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35299extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35300existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35301
35302
35303.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35304.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35305.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35306If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35307Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35308&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35309
35310.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35311.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35312.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35313&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35314set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35315the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35316in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35317set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35318messages.
35319
35320
35321.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35322.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35323.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35324.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35325&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35326Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35327generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35328messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35329(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35330messages.
35331
35332
35333.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35334.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35335.cindex "header lines" "From:"
35336.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35337.cindex "message" "submission"
35338.cindex "submission mode"
35339If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35340adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35341
35342.ilist
35343The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35344message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35345.next
35346.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35347The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35348.olist
35349.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35350If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35351&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35352.next
35353If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35354part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35355.next
35356If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35357&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35358.endlist
35359.endlist
35360
35361A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35362
35363If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35364line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35365containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35366are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35367They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35368&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35369&%qualify_domain%&.
35370
35371For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35372&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35373user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35374name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35375
35376
35377.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35378.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35379.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35380.cindex "message" "submission"
35381.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35382If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35383&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35384&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35385to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35386creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35387message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35388followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35389in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35390&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35391
35392
35393.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35394.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35395.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35396A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35397contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35398Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35399
35400The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35401have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35402line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35403that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35404
35405Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35406changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35407-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35408
35409
35410.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35411.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35412.cindex "header lines" "References:"
35413Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35414header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35415section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35416header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35417responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35418processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35419than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35420incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3542111 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35422
35423
35424
35425.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35426.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35427.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35428.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35429&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35430it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35431transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35432transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35433default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35434
35435
35436
35437.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35438.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35439.cindex "message" "submission"
35440.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35441For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35442existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35443these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35444&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35445control setting.
35446
35447When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35448&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35449control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35450&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35451that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35452&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35453be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35454appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35455line is added to the message.
35456
35457If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35458the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35459&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35460options true at the same time.
35461
35462.cindex "submission mode"
35463By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35464received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35465a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35466not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35467
35468.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35469First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35470authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35471created as follows:
35472
35473.ilist
35474.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35475If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35476&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35477.next
35478If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35479is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35480.next
35481If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35482&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35483.endlist
35484
35485This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35486are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35487added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35488by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35489
35490.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35491&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35492the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35493except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35494
35495
35496
35497.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35498 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35499.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35500.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35501When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35502specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35503process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35504modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35505as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35506
35507In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35508specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35509addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35510changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35511transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35512they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35513
35514&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35515the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35516expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35517
35518For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35519option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35520newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35521.code
35522headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35523 X-added-second: another added header line
35524.endd
35525Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35526
35527Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35528specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35529Each header-line is separately expanded.
35530
35531The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35532list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35533often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35534not part of the names. For example:
35535.code
35536headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35537.endd
35538
35539Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35540specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35541Each item is separately expanded.
35542Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35543form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35544will act as list separators.
35545
35546When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35547items are expanded at routing time,
35548and then associated with all addresses that are
35549accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35550an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35551forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35552
35553.oindex "&%unseen%&"
35554However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35555the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35556&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35557
35558Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35559settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35560dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35561requirements.
35562
35563The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35564with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35565these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35566recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35567consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35568names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35569instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35570
35571After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35572lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35573the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35574header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35575
35576This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35577the following consequences:
35578
35579.ilist
35580The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35581remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35582to it, at all times.
35583.next
35584Header lines that are added by a router's
35585&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35586expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35587.next
35588Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35589in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35590.next
35591Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35592a later router or by a transport.
35593.next
35594An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35595removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35596.code
35597headers_remove = subject
35598headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35599.endd
35600.endlist
35601
35602&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35603for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35604
35605
35606
35607
35608
35609.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35610.cindex "address" "constructed"
35611.cindex "constructed address"
35612When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35613the form
35614.display
35615<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35616.endd
35617For example:
35618.code
35619Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35620.endd
35621The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35622otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35623&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35624ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35625upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35626&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35627The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35628there is no password file entry.
35629
35630.cindex "RFC 2047"
35631In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35632parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35633characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35634including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35635&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35636characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35637&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35638is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35639
35640
35641
35642.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35643.cindex "case of local parts"
35644.cindex "local part" "case of"
35645RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35646be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35647addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35648because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35649routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35650original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35651router option.
35652
35653.cindex "mixed-case login names"
35654If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35655assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35656your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35657correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35658.code
35659correct_case:
35660 driver = redirect
35661 domains = +local_domains
35662 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35663 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35664 @$domain
35665.endd
35666For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35667(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35668up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35669on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35670local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35671
35672
35673
35674.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35675.cindex "dot" "in local part"
35676.cindex "local part" "dots in"
35677RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35678part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35679middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35680empty components for compatibility.
35681
35682
35683
35684.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35685.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35686Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35687happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35688in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35689&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35690
35691Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35692in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35693routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35694example, a header such as
35695.code
35696To: hare@teaparty
35697.endd
35698might get rewritten as
35699.code
35700To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35701.endd
35702Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35703does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35704been routed.
35705
35706Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35707addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35708result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35709deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35710immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35711routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35712.ecindex IIDmesproc
35713
35714
35715
35716. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35717. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35718
35719.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35720.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35721.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35722Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35723LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35724closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35725processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35726
35727.ilist
35728SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35729.next
35730SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35731.next
35732Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35733.endlist
35734
35735For mail delivery, the following are available:
35736
35737.ilist
35738SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35739.next
35740LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35741&"lmtp"&);
35742.next
35743LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35744transport);
35745.next
35746Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35747the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35748.endlist
35749
35750&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35751stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35752used to contain the envelope information.
35753
35754
35755
35756.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35757.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35758.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35759.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35760.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35761.cindex "EHLO"
35762.cindex "HELO"
35763.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35764Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35765The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35766processing is the same in both cases.
35767
35768If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35769parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35770command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35771&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35772such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35773.cindex "transport" "filter"
35774.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35775transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35776suppressed.
35777
35778If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35779pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35780required for the transaction.
35781
35782If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35783was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35784server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35785Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35786is called for verification.
35787
35788If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35789the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35790in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35791
35792.cindex "carriage return"
35793.cindex "linefeed"
35794Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35795LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35796order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35797line terminator.
35798
35799If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35800characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35801same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35802even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35803of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35804they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35805each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35806in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35807significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35808
35809When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35810message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35811records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35812particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35813
35814.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35815Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35816a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35817See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35818
35819.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35820.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35821When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35822looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35823messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35824creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35825a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35826so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35827does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35828turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35829
35830The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35831limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35832
35833.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35834The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35835identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35836square bracket of the IP address.
35837
35838
35839
35840
35841.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35842.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35843.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35844.cindex "host" "error"
35845Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35846message errors, and recipient errors.
35847
35848.vlist
35849.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35850A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35851particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35852
35853.ilist
35854Connection refused or timed out,
35855.next
35856Any error response code on connection,
35857.next
35858Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35859.next
35860Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35861.next
35862I/O errors at any time,
35863.next
35864Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35865the &"."& at the end of the data.
35866.endlist ilist
35867
35868For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35869EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35870error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35871host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35872the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35873alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35874host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35875made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35876
35877.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35878.cindex "message" "error"
35879A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35880particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35881message errors are:
35882
35883.ilist
35884Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35885the data,
35886.next
35887Timeout after MAIL,
35888.next
35889Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35890timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35891connection at any other time.
35892.endlist ilist
35893
35894For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35895to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35896temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35897addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35898a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35899message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35900that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35901time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35902affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35903it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35904
35905If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35906to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35907over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35908response to MAIL.
35909
35910.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35911.cindex "recipient" "error"
35912A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35913recipient errors are:
35914
35915.ilist
35916Any error response to RCPT,
35917.next
35918Timeout after RCPT.
35919.endlist
35920
35921For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35922recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35923sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35924address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35925used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35926routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35927operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35928to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35929if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35930(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35931have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35932the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35933the retry clock is reset.
35934
35935The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35936host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35937other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35938in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35939proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35940than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35941if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35942through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35943recipient's retry time.
35944.endlist
35945
35946In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35947current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35948tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35949own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35950until the next delivery attempt.
35951
35952Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35953MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35954would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35955host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35956What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35957is created.
35958
35959The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35960these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35961procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35962response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35963it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35964message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35965helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35966
35967Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35968host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35969or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35970the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35971then to be treated as a host error.
35972
35973There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35974terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35975reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35976should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35977host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35978
35979
35980
35981
35982.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35983.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35984.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35985.cindex "inetd"
35986.cindex "daemon"
35987Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35988listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35989&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35990.code
35991smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35992.endd
35993Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35994agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35995a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35996the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35997with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35998stream and exits with an error code.
35999
36000By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
36001disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
36002unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
36003&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
36004
36005.cindex "carriage return"
36006.cindex "linefeed"
36007Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36008LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
36009order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36010line terminator.
36011Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
36012sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
36013sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
36014
36015.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
36016.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
36017One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
36018HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
36019commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
36020the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
36021Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
36022match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
36023
36024.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
36025.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
36026The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
36027a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
36028&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
36029false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
36030&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
36031value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
36032message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
36033
36034When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
36035its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
36036logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
36037
36038The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
36039prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
36040number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
36041&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
36042rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
36043
36044The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
36045subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
36046for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
36047things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
36048processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
36049sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
36050it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
36051
36052When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
36053and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
36054high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
36055&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
36056applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
36057
36058Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
36059can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
36060&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
36061number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
36062SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
36063&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
36064subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
36065a delivery process.
36066
36067The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
36068&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
36069started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
36070handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
36071however, available with &'inetd'&.
36072
36073Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
36074are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
36075to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
36076section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
36077
36078Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
36079MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
36080&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
36081
36082
36083
36084.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
36085.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
36086If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
36087commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
36088the error response to the last command. The default value for
36089&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
36090abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
36091circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
36092
36093
36094.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
36095.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
36096.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
36097A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
36098something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
36099address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
36100sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
36101&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
36102drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
36103default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
36104broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
36105
36106
36107
36108.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
36109.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
36110The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
36111DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
36112many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
36113denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
36114client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
36115defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
36116
36117When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
36118allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
36119but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
36120or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
36121starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
36122counted.
36123
36124The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
36125STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
36126RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
36127
36128You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
36129&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
36130&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
36131the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
36132specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
36133
36134
36135
36136
36137.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
36138When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
36139runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
36140appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
36141
36142.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
36143When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
36144setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
36145(with a 252 SMTP response code)
36146in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
36147When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
36148called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
36149SMTP response codes.
36150
36151.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
36152If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
36153When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
36154EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
36155than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
36156as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
36157of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
36158VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
36159RCPT failures.
36160
36161
36162
36163.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
36164.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
36165RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
36166overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
36167disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
36168the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
36169should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
36170
36171The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
36172delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
36173the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
36174text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
36175specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
36176the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
36177argument. For example,
36178.code
36179ETRN #brigadoon
36180.endd
36181runs the command
36182.code
36183exim -R brigadoon
36184.endd
36185which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
36186containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
36187default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
36188for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
36189a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
36190
36191.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
36192Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
36193record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
36194the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
36195the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
36196a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
36197left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
36198Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
36199
36200.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
36201For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
36202used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
36203whatever the form of its argument. For
36204example:
36205.code
36206smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
36207 $sender_host_address
36208.endd
36209.vindex "&$domain$&"
36210The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
36211expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
36212and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
36213wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
36214under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
36215for it to change them before running the command.
36216
36217
36218
36219.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
36220.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
36221Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
36222standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
36223line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
36224&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
36225messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
36226sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
36227an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
36228identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
36229runs for RCPT commands:
36230.code
36231accept hosts = :
36232.endd
36233This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
36234
36235
36236
36237.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
36238.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
36239.cindex "batched SMTP output"
36240Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
36241batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
36242be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
36243delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36244envelope along with the message.
36245
36246The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36247MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36248the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36249HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36250can be used to specify it.
36251
36252Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36253one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36254to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36255this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36256chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36257
36258.vindex "&$host$&"
36259When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36260sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36261transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36262router:
36263.code
36264begin routers
36265route_append:
36266 driver = manualroute
36267 transport = smtp_appendfile
36268 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36269
36270begin transports
36271smtp_appendfile:
36272 driver = appendfile
36273 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36274 batch_max = 1000
36275 use_bsmtp
36276 user = exim
36277.endd
36278This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36279format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36280message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36281
36282
36283
36284.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36285.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36286.cindex "batched SMTP input"
36287The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36288reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36289is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36290sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36291rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36292and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36293as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36294
36295Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36296ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36297
36298If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36299the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36300standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36301make some use of automatically, for example:
36302.code
36303554 Unexpected end of file
36304Transaction started in line 10
36305Error detected in line 14
36306.endd
36307It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36308file, for example:
36309.code
36310An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36311The error message was:
36312
36313501 '>' missing at end of address
36314
36315The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36316The error was detected in line 12.
36317The SMTP command at fault was:
36318
36319rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36320
363211 previous message was successfully processed.
36322The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36323.endd
36324The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36325messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36326accepted.
36327.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36328.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36329
36330
36331
36332. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36333. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36334
36335.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36336 "Customizing messages"
36337When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36338configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36339to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36340the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36341string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36342
36343The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36344cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36345option. Exim also adds the line
36346.code
36347Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36348.endd
36349to all warning and bounce messages,
36350
36351
36352.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36353.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36354.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36355If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36356message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36357delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36358&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36359
36360When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36361constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36362separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36363opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36364logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36365item.
36366
36367.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36368.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36369Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36370expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36371the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36372&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36373option, rounded to a whole number.
36374
36375The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36376
36377.ilist
36378The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36379&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36380.next
36381The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36382failing addresses with their error messages.
36383.next
36384The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36385returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36386.next
36387The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36388The fields exist for back-compatibility
36389.endlist
36390
36391The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36392following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36393other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36394.code
36395Subject: Mail delivery failed
36396 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36397 {: returning message to sender}}
36398****
36399This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36400
36401A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36402 {that you sent }{sent by
36403
36404<$sender_address>
36405
36406}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36407This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36408****
36409The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36410****
36411------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36412 ------
36413****
36414------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36415 only the first
36416------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36417****
36418.endd
36419.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36420.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36421.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36422The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36423warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36424text sections:
36425
36426.ilist
36427The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36428&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36429.next
36430The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36431the delayed addresses.
36432.next
36433The third item then ends the message.
36434.endlist
36435
36436The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36437have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36438.code
36439Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36440 $warn_message_delay
36441****
36442This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36443
36444A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36445{that you sent }{sent by
36446
36447<$sender_address>
36448
36449}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36450more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36451
36452The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36453The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36454The date of the message is: $h_date
36455
36456The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36457****
36458No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36459continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36460intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36461mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36462the message will be returned to you.
36463.endd
36464.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36465.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36466However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36467appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36468&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36469minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36470of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36471multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36472handled them.
36473
36474
36475
36476
36477. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36478. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36479
36480.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36481This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36482common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36483
36484
36485
36486.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36487.cindex "smart host" "example router"
36488If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36489should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36490routing explicitly:
36491.code
36492send_to_smart_host:
36493 driver = manualroute
36494 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36495 transport = remote_smtp
36496.endd
36497You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36498If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36499receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36500synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36501&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36502
36503
36504
36505
36506.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36507.cindex "mailing lists"
36508Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36509requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36510Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36511
36512The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36513is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36514independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36515lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36516.code
36517lists:
36518 driver = redirect
36519 domains = lists.example
36520 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36521 forbid_pipe
36522 forbid_file
36523 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36524 no_more
36525.endd
36526This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36527in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36528such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36529routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36530
36531The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36532expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36533a mailing list.
36534
36535.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36536The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36537taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36538original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36539the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36540
36541For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36542&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36543&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36544&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36545There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36546the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36547such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36548or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36549&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36550
36551
36552
36553.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36554.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36555If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36556delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36557list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36558list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36559addresses are not rigorously checked.
36560
36561If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36562entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36563&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36564whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36565&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36566
36567
36568
36569.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36570.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36571Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36572in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36573recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36574cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36575delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36576account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36577the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36578message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36579
36580If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36581on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36582router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36583&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36584&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36585subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36586failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36587pre-existing messages.
36588
36589The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36590addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36591addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36592&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36593one level of expansion anyway.
36594
36595
36596
36597.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36598.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36599The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36600send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36601from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36602&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36603
36604The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36605of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36606.code
36607lists_request:
36608 driver = redirect
36609 domains = lists.example
36610 local_part_suffix = -request
36611 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36612 no_more
36613
36614lists_post:
36615 driver = redirect
36616 domains = lists.example
36617 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36618 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36619 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36620 forbid_pipe
36621 forbid_file
36622 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36623 no_more
36624
36625lists_closed:
36626 driver = redirect
36627 domains = lists.example
36628 allow_fail
36629 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36630.endd
36631All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36632they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36633&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36634mailing list.
36635
36636The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36637checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36638checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36639necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36640because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36641not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36642means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36643&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36644&"unrouteable address"& error.
36645
36646The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36647a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36648the address, giving a suitable error message.
36649
36650
36651
36652
36653.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36654.cindex "VERP"
36655.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36656.cindex "envelope from"
36657.cindex "envelope sender"
36658Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36659are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36660address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36661the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36662if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36663original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36664
36665.oindex &%errors_to%&
36666.oindex &%return_path%&
36667Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36668facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36669list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36670these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36671host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36672of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36673of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36674.code
36675verp_smtp:
36676 driver = smtp
36677 max_rcpt = 1
36678 return_path = \
36679 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36680 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36681.endd
36682This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36683SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36684&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36685local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36686example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36687&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36688&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36689rewritten as
36690.code
36691somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36692.endd
36693.vindex "&$local_part$&"
36694For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36695have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36696achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36697might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36698&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36699
36700Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36701probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36702extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36703can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36704.code
36705dnslookup:
36706 driver = dnslookup
36707 domains = ! +local_domains
36708 transport = \
36709 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36710 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36711 no_more
36712.endd
36713If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36714of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36715routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36716errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36717address.
36718
36719On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36720&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36721SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36722and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36723of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36724.code
36725verp_dnslookup:
36726 driver = dnslookup
36727 domains = ! +local_domains
36728 transport = remote_smtp
36729 errors_to = \
36730 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36731 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36732 no_more
36733.endd
36734Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36735configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36736Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36737router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36738them.
36739
36740The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36741message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36742host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36743a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36744a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36745than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36746used).
36747
36748
36749
36750
36751
36752
36753.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36754.cindex "virtual domains"
36755.cindex "domain" "virtual"
36756The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36757meanings:
36758
36759.ilist
36760A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36761aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36762top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36763.next
36764One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36765with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36766have login accounts on that host.
36767.endlist
36768
36769The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36770the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36771aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36772virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36773whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36774to a router of this form:
36775.code
36776virtual:
36777 driver = redirect
36778 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36779 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
36780 no_more
36781.endd
36782.new
36783The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36784is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36785domain that is being processed.
36786The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
36787being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
36788.wen
36789
36790When the router runs, it looks up the local
36791part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36792setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36793string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36794
36795This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36796follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36797can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36798a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36799
36800The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36801way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36802valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36803.code
36804my_domains:
36805 driver = accept
36806 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36807 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36808 transport = my_mailboxes
36809.endd
36810The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36811can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36812file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36813option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36814because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36815follows:
36816.code
36817my_mailboxes:
36818 driver = appendfile
36819 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36820 user = mail
36821.endd
36822This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36823required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36824
36825The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36826requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36827up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36828information about the domains.
36829
36830
36831
36832.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36833.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36834.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36835.cindex "local part" "prefix"
36836.cindex "local part" "suffix"
36837Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36838incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36839allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36840identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36841parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36842&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36843example, consider this router:
36844.code
36845userforward:
36846 driver = redirect
36847 check_local_user
36848 file = $home/.forward
36849 local_part_suffix = -*
36850 local_part_suffix_optional
36851 allow_filter
36852.endd
36853.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36854It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36855&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36856cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36857.code
36858if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36859save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36860endif
36861.endd
36862If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36863fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36864&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36865control over which suffixes are valid.
36866
36867Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36868&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36869another MTA:
36870.code
36871userforward:
36872 driver = redirect
36873 check_local_user
36874 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36875 local_part_suffix = -*
36876 local_part_suffix_optional
36877 allow_filter
36878.endd
36879If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36880example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36881does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36882subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36883&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36884
36885
36886
36887.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36888.cindex "vacation processing"
36889The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36890a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36891(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36892This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36893that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36894
36895.ilist
36896A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36897can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36898alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36899&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36900.code
36901spqr, vacation-spqr
36902.endd
36903.next
36904The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36905vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36906user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36907ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36908to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36909message.
36910.endlist
36911
36912Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36913use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36914
36915
36916
36917.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36918.cindex "message" "copying every"
36919Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36920be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36921command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36922each day's messages.
36923
36924There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36925messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36926delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36927notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36928
36929
36930
36931.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36932.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36933It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36934Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36935arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36936permanently connected.
36937
36938Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36939particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36940Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36941
36942
36943.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36944It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36945host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36946approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36947being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36948some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36949to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36950resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36951
36952A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36953intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36954into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36955format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36956destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36957in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36958if required.
36959
36960On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36961you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36962intermittent host. For example:
36963.code
36964cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36965.endd
36966This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36967which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36968online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36969options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36970causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36971connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36972immediately.
36973
36974If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36975issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36976mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36977used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36978avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36979Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36980arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36981
36982
36983
36984.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36985The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36986increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36987connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36988delivered immediately.
36989
36990.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36991.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36992.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36993.cindex "first pass routing"
36994Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36995not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36996possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36997each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36998avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36999&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
37000first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
37001normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
37002destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
37003single SMTP connection.
37004
37005
37006
37007. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37008. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37009
37010.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
37011 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
37012.cindex "client, non-queueing"
37013.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
37014On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
37015email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
37016configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
37017However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
37018configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
37019&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
37020messages this way.
37021
37022If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
37023run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
37024any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
37025continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
37026email is not desirable.
37027
37028There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
37029&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
37030any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
37031host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
37032informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
37033to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
37034to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
37035
37036There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
37037that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
37038ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
37039before sending a message to the smart host.
37040
37041Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
37042tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
37043overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
37044
37045.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
37046There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
37047Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
37048assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
37049just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
37050compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
37051router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
37052
37053When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
37054following ways:
37055
37056.ilist
37057A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
37058In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
37059.next
37060Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
37061assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
37062&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
37063does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
37064successful, a zero return code is given.
37065.next
37066Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
37067be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
37068the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
37069must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
37070deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
37071are.
37072.next
37073If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
37074failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
37075successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
37076.next
37077Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
37078is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
37079smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
37080the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
37081there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
37082.next
37083If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
37084connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
37085failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
37086.next
37087When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
37088(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
37089value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
37090are ever generated.
37091.next
37092No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
37093.next
37094A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
37095true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
37096&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
37097.endlist
37098
37099The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
37100the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
37101deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
37102privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
37103to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
37104the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
37105
37106
37107
37108
37109. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37110. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37111
37112.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
37113.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
37114.cindex "log" "types of"
37115Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
37116and the panic log:
37117
37118.ilist
37119.cindex "main log"
37120The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
37121line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
37122down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
37123out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
37124them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
37125they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
37126analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
37127&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
37128.next
37129.cindex "reject log"
37130The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
37131of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
37132The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
37133the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
37134is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
37135lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
37136reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
37137host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
37138can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
37139false.
37140.next
37141.cindex "panic log"
37142.cindex "system log"
37143When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
37144error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
37145are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
37146other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
37147therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
37148regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
37149panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
37150is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
37151message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
37152.endlist
37153
37154Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
37155example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
37156In the log file, this would be all on one line:
37157.code
371582001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
37159 by QUIT
37160.endd
37161By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
37162ways of changing this:
37163
37164.ilist
37165You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
37166you set
37167.code
37168timezone = UTC
37169.endd
37170the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
37171.next
37172If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
37173example:
37174.code
371752003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
37176.endd
37177.endlist
37178
37179.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37180.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37181Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
37182request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
37183&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
37184brackets, immediately after the time and date.
37185
37186
37187
37188
37189.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
37190.cindex "log" "destination"
37191.cindex "log" "to file"
37192.cindex "log" "to syslog"
37193.cindex "syslog"
37194The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
37195should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
37196are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
37197arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
37198It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
37199need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
37200Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
37201
37202The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
37203&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
37204configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
37205references to the host name:
37206.code
37207log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
37208.endd
37209It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
37210rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
37211start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
37212before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
37213configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
37214log at all.
37215
37216The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
37217list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
37218facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
37219colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
37220otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
37221point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
37222implying the use of a default path.
37223
37224When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
37225LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
37226&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
37227mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
37228files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
37229equivalent to the setting:
37230.code
37231log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
37232.endd
37233If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
37234or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
37235that is where the logs are written.
37236
37237A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
37238are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
37239
37240Here are some examples of possible settings:
37241.display
37242&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
37243&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
37244&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
37245&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
37246.endd
37247If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
37248error is logged.
37249
37250
37251
37252.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37253.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37254.cindex "cycling logs"
37255.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37256.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37257Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37258log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37259provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37260main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37261keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37262
37263An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37264and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37265example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37266message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37267that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37268something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37269ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37270&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37271does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37272tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37273for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37274renamed.
37275
37276
37277
37278.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37279.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37280Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37281periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37282for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37283&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37284the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37285point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37286.code
37287log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37288log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37289log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37290log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37291.endd
37292As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37293examples of names generated by the above examples:
37294.code
37295/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37296/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37297/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37298/var/log/exim/main.200212
37299.endd
37300When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37301files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37302will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37303run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37304
37305The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37306is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37307When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37308the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37309non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37310character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37311log names:
37312.code
37313/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37314/var/log/exim-panic.log
37315/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37316/var/log/exim/panic
37317.endd
37318
37319
37320.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37321.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37322The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37323except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37324Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37325that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37326&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37327by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37328&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37329SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37330&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37331LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37332the time and host name to each line.
37333The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37334
37335.ilist
37336&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37337.next
37338&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37339.next
37340&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37341.endlist
37342
37343Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37344written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37345these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37346by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37347
37348Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37349entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37350these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37351calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37352870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37353additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37354replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37355RFC 3164, you should set
37356.code
37357SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37358.endd
37359in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37360lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37361
37362To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37363entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37364where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37365components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37366because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37367delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37368870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37369&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37370name, and pid as added by syslog:
37371.code
37372[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37373[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37374[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37375[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37376[5/5] mple>)
37377.endd
37378The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37379(LOG_NOTICE):
37380.code
37381[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37382[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37383[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37384[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37385[5\18] .example>)
37386[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37387[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37388[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37389[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37390[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37391[11\18] 09:43 +0100
37392[12\18] F From: <>
37393[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37394[18\18] X-something: this is another header
37395[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37396[16\18] le>
37397[17\18] B Bcc:
37398[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37399.endd
37400Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37401without modification.
37402
37403If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37404display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37405the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37406where it is.
37407
37408
37409
37410.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37411One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37412successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37413picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37414timestamp. The flags are:
37415.display
37416&`<=`& message arrival
37417&`(=`& message fakereject
37418&`=>`& normal message delivery
37419&`->`& additional address in same delivery
37420&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37421&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37422&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37423&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37424.endd
37425
37426
37427.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37428.cindex "log" "reception line"
37429The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37430message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37431several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37432.code
374332002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37434 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37435 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37436.endd
37437The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37438bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37439generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37440.code
37441R=<message id>
37442.endd
37443which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37444
37445.cindex "HELO"
37446.cindex "EHLO"
37447For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37448record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37449received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37450host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37451above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37452&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37453by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37454verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37455EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37456name in parentheses.
37457
37458Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37459without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37460the log containing text like these examples:
37461.code
37462H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37463H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37464.endd
37465This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37466on.
37467
37468For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37469the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37470of Exim.
37471
37472.cindex "authentication" "logging"
37473.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37474For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37475message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37476of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37477extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37478session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37479suite that was used.
37480
37481.cindex log protocol
37482The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37483hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37484value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37485there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37486was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37487&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37488authenticator name.
37489
37490.cindex "size" "of message"
37491The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37492received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37493headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37494message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37495other).
37496
37497The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37498data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37499
37500
37501
37502.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37503.cindex "log" "delivery line"
37504The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37505delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37506deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37507to fit it on the page:
37508.code
375092002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37510 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
375112002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37512 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37513 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37514.endd
37515For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37516after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37517intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37518last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37519fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37520
37521If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37522followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37523If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37524option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37525
37526If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37527for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37528.display
37529&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37530.endd
37531If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37532parentheses afterwards.
37533
37534.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37535When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37536SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37537flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37538down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37539lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37540When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37541DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37542will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37543TLS cipher information is still available.
37544
37545.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37546.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37547When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37548line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37549rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37550
37551The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37552&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37553
37554The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37555data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37556
37557
37558.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37559.cindex "discarded messages"
37560.cindex "message" "discarded"
37561.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37562When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37563obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37564.code
375652002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37566 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37567.endd
37568is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37569because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37570.code
375711999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37572 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37573.endd
37574
37575
37576.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37577When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37578.code
375792002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37580 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37581.endd
37582In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37583last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37584written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37585.code
375862002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37587 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37588.endd
37589When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37590a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37591appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37592
37593
37594
37595.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37596.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37597If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37598following form is logged:
37599.code
376001995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37601 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37602.endd
37603If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37604the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37605.code
376062002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37607 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37608 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37609 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37610 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37611.endd
37612The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37613used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37614disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37615flagged with &`**`&.
37616
37617
37618
37619.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37620.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37621If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37622used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37623&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37624
37625
37626
37627.section "Completion" "SECID257"
37628A line of the form
37629.code
376302002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37631.endd
37632is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37633at the end of its processing.
37634
37635
37636
37637
37638.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37639.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37640A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37641the following table:
37642.display
37643&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37644&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37645&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37646&`CV `& certificate verification status
37647&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37648&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37649&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37650&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37651&`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
37652&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37653&`H `& host name and IP address
37654&`I `& local interface used
37655&`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37656&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37657&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37658&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37659&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37660&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37661&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37662&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37663&`Q `& alternate queue name
37664&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37665&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37666&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37667&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37668&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37669&`S `& size of message in bytes
37670&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37671&`ST `& shadow transport name
37672&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37673&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37674&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37675&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37676&`X `& TLS cipher suite
37677.endd
37678
37679
37680.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37681Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37682self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37683
37684.ilist
37685.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37686&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37687during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37688This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37689during the first delivery attempt.
37690.next
37691&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37692temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37693for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37694.next
37695.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37696&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37697some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37698common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37699&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37700doing.
37701.next
37702.cindex "error" "ignored"
37703&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37704message:
37705.olist
37706Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37707&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37708.next
37709A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37710failed. The delivery was discarded.
37711.next
37712A delivery set up by a router configured with
37713. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37714. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37715.code
37716 errors_to = <>
37717.endd
37718failed. The delivery was discarded.
37719.endlist olist
37720.next
37721.cindex DKIM "log line"
37722&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37723logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37724.endlist ilist
37725
37726
37727
37728
37729
37730.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37731.cindex "log" "selectors"
37732By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37733default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37734&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37735example:
37736.code
37737log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37738.endd
37739The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37740selection marked by asterisks:
37741.display
37742&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37743&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37744&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37745&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37746&` arguments `& command line arguments
37747&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37748&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37749&` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
37750&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37751&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37752&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37753&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37754&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37755&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37756&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37757&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37758&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37759&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37760&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37761&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37762&`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37763&` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37764&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37765&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37766&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37767&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37768&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37769&` pid `& Exim process id
37770&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37771&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37772&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37773&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37774&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37775&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37776&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37777&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37778&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37779&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37780&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37781&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37782&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37783&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37784&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37785&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37786&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37787&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37788&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37789&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37790&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37791&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37792&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37793&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37794&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37795
37796&` all `& all of the above
37797.endd
37798See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37799section &<<SECID99>>&
37800
37801More details on each of these items follows:
37802
37803.ilist
37804.cindex "8BITMIME"
37805.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37806&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37807which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37808that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37809&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37810&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37811.next
37812.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37813&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37814its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37815this log selector is set.
37816.next
37817.cindex "log" "rewriting"
37818.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37819&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37820rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37821such users cannot access the log).
37822.next
37823.cindex "log" "full parentage"
37824&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37825delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37826parentheses between them.
37827.next
37828.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37829.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37830&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37831to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37832feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37833&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37834privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37835that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37836are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37837because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37838only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37839between the caller and Exim.
37840.next
37841.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37842&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37843connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37844.next
37845.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37846.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37847&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37848started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37849messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37850process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37851.next
37852.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37853&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37854perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37855If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37856precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37857.next
37858.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37859.cindex "size" "of message"
37860&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37861the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37862.next
37863.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37864.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37865&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37866verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37867.next
37868.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37869.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37870&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37871.next
37872.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37873.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37874.cindex "black list (DNS)"
37875&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37876DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37877.next
37878.cindex log dnssec
37879.cindex dnssec logging
37880&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37881dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37882For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37883It does not cover helo-name verification.
37884For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37885.next
37886.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37887.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37888&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37889is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37890command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37891selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37892.next
37893.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37894&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37895any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37896log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37897routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37898.next
37899.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37900.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37901&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37902client's ident port times out.
37903.next
37904.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37905.cindex "log" "local interface"
37906.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37907.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37908.cindex "interface" "logging"
37909&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37910to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37911followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37912added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37913rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37914The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37915.next
37916.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37917.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37918.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37919&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37920of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37921on a proxied connection
37922or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37923See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37924.next
37925.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37926.cindex "port" "logging remote"
37927.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37928.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37929.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37930&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37931added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37932in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37933changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37934&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37935important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37936.next
37937.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37938&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37939connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37940.next
37941.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37942.cindex millisecond logging
37943.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37944&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37945appended to the seconds value.
37946.next
37947.cindex "log" "message id"
37948&%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37949.next
37950&%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37951This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37952(submission mode) without one.
37953The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37954.next
37955.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37956.cindex "log" "local interface"
37957.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37958.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37959.cindex "interface" "logging"
37960&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37961interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37962followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37963off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37964.next
37965.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37966.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37967.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37968&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37969containing => tags) following the IP address.
37970The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37971&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37972This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37973configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37974local port is a random ephemeral port.
37975.next
37976.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37977.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37978&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37979immediately after the time and date.
37980.next
37981.cindex log pipelining
37982.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37983&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37984log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37985The field is a single "L".
37986
37987On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37988the field has a minus appended.
37989
37990.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37991If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37992accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37993offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37994Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37995
37996.next
37997.cindex "log" "queue run"
37998.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37999&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
38000.next
38001.cindex "log" "queue time"
38002&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
38003local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
38004&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
38005includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
38006This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
38007delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
38008message has been successfully received.
38009If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38010precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
38011.next
38012&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
38013the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
38014example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
38015message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
38016.next
38017.cindex "log" "receive duration"
38018&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
38019perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
38020If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38021precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
38022.next
38023.cindex "log" "recipients"
38024&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
38025as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
38026that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
38027addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
38028has taken place.
38029Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
38030in the list.
38031.next
38032.cindex "log" "sender reception"
38033&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
38034the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
38035&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
38036.next
38037.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
38038&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
38039rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
38040log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
38041rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
38042.next
38043.cindex "log" "retry defer"
38044&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
38045retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
38046message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
38047attempt.
38048.next
38049.cindex "log" "return path"
38050&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
38051the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
38052This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
38053or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
38054.next
38055.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
38056&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
38057and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
38058This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
38059necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
38060.next
38061.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
38062&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
38063gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
38064the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
38065detail is lost.
38066.next
38067.cindex "log" "size rejection"
38068&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
38069it is too big.
38070.next
38071.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
38072.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
38073&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
38074queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
38075it.
38076.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
38077The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
38078.next
38079.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
38080.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
38081.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
38082&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
38083outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
38084A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
38085response.
38086.next
38087.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
38088.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
38089&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
38090established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
38091&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
38092only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
38093processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
38094dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
38095not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
38096of connections unless this selector is enabled.
38097
38098For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
38099included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
38100reset if the daemon is restarted.
38101Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
38102subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
38103whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
38104match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
38105logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
38106.next
38107.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
38108.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
38109&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
38110RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
38111and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
38112line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
38113.next
38114.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
38115.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
38116&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
38117connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
38118the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
38119does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
38120an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
38121already have their own log lines.
38122
38123The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
38124way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
38125If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
38126an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
38127DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
38128the same logging options.
38129
38130Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
38131is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
38132.code
38133C=EHLO,QUIT
38134.endd
38135shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
38136than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
38137the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
38138setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
38139have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
38140.next
38141&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
38142colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
38143log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
38144was accepted or used.
38145.next
38146.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
38147.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
38148&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
38149encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
38150because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
38151been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
38152it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
38153received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
38154.next
38155.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
38156.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
38157.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
38158.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
38159.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
38160&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
38161encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
38162external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
38163using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
38164.next
38165.cindex "log" "subject"
38166.cindex "subject, logging"
38167&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
38168preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
38169Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
38170specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
38171unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
38172.next
38173.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
38174.cindex log DANE
38175.cindex DANE logging
38176&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
38177when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
38178verified
38179using a CA trust anchor,
38180&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
38181and &`CV=no`& if not.
38182.next
38183.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
38184.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
38185&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38186connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
38187.next
38188.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
38189.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
38190&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38191connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
38192added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
38193.next
38194.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
38195.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
38196&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
38197the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
38198added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
38199.next
38200.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
38201&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
38202result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
38203.endlist
38204
38205
38206.section "Message log" "SECID260"
38207.cindex "message" "log file for"
38208.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
38209.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
38210.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
38211In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
38212that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
38213they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
38214message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
38215makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
38216to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
38217is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
38218only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
38219
38220On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
38221per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
38222&%message_logs%& option false.
38223.ecindex IIDloggen
38224
38225
38226
38227
38228. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38229. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38230
38231.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
38232.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
38233A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
38234described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
38235the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
38236
38237.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
38238.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
38239 "list what Exim processes are doing"
38240.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
38241.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
38242.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
38243.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
38244 various criteria"
38245.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
38246.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
38247 "extract statistics from the log"
38248.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
38249 "check address acceptance from given IP"
38250.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38251.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38252.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38253.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38254.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38255.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38256.endtable
38257
38258Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38259&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38260&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38261
38262
38263
38264
38265.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38266.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38267.cindex "process, querying"
38268.cindex "SIGUSR1"
38269On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38270(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38271a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38272Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38273processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38274second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38275order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38276send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38277
38278&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38279use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38280script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38281
38282
38283Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38284varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38285but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38286system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38287it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38288options:
38289.display
38290&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38291&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38292&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38293&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38294.endd
38295An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38296.code
38297164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3829810483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3829910492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38300 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3830110592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3830210628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38303.endd
38304The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38305been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38306
38307
38308
38309.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38310.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38311.cindex "queue" "grepping"
38312This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38313.code
38314exim -bpu
38315.endd
38316or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38317.code
38318exim -bp
38319.endd
38320The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38321contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38322
38323to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38324that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38325
38326.vlist
38327.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38328Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38329tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38330.code
38331exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
38332.endd
38333.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38334Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38335tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38336
38337.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38338Match against the size field.
38339
38340.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38341Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38342
38343.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38344Match messages that are older than the given time.
38345
38346.vitem &*-z*&
38347Match only frozen messages.
38348
38349.vitem &*-x*&
38350Match only non-frozen messages.
38351
38352.vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38353Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38354.endlist
38355
38356The following options control the format of the output:
38357
38358.vlist
38359.vitem &*-c*&
38360Display only the count of matching messages.
38361
38362.vitem &*-l*&
38363Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38364the default.
38365
38366.vitem &*-i*&
38367Display message ids only.
38368
38369.vitem &*-b*&
38370Brief format &-- one line per message.
38371
38372.vitem &*-R*&
38373Display messages in reverse order.
38374
38375.vitem &*-a*&
38376Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38377.endlist
38378
38379There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38380
38381
38382
38383.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38384.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38385.cindex "queue" "summary"
38386The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38387-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38388running a command such as
38389.code
38390exim -bp | exiqsumm
38391.endd
38392The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38393it, as in the following example:
38394.code
383953 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38396.endd
38397Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38398volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38399been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38400number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38401
38402A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38403domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38404the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38405respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38406domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38407separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38408sender.
38409
38410The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38411this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38412generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38413option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38414level"& addresses).
38415
38416
38417
38418
38419.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38420 "SECTextspeinf"
38421.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38422.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38423The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38424files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38425extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38426match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38427given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38428The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38429If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38430included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38431.display
38432&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38433.endd
38434If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38435
38436The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38437condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38438they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38439
38440By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38441makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38442large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38443option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38444case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38445
38446The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38447pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38448regular expression.
38449
38450The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38451if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38452
38453The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38454that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38455normally.
38456
38457Example of &%-M%&:
38458user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38459&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38460displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38461the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38462when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38463&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38464search term.
38465
38466If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38467ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38468whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38469If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38470autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38471
38472
38473.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38474.cindex "&'exipick'&"
38475John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38476lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38477of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38478the &%--help%& option.
38479
38480
38481.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38482.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38483.cindex "cycling logs"
38484.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38485The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38486&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38487you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38488&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38489for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38490There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38491.ilist
38492&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38493default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38494.next
38495&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38496&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38497overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38498configuration.
38499.endlist
38500
38501Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38502the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38503run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38504&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38505&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38506logs are handled similarly.
38507
38508If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38509&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38510to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38511any existing log files.
38512
38513If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38514the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38515using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38516setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38517root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38518.code
385191 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38520.endd
38521assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38522&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38523
38524
38525
38526.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38527.cindex "statistics"
38528.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38529A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38530information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38531. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38532. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38533
38534The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38535latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38536lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38537various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38538list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38539.code
38540eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38541.endd
38542By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38543messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38544both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38545are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38546addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38547options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38548also produced per user.
38549
38550The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38551histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38552hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38553example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38554as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38555
38556Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38557have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38558messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38559and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38560recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38561an entirely separate message.
38562
38563&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38564of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38565each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38566not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38567least one address that failed.
38568
38569The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38570or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38571transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38572(default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38573a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38574senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38575and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38576
38577The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38578came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38579without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38580
38581There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38582outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38583by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38584.code
38585perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38586.endd
38587
38588.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38589.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38590.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38591.cindex "checking access"
38592The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38593debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38594policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38595familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38596sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38597access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38598
38599The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38600two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38601.code
38602exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38603.endd
38604The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38605given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38606connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38607is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38608.code
38609Rejected:
38610550 Relay not permitted
38611.endd
38612When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38613for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38614options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38615that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38616you can use:
38617.code
38618exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38619 -f himself@there.example
38620.endd
38621Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38622mandatory arguments.
38623
38624Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38625while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38626&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38627
38628
38629
38630.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38631.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38632.cindex "building DBM files"
38633.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38634.cindex "lower casing"
38635.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38636The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38637the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38638&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38639names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38640can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38641
38642A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38643the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38644&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38645strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38646files.
38647
38648The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38649single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38650It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38651well.
38652
38653.cindex "USE_DB"
38654If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38655configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38656filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38657create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38658.code
38659exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38660.endd
38661reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38662&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38663
38664In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38665Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38666environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38667&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38668when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38669recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38670
38671If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38672finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38673option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38674this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38675&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38676There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38677&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38678return code is 2.
38679
38680
38681
38682
38683.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38684.cindex "retry" "times"
38685.cindex "&'exinext'&"
38686A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38687fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38688complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38689information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38690is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38691output. For example:
38692.code
38693$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38694kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38695 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38696 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38697 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38698roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38699 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38700 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38701 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38702 past final cutoff time
38703.endd
38704You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38705will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38706A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38707message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38708suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38709&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38710run very often.
38711
38712The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38713of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38714passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38715configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38716file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38717environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38718
38719
38720
38721.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38722.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38723.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38724Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38725uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38726arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38727second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38728
38729.ilist
38730&'retry'&: the database of retry information
38731.next
38732&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38733for remote hosts
38734.next
38735&'callout'&: the callout cache
38736.next
38737&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38738.next
38739&'misc'&: other hints data
38740.endlist
38741
38742The &'misc'& database is used for
38743
38744.ilist
38745Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38746.next
38747Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38748&(smtp)& transport)
38749.next
38750Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38751in a transport)
38752.endlist
38753
38754
38755
38756.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38757.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38758The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38759&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38760spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38761.code
38762exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38763.endd
38764Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38765.code
38766T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3876731-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38768.endd
38769The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38770of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38771transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38772a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38773address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38774transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38775to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38776and a textual description of the error.
38777
38778The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38779the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38780ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38781exceeded.
38782
38783Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38784consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38785waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38786one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38787may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38788may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38789cross-references.
38790
38791
38792
38793.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38794.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38795The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38796database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38797days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38798updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38799since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38800for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38801updated sufficiently often.
38802
38803The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38804followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38805the retry database:
38806.code
38807exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38808.endd
38809Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38810message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38811they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38812are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38813types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38814message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38815queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38816&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38817For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38818removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38819whenever it removes information from the database.
38820
38821Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38822needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38823down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38824first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38825records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38826
38827It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38828hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38829a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38830work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38831but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38832After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38833point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38834tidied.
38835
38836&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38837databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38838
38839
38840
38841
38842.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38843.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38844The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38845Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38846getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38847is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38848key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38849displayed.
38850
38851If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38852except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38853out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38854data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38855by new data, for example:
38856.code
38857> 4 951102:1000
38858.endd
38859resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38860sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38861used as optional separators.
38862
38863
38864
38865
38866.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38867.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38868.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38869.cindex "locking mailboxes"
38870The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38871Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38872&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38873a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38874the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38875argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38876second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38877is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38878is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38879
38880.vlist
38881.vitem &%-fcntl%&
38882Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38883
38884.vitem &%-flock%&
38885Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38886supports it.
38887
38888.vitem &%-interval%&
38889This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38890interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38891
38892.vitem &%-lockfile%&
38893Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38894
38895.vitem &%-mbx%&
38896Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38897
38898.vitem &%-q%&
38899Suppress verification output.
38900
38901.vitem &%-retries%&
38902This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38903the lock (default 10).
38904
38905.vitem &%-restore_time%&
38906This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38907locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38908example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38909subsequently sees.
38910
38911.vitem &%-timeout%&
38912This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38913timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38914default), a non-blocking call is used.
38915
38916.vitem &%-v%&
38917Generate verbose output.
38918.endlist
38919
38920If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38921default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38922mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38923&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38924requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38925file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38926more than 30 minutes old.
38927
38928The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38929&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38930to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38931&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38932number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38933can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38934
38935The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38936&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38937suppresses all output except error messages.
38938
38939A command such as
38940.code
38941exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38942.endd
38943runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38944.display
38945&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38946<&'some commands'&>
38947&`End`&
38948.endd
38949runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38950suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38951such as
38952.code
38953exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38954 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38955.endd
38956Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38957second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38958.ecindex IIDutils
38959
38960
38961. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38962. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38963
38964.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38965.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38966.cindex "X-windows"
38967.cindex "&'eximon'&"
38968.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38969.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38970The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38971about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38972perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38973such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38974monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38975
38976
38977
38978.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38979The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38980script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38981binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38982be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38983&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38984parameters are for.
38985
38986The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38987a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38988preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38989.code
38990EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38991.endd
38992(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38993the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38994overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38995&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38996syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38997
38998X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38999way. For example, a resource setting of the form
39000.code
39001Eximon*background: gray94
39002.endd
39003changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
39004stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
39005black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
39006data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
39007&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
39008For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
39009reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
39010.code
39011xrdb -merge <<End
39012Eximon*highlight: gray
39013End
39014.endd
39015.cindex "admin user"
39016In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
39017&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
39018
39019The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
39020contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
39021if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
39022binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
39023versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
39024
39025The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
39026more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
39027main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
39028delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
39029different parts of the display.
39030
39031
39032
39033
39034.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
39035.cindex "stripchart"
39036The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
39037be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39038&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
39039configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
39040it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
39041hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
39042received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
39043period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
39044parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39045
39046The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
39047displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
39048title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
39049For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
39050
39051It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
39052a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
39053to a single partition.
39054
39055.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
39056This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
39057the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
39058this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
39059100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
39060SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39061&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39062
39063
39064
39065
39066.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
39067.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
39068.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
39069.cindex "window size"
39070Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
39071to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
39072shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
39073stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
39074the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
39075in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
39076
39077When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
39078currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
39079size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
39080remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
39081
39082The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
39083stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
39084the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
39085The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
39086&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
39087the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39088
39089Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
39090built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
39091START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39092
39093
39094
39095.section "The log display" "SECID267"
39096.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
39097The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
39098the main log is maintained.
39099To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
39100removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
39101The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
39102syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
39103to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
39104
39105The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
39106move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
39107scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
39108LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
39109to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
39110much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
39111a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
39112only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
39113available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
39114normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
39115configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39116
39117Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
39118and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
39119respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
39120It cannot go further back up the log.
39121
39122The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
39123normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
39124by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
39125by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
39126back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
39127the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
39128
39129Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
39130There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
39131the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
39132happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
39133&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
39134^C is typed the search is cancelled.
39135
39136The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
39137widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
39138&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
39139eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
39140However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
39141provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
39142come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
39143unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
39144on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
39145window.
39146
39147
39148
39149.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
39150.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
39151The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
39152are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
39153as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
39154parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
39155at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
39156the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
39157there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
39158to force an update of the queue display at any time.
39159
39160When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
39161and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
39162with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
39163pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
39164type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
39165such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
39166of the texts, the message is not displayed.
39167
39168If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
39169are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
39170example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
39171&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
39172has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
39173cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
39174a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
39175
39176While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
39177else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
39178queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
39179pressing the &"Hide"& button.
39180
39181The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
39182time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
39183message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
39184a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
39185recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
39186listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
39187an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
39188not shown.
39189
39190.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
39191If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
39192
39193The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
39194of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
39195The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
39196available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
39197display is updated.
39198
39199
39200
39201.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
39202.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
39203If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
39204pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
39205line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
39206any selected text.
39207
39208If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
39209MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
39210set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
39211value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
39212run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
39213.code
39214EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
39215.endd
39216The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
39217follows:
39218
39219.ilist
39220&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
39221in a new text window.
39222.next
39223&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
39224information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
39225&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
39226.next
39227&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
39228displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
39229amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
39230option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
39231.next
39232&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
39233delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
39234frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
39235a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
39236up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
39237.next
39238&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
39239that the message be frozen.
39240.next
39241.cindex "thawing messages"
39242.cindex "unfreezing messages"
39243.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
39244&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
39245that the message be thawed.
39246.next
39247.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
39248&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
39249that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
39250for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39251.next
39252&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39253that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39254message.
39255.next
39256&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39257be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39258is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39259Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39260causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39261additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39262which case no action is taken.
39263.next
39264&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39265can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39266is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39267Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39268causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39269recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39270case no action is taken.
39271.next
39272&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39273mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39274.next
39275&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39276sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39277&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39278in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39279bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39280not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39281the address is qualified with that domain.
39282.endlist
39283
39284When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39285other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39286particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39287output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39288from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39289&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39290if no output is generated.
39291
39292The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39293thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39294&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39295force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39296
39297In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39298cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39299and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39300.ecindex IIDeximon
39301
39302
39303
39304
39305
39306. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39307. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39308
39309.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39310.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39311This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39312which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39313
39314For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39315Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39316existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39317chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39318security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39319its security as compared with other MTAs.
39320
39321What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39322have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39323absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39324as soon as possible.
39325
39326
39327.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39328.cindex "security" "build-time features"
39329There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39330to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39331Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39332penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39333
39334.ilist
39335ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39336start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39337filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39338the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39339&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39340default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39341
39342If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39343which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39344into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39345configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39346.next
39347
39348If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39349or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39350file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39351the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39352root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39353right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39354reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39355it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39356privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39357separate commands.
39358
39359.next
39360The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39361with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39362CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39363requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39364the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39365but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39366previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39367.next
39368If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39369is disabled.
39370.next
39371FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39372never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39373option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39374to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39375is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39376.endlist
39377
39378
39379
39380.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39381.cindex "setuid"
39382.cindex "root privilege"
39383The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39384privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39385example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39386may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39387discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39388is required for two things:
39389
39390.ilist
39391To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39392the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39393not required.
39394.next
39395To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39396perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39397configuration.
39398.endlist
39399
39400It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39401receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39402obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39403For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39404&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39405group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39406is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39407&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39408
39409Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39410abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39411&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39412
39413After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39414uid and gid in the following cases:
39415
39416.ilist
39417.oindex "&%-C%&"
39418.oindex "&%-D%&"
39419If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39420the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39421calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39422the calling process.
39423However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39424option may not be used at all.
39425If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39426can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39427user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39428.next
39429.oindex "&%-be%&"
39430.oindex "&%-bf%&"
39431.oindex "&%-bF%&"
39432If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39433(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39434calling process.
39435.next
39436If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39437process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39438uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39439runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39440testing address verification
39441.oindex "&%-bv%&"
39442.oindex "&%-bh%&"
39443(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39444option).
39445.next
39446For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39447remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39448.endlist
39449
39450The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39451
39452.ilist
39453A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39454user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39455function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39456will be used during message reception.
39457.next
39458A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39459job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39460.next
39461A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39462but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39463subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39464deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39465remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39466subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39467while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39468generating bounce and warning messages.
39469
39470While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39471process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39472this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39473gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39474.next
39475A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39476the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39477.endlist
39478
39479
39480
39481
39482.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39483.cindex "privilege, running without"
39484.cindex "unprivileged running"
39485.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39486Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39487operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39488by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39489gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39490(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39491routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39492to any other uid.
39493
39494.cindex SIGHUP
39495.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39496Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39497that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39498correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39499
39500An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39501to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39502process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39503when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39504SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39505
39506It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39507stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39508been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39509effect.
39510
39511If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39512set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39513to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39514
39515In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39516those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39517Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39518that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39519discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39520have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39521number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39522address this problem at this time.
39523
39524For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39525is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39526&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39527be used in the most straightforward way.
39528
39529If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39530number of restrictions on what you can do:
39531
39532.ilist
39533You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39534&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39535normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39536work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39537explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39538.next
39539Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39540not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39541.next
39542Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39543the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39544and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39545enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39546.next
39547Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39548some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39549
39550.olist
39551They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39552implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39553mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39554.next
39555You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39556owned by the Exim user.
39557.next
39558You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39559on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39560mailboxes need to be created manually.
39561.endlist olist
39562.endlist ilist
39563
39564
39565These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39566However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39567gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39568gives more security at essentially no cost.
39569
39570If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39571&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39572
39573
39574
39575
39576.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39577Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39578are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39579
39580
39581
39582.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39583.cindex "security" "local commands"
39584.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39585There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39586commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39587configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39588run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39589
39590.ilist
39591Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39592injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39593be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39594allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39595has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39596.next
39597A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39598&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39599&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39600hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39601NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39602forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39603need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39604.next
39605The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39606administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39607Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39608.next
39609Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39610taint checking might apply to their usage.
39611.next
39612Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39613administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39614instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39615.next
39616Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39617Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39618each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39619of opaque strings.
39620The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39621real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39622injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39623Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39624.endlist
39625
39626
39627
39628
39629.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39630.cindex "security" "data sources"
39631.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39632.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39633.cindex "PCRE" "security"
39634If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39635are some issues to be aware of:
39636
39637.ilist
39638Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39639.next
39640Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39641.next
39642Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39643data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39644"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39645expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39646when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39647possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39648data.
39649.next
39650It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39651&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39652items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39653.next
39654Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39655expected to yield one result.
39656.endlist
39657
39658
39659
39660
39661.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39662.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39663.cindex "IP source routing"
39664Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39665some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39666IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39667IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39668
39669
39670
39671.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39672Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39673be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39674
39675
39676
39677
39678.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39679.cindex "trusted users"
39680.cindex "admin user"
39681.cindex "privileged user"
39682.cindex "user" "trusted"
39683.cindex "user" "admin"
39684Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39685able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39686addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39687local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39688permit a remote host to be specified.
39689
39690.oindex "&%-f%&"
39691However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39692in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39693message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39694but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39695permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39696the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39697
39698Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39699other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39700the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39701as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39702group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39703
39704Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39705can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39706them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39707the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39708includes the contents of files on the spool.
39709
39710.oindex "&%-M%&"
39711.oindex "&%-q%&"
39712By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39713delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39714restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39715Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39716queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39717setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39718
39719Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39720the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39721the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39722group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39723the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39724unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39725files.
39726
39727By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39728introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39729setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39730This affects most of the checking options,
39731such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39732
39733
39734.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39735.cindex "spool directory" "files"
39736Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39737set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39738&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39739any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39740
39741
39742
39743.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39744Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39745of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39746with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39747to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39748this.
39749
39750
39751
39752.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39753The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39754are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39755Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39756converted output.
39757
39758
39759
39760.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39761Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39762to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39763does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39764arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39765
39766
39767
39768.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39769Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39770defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39771loading it.
39772
39773
39774.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39775.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39776A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39777&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39778The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39779that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39780conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39781
39782The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39783the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39784string.
39785
39786
39787
39788.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39789Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39790formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39791the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39792
39793
39794
39795.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39796These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39797enough to hold the result.
39798.ecindex IIDsecurcon
39799
39800
39801
39802
39803. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39804. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39805
39806.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39807.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39808.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39809.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39810.cindex "spool files" "editing"
39811A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39812followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39813the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39814kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39815two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39816is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39817themselves are recoverable.
39818
39819The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39820Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39821and should not be used as such.
39822
39823Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39824need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39825on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39826
39827.ilist
39828You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39829fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39830which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39831place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39832lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39833.next
39834.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39835If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39836&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39837cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39838.next
39839If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39840.next
39841If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39842signature.
39843.endlist
39844All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39845
39846Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39847its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39848files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39849the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39850the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39851is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39852file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39853-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39854attempt.
39855
39856Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39857These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39858They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39859relics of crashes and can be removed.
39860
39861.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39862.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39863.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39864The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39865process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39866gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39867message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39868normally the Exim user.
39869
39870The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39871transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39872empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39873in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39874created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39875&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39876leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39877&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39878
39879The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39880was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39881start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39882warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39883
39884There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39885order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39886
39887.vlist
39888.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39889This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39890&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39891recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39892this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39893identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39894the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39895the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39896the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39897newlines.
39898
39899.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39900A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39901defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39902The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39903starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39904character. It may contain internal newlines.
39905
39906.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39907A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39908Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39909length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39910starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39911character. It may contain internal newlines.
39912
39913.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39914This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39915&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39916
39917.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39918This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39919lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39920transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39921messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39922
39923.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39924This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39925(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39926time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39927hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39928
39929.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39930The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39931&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39932
39933.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39934The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39935&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39936
39937.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39938This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39939present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39940
39941.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39942This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39943present if the number is greater than zero.
39944
39945.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39946This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39947file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39948
39949.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39950.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39951The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39952
39953.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39954This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39955command.
39956
39957.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39958This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39959the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39960messages.
39961
39962.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39963If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39964the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39965&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39966
39967.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39968This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39969address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39970
39971.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39972.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39973.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39974This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39975if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39976received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39977
39978.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39979For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39980unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39981ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39982supplied by the remote host, if any.
39983
39984.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39985This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39986which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39987generated messages.
39988
39989.vitem &%-local%&
39990The message is from a local sender.
39991
39992.vitem &%-localerror%&
39993The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39994
39995.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39996This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39997when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39998variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39999
40000.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
40001The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
40002Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
40003
40004.vitem &%-N%&
40005A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
40006actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
40007&%-N%& is assumed.
40008
40009.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
40010This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
40011the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
40012
40013.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
40014The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
40015to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
40016
40017.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
40018If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
40019of &$spam_score_int$&.
40020
40021.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
40022The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
40023rather than Unix-format.
40024The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
40025There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
40026
40027.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
40028A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
40029certificate was verified by the server.
40030
40031.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
40032When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
40033name of the cipher suite that was used.
40034
40035.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
40036When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
40037was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
40038certificate.
40039.endlist
40040
40041Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
40042corresponding data is untrusted.
40043
40044Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
40045is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
40046line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
40047is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
40048the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
40049balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
40050to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
40051original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
40052addresses are complete.
40053
40054If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
40055the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
40056Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
40057tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
40058right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
40059follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
40060.code
40061YY darcy@austen.fict.example
40062NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
40063NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40064.endd
40065After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
40066This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
40067recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
40068delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
40069example:
40070.code
400714
40072editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40073darcy@austen.fict.example
40074rdo@foundation
40075alice@wonderland.fict.example
40076.endd
40077However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
40078result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
40079line is of the following form:
40080.display
40081<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
40082 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
40083.endd
40084The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
40085the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
40086fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
40087original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
40088envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
40089length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
40090characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
40091that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
40092
40093
40094A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
40095which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
40096when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
40097character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
40098embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
40099following:
40100
40101.table2 50pt
40102.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
40103.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
40104.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
40105.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
40106.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
40107.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
40108.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
40109.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
40110.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
40111.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
40112.endtable
40113
40114Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
40115purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
40116typical set of headers:
40117.code
40118111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
40119id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40120049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
40121038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
40122042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
40123049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
40124099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
40125darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40126104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
40127darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40128038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40129.endd
40130The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
40131&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
40132unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
40133.ecindex IIDforspo1
40134.ecindex IIDforspo2
40135.ecindex IIDforspo3
40136
40137.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
40138The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
40139an ASCII newline character.
40140However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
40141can have an alternate format.
40142This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
40143The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
40144suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
40145ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
40146Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
40147There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
40148
40149. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40150. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40151
40152.chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
40153 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
40154
40155.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
40156.cindex "DKIM"
40157
40158DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
40159linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
40160be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
40161DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
40162
40163As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
40164by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
40165any original DKIM signature.
40166
40167DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
40168It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40169
40170Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
40171.olist
40172Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
40173It can co-exist with all other Exim features
40174(including transport filters)
40175except cutthrough delivery.
40176.next
40177Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
40178ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
40179different signature contexts.
40180.endlist
40181
40182In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
40183default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
40184Exim's standard controls.
40185
40186Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
40187on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
40188
40189Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
40190When set, for each signature in incoming email,
40191exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
40192signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
40193.code
401942009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
40195 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
40196 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
40197 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
40198.endd
40199
40200You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
40201or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
40202control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
40203where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
40204senders).
40205
40206
40207.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
40208.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
40209
40210For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
40211Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
40212.code
40213rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40214
40215Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40216Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40217.endd
40218
40219Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
40220in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
40221for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
40222(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
40223but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
40224
40225Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
40226These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
40227
40228.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
40229The domain(s) you want to sign with.
40230After expansion, this can be a list.
40231Each element in turn,
40232lowercased,
40233is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
40234while expanding the remaining signing options.
40235If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
40236and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40237
40238.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
40239This sets the key selector string.
40240After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
40241Each element in turn is put in the expansion
40242variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
40243option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
40244If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
40245and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40246
40247.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
40248This sets the private key to use.
40249You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
40250&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40251The result can either
40252.ilist
40253be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40254.next
40255with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40256be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40257.next
40258start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40259the private key
40260.next
40261be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40262be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40263is set.
40264.endlist
40265
40266To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40267.code
40268openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40269openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40270.endd
40271The result file from the first command should be retained, and
40272this option set to use it.
40273Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40274for the DNS TXT record.
40275See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40276
40277Under GnuTLS:
40278.code
40279certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40280certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40281.endd
40282
40283Note that RFC 8301 says:
40284.code
40285Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40286Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40287.endd
40288
40289EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40290They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40291As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40292(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40293for some transition period.
40294The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40295for EC keys.
40296
40297OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40298.code
40299openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40300certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40301.endd
40302
40303To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40304.code
40305openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40306certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40307.endd
40308
40309Exim also supports an alternate format
40310of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40311of the standard, but not adopted.
40312A future release will probably drop that support.
40313
40314.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40315Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40316.ilist
40317&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40318.next
40319&`sha256`& &-- the default
40320.next
40321&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40322.endlist
40323
40324Note that RFC 8301 says:
40325.code
40326rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40327.endd
40328
40329.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40330If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40331the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40332syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40333local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40334tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40335
40336.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40337This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40338The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40339The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40340only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40341
40342.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40343This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40344should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40345either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40346unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40347variables here.
40348
40349.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40350If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40351list of header names.
40352Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40353in the message signature.
40354When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40355whether or not each header is present in the message.
40356The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40357"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
40358
40359If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40360will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40361message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40362
40363A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
40364If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40365will be signed.
40366If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40367will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40368name will be appended.
40369
40370.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40371This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40372If not set, no such information will be included.
40373Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40374for the expiry tag
40375(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40376both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40377
40378RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40379
40380
40381.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40382.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40383
40384Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40385messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40386.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40387Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40388the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40389The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40390processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40391
40392.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40393Performing verification sets up information used by the
40394&%authresults%& expansion item.
40395
40396For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40397of this section can be ignored.
40398
40399The results of verification are made available to the
40400&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40401A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40402By default, the ACL is called once for each
40403syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40404If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40405If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40406summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40407
40408To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40409a large number of expansion variables
40410containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40411runtime of the ACL.
40412
40413Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40414more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40415&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40416&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40417
40418The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40419list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40420called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40421the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40422list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40423&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40424it defaults as:
40425.code
40426dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40427.endd
40428This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40429DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40430call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40431.code
40432dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40433.endd
40434This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40435and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40436You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40437.code
40438dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40439.endd
40440
40441If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40442&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40443
40444Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40445(such as the From: header)
40446care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40447and for the domain part if identities.
40448The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40449
40450If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40451for each matching signature.
40452
40453
40454Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40455available (from most to least important):
40456
40457
40458.vlist
40459.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40460The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40461an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40462&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40463
40464.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40465Within the DKIM ACL,
40466a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40467.ilist
40468&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40469identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40470.next
40471&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40472More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40473.next
40474&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40475available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40476.next
40477&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40478.endlist
40479
40480This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40481This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40482hash-method or key-size:
40483.code
40484 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40485 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40486 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40487 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40488 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40489 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40490 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40491.endd
40492
40493So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40494after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40495colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40496This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40497
40498.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40499A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40500"fail" or "invalid". One of
40501.ilist
40502&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40503key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40504.next
40505&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40506record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40507.next
40508&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40509body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40510means that the message body was modified in transit.
40511.next
40512&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40513could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40514re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40515DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40516.endlist
40517
40518This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40519
40520.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40521The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40522an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40523reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40524
40525.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40526The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40527if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40528identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40529
40530.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40531The key record selector string.
40532
40533.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40534The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40535If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40536may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40537The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40538for EC keys.
40539
40540Note that RFC 8301 says:
40541.code
40542rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40543
40544DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40545algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40546.endd
40547
40548To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40549and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40550or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40551processing of such signatures.
40552
40553.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40554The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40555
40556.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40557The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40558
40559.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40560A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40561(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40562Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40563not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40564strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40565
40566.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40567The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40568limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40569that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40570&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40571is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40572A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40573shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40574
40575.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40576UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40577When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40578
40579.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40580UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40581signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40582signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40583integer size comparisons against this value.
40584Note that Exim does not check this value.
40585
40586.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40587A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40588
40589.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40590"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40591
40592.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40593"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40594
40595.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40596Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40597in the key record.
40598
40599.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40600Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40601in the key record.
40602
40603.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40604Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40605
40606.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40607Number of bits in the key.
40608
40609Note that RFC 8301 says:
40610.code
40611Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40612less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40613.endd
40614
40615To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40616and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40617As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40618
40619.endlist
40620
40621In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40622
40623.vlist
40624.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40625ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40626for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40627(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40628verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40629
40630.code
40631# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40632warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40633 sender_domains = gmail.com
40634 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40635 dkim_status = none
40636.endd
40637
40638Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40639for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40640
40641.vitem &%dkim_status%&
40642ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40643results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40644to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40645
40646.code
40647deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40648 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40649 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40650 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40651.endd
40652
40653The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40654see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40655for more information of what they mean.
40656.endlist
40657
40658
40659
40660
40661.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40662.cindex SPF verification
40663
40664SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40665messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40666For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40667the &url(http://openspf.org).
40668. --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40669. --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40670. --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40671. --- discussion.
40672
40673Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40674This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40675
40676SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40677&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40678&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40679There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40680publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40681
40682For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40683.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40684Performing verification sets up information used by the
40685&%authresults%& expansion item.
40686
40687
40688.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40689.cindex ACL "spf condition"
40690The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40691It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40692and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40693Valid strings are:
40694.vlist
40695.vitem &%pass%&
40696The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40697
40698.vitem &%fail%&
40699The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40700domain in the envelope-from address.
40701
40702.vitem &%softfail%&
40703The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40704is a forgery.
40705
40706.vitem &%none%&
40707The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40708
40709.vitem &%neutral%&
40710The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40711published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40712its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40713
40714.vitem &%permerror%&
40715This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40716You may deny messages when this occurs.
40717
40718.vitem &%temperror%&
40719This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40720SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40721.endlist
40722
40723You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40724its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40725"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40726short-circuit fashion.
40727
40728Example:
40729.code
40730deny spf = fail
40731 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40732 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40733 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40734 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40735 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40736 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40737 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40738 ip=$sender_host_address
40739.endd
40740
40741When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40742variables:
40743
40744.cindex SPF "verification variables"
40745.vlist
40746.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40747.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40748 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40749 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40750 it for logging purposes.
40751
40752.vitem &$spf_received$&
40753.vindex &$spf_received$&
40754 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40755 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40756 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40757 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40758
40759 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40760 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40761
40762.vitem &$spf_result$&
40763.vindex &$spf_result$&
40764 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40765 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40766 temperror.
40767
40768.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40769.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40770 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40771 and required in order to obtain a result.
40772
40773.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40774.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40775 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40776 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40777.endlist
40778
40779
40780.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40781.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40782.cindex SPF "best guess"
40783In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40784"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40785SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40786capability.
40787Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40788for a description of what it means.
40789. --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40790
40791To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40792of the spf one. For example:
40793
40794.code
40795deny spf_guess = fail
40796 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40797.endd
40798
40799In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40800should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40801is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40802reject message.
40803
40804When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40805variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40806
40807Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40808what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40809&%spf_guess%& option.
40810For example, the following:
40811
40812.code
40813spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40814.endd
40815
40816would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40817
40818
40819.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40820.cindex lookup spf
40821A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40822address as the key and an IP address
40823(v4 or v6)
40824as the database:
40825
40826.code
40827 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40828.endd
40829
40830The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40831&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40832
40833
40834
40835
40836
40837.section DMARC SECDMARC
40838.cindex DMARC verification
40839
40840DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40841to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40842email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40843should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40844&url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40845
40846If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40847the libopendmarc library is used.
40848
40849For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40850&url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40851to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
40852repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40853SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40854This description assumes
40855that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40856are in /usr/local/lib.
40857
40858. subsection
40859
40860There are three main-configuration options:
40861.cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40862
40863The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40864.oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40865defines the location of a text file of valid
40866top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40867during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40868the most current version can be downloaded
40869from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
40870See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40871.new
40872The default for the option is unset.
40873If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
40874.wen
40875
40876
40877The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40878.oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40879defines the location of a file to log results
40880of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40881contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40882which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40883reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40884directory of this file is writable by the user
40885exim runs as.
40886The default is unset.
40887
40888The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40889.oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40890defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40891forensic report detailing alignment failures
40892if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40893and you have configured Exim to send them.
40894If set, this is expanded and used for the
40895From: header line; the address is extracted
40896from it and used for the envelope from.
40897If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40898the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40899envelope from.
40900
40901. I wish we had subsections...
40902
40903.cindex DMARC controls
40904By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40905non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40906status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40907use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40908DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40909DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
40910.code
40911 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40912.endd
40913A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40914exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40915Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40916results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40917be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40918reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40919forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40920exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
40921configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
40922construction might be inadequate.
40923.code
40924 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40925.endd
40926(AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40927not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40928your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
40929send them.)
40930
40931There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40932the DATA acl.
40933
40934. subsection
40935
40936DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40937&"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40938call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
40939condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40940for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40941up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40942occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40943
40944The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
40945right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40946on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40947mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40948.display
40949&'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40950&'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40951&'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40952&'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40953&'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40954&'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40955&'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40956&'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40957.endd
40958You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40959meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40960"accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40961short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40962DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40963strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40964fails.
40965
40966Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40967supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40968result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40969
40970Performing the check sets up information used by the
40971&%authresults%& expansion item.
40972
40973Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40974processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40975expansion variables are available:
40976
40977.vlist
40978.vitem &$dmarc_status$&
40979.vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40980.cindex DMARC result
40981A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40982thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40983DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40984(if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40985in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40986
40987.vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
40988.vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40989Slightly longer, human readable status.
40990
40991.vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40992.vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40993The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40994
40995.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40996.vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40997The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40998are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40999is any error, including no DMARC record.
41000.endlist
41001
41002. subsection
41003
41004By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
41005non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
41006create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
41007you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
41008DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
41009than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
41010processing or failure delivery issues).
41011
41012In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
41013tools, you need to:
41014.ilist
41015Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
41016.next
41017Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
41018import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
41019.endlist
41020
41021In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
41022.ilist
41023Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41024.next
41025Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
41026enable sending DMARC forensic reports
41027.endlist
41028
41029. subsection
41030
41031Example usage:
41032.code
41033(RCPT ACL)
41034 warn domains = +local_domains
41035 hosts = +local_hosts
41036 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41037
41038 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
41039 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41040
41041 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
41042 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
41043
41044(DATA ACL)
41045 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
41046 !authenticated = *
41047 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
41048
41049 warn dmarc_status = !accept
41050 !authenticated = *
41051 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
41052
41053 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
41054 !authenticated = *
41055 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
41056 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
41057
41058 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
41059 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
41060 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
41061
41062 deny dmarc_status = reject
41063 !authenticated = *
41064 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
41065
41066 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
41067.endd
41068
41069
41070
41071
41072
41073. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41074. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41075
41076.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
41077 "Proxy support"
41078.cindex "proxy support"
41079.cindex "proxy" "access via"
41080
41081A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
41082Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
41083
41084
41085.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
41086.cindex proxy inbound
41087.cindex proxy "server side"
41088.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
41089.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
41090
41091Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
41092that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
41093To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
41094in Local/Makefile.
41095
41096It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
41097&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
41098
41099The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
41100such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
41101to distribute load.
41102Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
41103the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
41104There is no logging if a host passes or
41105fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
41106recorded in an ACL (example is below).
41107
41108Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
41109main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
41110hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
41111Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
41112automatically determines which version is in use.
41113
41114The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
41115and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
41116negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
41117Exim and the proxy server.
41118
41119The following expansion variables are usable
41120(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
41121of the proxy):
41122.display
41123&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
41124&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
41125&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
41126&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
41127&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
41128.endd
41129If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
41130there was a protocol error.
41131The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
41132will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
41133
41134Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
41135per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
41136evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
41137handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
41138With the option set so high, you lose the ability
41139to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
41140In order to prevent your server from overload, you
41141need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
41142A possible solution is:
41143.display
41144 # Set max number of connections per host
41145 LIMIT = 5
41146 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
41147 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
41148
41149 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
41150 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
41151.endd
41152
41153
41154
41155.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
41156.cindex proxy outbound
41157.cindex proxy "client side"
41158.cindex proxy SOCKS
41159.cindex SOCKS proxy
41160Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
41161using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
41162The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
41163Local/Makefile.
41164
41165Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
41166on an smtp transport.
41167The option value is expanded and should then be a list
41168(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
41169Each proxy specifier is a list
41170(space-separated by default) where the initial element
41171is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
41172
41173Options are a string <name>=<value>.
41174The list of options is in the following table:
41175.display
41176&'auth '& authentication method
41177&'name '& authentication username
41178&'pass '& authentication password
41179&'port '& tcp port
41180&'tmo '& connection timeout
41181&'pri '& priority
41182&'weight '& selection bias
41183.endd
41184
41185More details on each of these options follows:
41186
41187.ilist
41188.cindex authentication "to proxy"
41189.cindex proxy authentication
41190&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
41191Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
41192for access to the proxy.
41193Default is &"none"&.
41194.next
41195&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
41196Default is empty.
41197.next
41198&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
41199Default is empty.
41200.next
41201&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
41202Default is 1080.
41203.next
41204&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
41205Default is 5.
41206.next
41207&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
41208higher values being tried first.
41209The default priority is 1.
41210.next
41211&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
41212Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
41213weighted by this value.
41214The default value for selection bias is 1.
41215.endlist
41216
41217Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
41218and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
41219overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
41220
41221.section Logging SECTproxyLog
41222To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
41223add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
41224This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
41225
41226. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41227. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41228
41229.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
41230 "Internationalisation""
41231.cindex internationalisation "email address"
41232.cindex EAI
41233.cindex i18n
41234.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
41235
41236Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
41237To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
41238Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
41239
41240If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
41241instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
41242requirement, upon libidn2.
41243
41244.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
41245.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
41246The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
41247a host list. If this matches the sending host and
41248accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
41249SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
41250
41251If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
41252international handling for the message is enabled and
41253the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41254
41255The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41256message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41257whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41258when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41259
41260Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41261UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41262require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41263the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41264
41265HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41266components expanded to a-label form,
41267and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41268form of the name.
41269
41270.cindex log protocol
41271.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41272.cindex i18n logging
41273Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41274prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41275
41276The following expansion operators can be used:
41277.code
41278${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41279${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41280${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41281${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41282.endd
41283
41284.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41285.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41286The RCPT ACL
41287may use the following modifier:
41288.display
41289control = utf8_downconvert
41290control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41291.endd
41292This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
41293a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
41294Message Submission Agent context.
41295If a value is appended it may be:
41296.display
41297&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
41298&`0 `& no downconversion
41299&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41300.endd
41301
41302If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41303is initially set to -1.
41304
41305The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41306If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41307and it overrides any previously set value.
41308
41309
41310There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41311Configurations supporting these should inspect
41312&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41313
41314There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41315Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41316for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41317
41318There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41319and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41320
41321
41322
41323.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41324To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41325the following expansion operator can be used:
41326.code
41327${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41328.endd
41329
41330The string is converted from the charset specified by
41331the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41332or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41333to the
41334modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41335with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41336(which has to be a single character)
41337are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41338<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41339
41340The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41341The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41342
41343This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41344by many other IMAP servers.
41345
41346Examples:
41347.display
41348&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41349&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41350&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41351.endd
41352
41353Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41354must be representable in UTF-16.
41355
41356
41357. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41358. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41359
41360.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41361 "Events"
41362.cindex events
41363
41364The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41365of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41366actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41367processing actions.
41368
41369Most installations will never need to use Events.
41370The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41371in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41372
41373There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41374The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41375a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41376
41377Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41378An example might look like:
41379.cindex logging custom
41380.code
41381event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41382{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41383 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41384 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41385 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41386 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41387 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41388 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41389 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41390} {}}
41391.endd
41392
41393Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41394The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41395expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41396
41397.new
41398The current list of events is:
41399.wen
41400.display
41401&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41402&`msg:complete after main `& per message
41403&`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41404&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41405&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41406&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41407&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41408&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41409&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41410&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41411&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41412&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41413&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41414&`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41415.endd
41416New event types may be added in future.
41417
41418The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41419event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41420or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41421
41422The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41423before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41424can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41425
41426The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41427should define the event action.
41428
41429An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41430with the event type:
41431.display
41432&`dane:fail `& failure reason
41433&`msg:defer `& error string
41434&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41435&`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41436&`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41437&`msg:host:defer `& error string
41438&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41439&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41440&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41441&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41442&`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41443.endd
41444
41445The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41446
41447For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41448however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41449the course of its processing:
41450.ilist
41451variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41452transport call
41453.next
41454acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41455and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41456.endlist
41457Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41458a useful way of writing to the main log.
41459
41460The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41461return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41462following will be forced:
41463.display
41464&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41465&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41466&`smtp:connect `& close connection
41467.endd
41468All other message types ignore the result string, and
41469no other use is made of it.
41470
41471For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41472then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41473the target system.
41474
41475For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41476chain element received on the connection.
41477For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41478loaded locally.
41479
41480. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41481. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41482
41483.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41484 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41485.cindex "adding drivers"
41486.cindex "new drivers, adding"
41487.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41488The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41489authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41490
41491.olist
41492Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41493existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41494.next
41495Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41496.display
41497<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41498.endd
41499where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41500code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41501should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41502.next
41503Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41504.code
41505#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41506.endd
41507.next
41508Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41509and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41510.next
41511Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41512near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41513Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41514As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41515simple form that most lookups have.
41516.next
41517Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41518&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41519driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41520.next
41521Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41522definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41523.next
41524Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41525&_src_&.
41526.next
41527Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41528as for other drivers and lookups.
41529.endlist
41530
41531Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41532proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41533occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41534options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41535searched using a binary chop procedure.
41536
41537There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41538the interface that is expected.
41539
41540
41541
41542
41543. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41544. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41545
41546. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41547. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41548. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41549. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41550. processors.
41551. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41552
41553.literal xml
41554<?sdop
41555 format="newpage"
41556 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41557 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41558?>
41559.literal off
41560
41561.makeindex "Options index" "option"
41562.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41563.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41564
41565
41566. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41567. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////